Pa1x 252um Eng
Pa1x 252um Eng
Pa1x 252um Eng
Users Manual
ENGLISH
OS Ver. 2.52
MAN0001093
Do not install near any heat sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus (including amplifiers) that produce
heat.
Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or groundingtype plug. A polarized plug has two blades with one wider than
the other. A grounding type plug has two blades and a third
grounding prong. The wide blade or the third prong are provided
for your safety. If the provided plug does not fit into your outlet,
consult an electrician for replacement of the obsolete outlet. (for
U.S.A. and Canada)
Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched particularly at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where they
exit from the apparatus.
Turning off the power switch does not completely isolate this
product from the power line so remove the plug from the socket if
not using it for extended periods of time.
Do not install this equipment on the far position from wall outlet
and/or convenience receptacle.
Use only with the cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table specified by
the manufacturer, or sold with the apparatus. When a cart is used,
use caution when moving the cart/apparatus combination to avoid
injury from tip-over.
CAUTION
Danger of explosion if battery is incorrectly replaced.
Replace only with the same or equivalent type.
Data Handling
Disclaimer
Example screens
Some pages of the manuals show LCD screens along with an
explanation of functions and operations. All sound names,
parameter names, and values are merely examples and may not
always match the actual display you are working on.
Liability
Use a soft cotton cloth to clean the screen. Some materials, such
as paper towels, could cause scratches and damage it. Computer
wipes are also suggested, provided they are specifically designed
for LCD screens.
Trademarks
Akai is a registered trademark of Akai Professional Corporation.
Macintosh is a registered trademark of Apple Computer, Inc.
MS-DOS and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft
Corporation. TC-Helicon is a registered trademark of TC Electronic, Inc. All other trademarks or registered trademarks are the
property of their respective holders.
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Introduction
Front panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
Rear panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Welcome! . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Live Performing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Useful links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
Whats in the box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
About this manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Making a backup copy of system files . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Loading the operating system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Reloading the Factory Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Start up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Connecting the AC power cord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Turning the instrument on and off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Controlling the Volume (Master&Acc/Seq) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
The BALANCE slider . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Headphones . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Audio Outputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18
Audio Inputs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
MIDI connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Damper Pedal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Demo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
The music stand . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
Glossary of Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Sound . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Keyboard tracks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Sequencer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
The LOGO decoder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Interface basics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
The Color TouchView graphical user interface . . . . . . . . . . 22
Operative modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Selected, highlighted items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Non-available, grayed-out parameters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Reference
Quick Guide
Turning the instrument on and listening to the
demos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Turning the instrument on, and viewing the main screen . . . 26
Playing the demos . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Playing Sounds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Selecting a Sound and playing it on the keyboard . . . . . . . . . . 27
Playing two or three Sounds at the same time . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Playing different Sounds with your left and your right hand . 31
Changing the split point . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Raising or lowering the Upper octave . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Digital Drawbars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
Selecting and saving Performances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Selecting a Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
Saving your settings to a Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
Selecting and playing Styles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Selecting and playing a Style . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Tempo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Intro, Fill, Variation, Ending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Selecting elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Sound Select window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Performance Select window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Style Select window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Pad Select window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
STS Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
Song Select window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
Style Play operating mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Start-up settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
How Styles, Performances and STSs are linked together . . . . . 78
Main page (Normal view) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Style Tracks view page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Volume panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
STS Name panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Mic panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Sub-Scale panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Pad panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Split panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Edit menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Edit page structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Table of Contents
Mixer/Tuning: Volume/Pan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Mixer/Tuning: FX Send . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Mixer/Tuning: Tuning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Mixer/Tuning: Sub Scale . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Effects: FX Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
Effects: FX AD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Track Controls: Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Track Controls: Drum Volume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
Track Controls: Easy Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Keyboard/Ensemble: Keyboard Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Keyboard/Ensemble: Key/Velocity Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
Keyboard/Ensemble: Ensemble . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Style Controls: Drum/Fill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Style Controls: Keyboard Range On/Off / Wrap Around . . . . 93
Pad/Switch: Pad . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Pad/Switch: Assignable Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Preferences: Style Preferences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Preferences: Global Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Page menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Write Performance dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Write Single Touch Setting dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Write Style Performance dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Write Global-Style Play Setup dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
The DIRECT HD bank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
The DIRECT FD bank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Style Record mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
The Style structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
Style Import/Export . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Entering the Style Record mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Exit by saving or deleting changes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Listening to the Style while in Edit mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
List of recorded events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
Main page - Record 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Main page - Record 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Style Record procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Edit menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Edit page structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Event Edit: Event Edit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Event Edit: Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Style Edit: Quantize . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Style Edit: Transpose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Style Edit: Velocity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Style Edit: Cut . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Style Edit: Delete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Style Edit: Delete All . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Style Edit: Copy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Style Element Track Controls: Sound/Expression . . . . . . . . . 119
Style Element Track Controls: Keyboard Range . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Style Element Chord Table: Chord Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Style Track Controls: Type/Trigger/Tension . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Import: Import Groove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Import: Import SMF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Export SMF . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Page menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Write Style dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
Copy Sounds dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Copy Expression dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Copy Key Range dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Copy Chord Table dialog box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Overdub Step Recording window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Pad Record mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
The Pad structure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Entering the Pad Record mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Table of Contents
Table of Contents
Appendix
Factory data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
Styles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
Style Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
Single Touch Settings (STS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
Sounds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
Introduction
Front panel
Front panel
23
78
I
90AB
D
E
C
G
L
R
78
2
3
D
E
1
90AB
C
F
J
K
Introduction
Front panel
a b
WX
L M
YZ
[ \
Q
U
L M
O P
WX
a b
c
g
YZ
R
[ \
Front panel
1 JOYSTICK
This joystick triggers different functions, depending on the
direction it is moved towards.
X (+/)
ASSIGN. B
6 MODE section
Y+
Move the joystick backward, to trigger the function assigned in Sound mode.
2 MASTER VOLUME
STYLE PLAY Style Play mode, where you can play Styles (automatic accompaniments) and/or play up to four
Keyboard tracks.
In the main page, Keyboard tracks are shown in
the right half of the display. You can reach the
main page by pressing EXIT from any of the Style
Play edit pages. If you are in a different operating
mode, press STYLE PLAY to recall the Style Play
mode. If Keyboard tracks are not shown in the
display, press the TRK. SEL. button to see them.
3 ACC/SEQ VOLUME
This slider controls the accompaniment tracks volume (Style
Play mode) or the Song tracks volume, excluding the Keyboard
tracks (Song Play and Sequencer modes). This is a relative control, whose effective maximum value is determined by the MASTER VOLUME slider position.
4 ASSIGNABLE SLIDERS
Gbl
Keep SHIFT pressed and move one of the sliders controlling the volume of one of the Upper tracks, to proportionally change the volume of all Upper tracks at the same time.
This works in Style Play and Song Play mode.
Keep SHIFT pressed and move one of the sliders controlling the volume of one of the Style tracks, to proportionally
change the volume of all Style tracks at the same time. This
works in Style Play mode.
Sound mode, to play single Sounds on the keyboard, or edit them. By pressing RECORD you
can enter the Sampling mode, Pa1X full-featured
sampler.
DEMO
Keep SHIFT pressed and move one of the sliders controlling the volume of one of the Song tracks, to proportionally
change the volume of all Song tracks at the same time. This
works in Sequencer mode.
7 GLOBAL
This button recalls the Global edit environment, where you can
adjust various global settings. This edit environment overlaps
any operating mode, that still remains active in the background.
Press EXIT to go back to the underlying operating mode.
VOLUME
8 DISK
5 SLIDER MODE
SB
Each slider controls the volume of the corresponding track in the display.
This button recalls the Disk edit environment, where you can
execute various operations on files and disks (Load, Save, For-
9 MEMORY
SB
Off
Flashing
Variation/STS Link function activated. This function makes each Variation recall the corresponding STS when selected. For example, select
Variation 2, and STS 2 will be automatically
recalled; select Variation 3, and STS 3 will be
automatically recalled.
Off
0 BASS INVERSION
SB
Off
A MANUAL BASS
SB
Off
Upper LED On
Lower LED On
Both LEDs On
B FADE IN/OUT
When the Style is not playing, press this button to start it with a
volume fade-in (the volume goes from zero to the maximum).
When the Style is playing back, press this button to stop it with a
volume fade-out (the volume gradually decreases).
You dont need to press START/STOP to start or stop the Style.
C SINGLE TOUCH
This button turns the Single Touch and Variation/STS Link
functions on or off.
On
SB
These buttons set the arranger in Intro mode. After pressing one
of these buttons, start the Style, and it will begin with the
selected intro. The INTRO LED automatically goes off at the end
of the intro.
Press them twice (LED blinking) to let them play in loop, and
select any other Style element (Fill, Intro, Variation) to exit the
loop.
Note: Intro 1 plays a short sequence with different chords, while
Intro 2 plays on the last recognized chord. Intro 3 is usually a onebar Count In.
Introduction
Front panel
10
Front panel
Sty
SB
Sty
Sty
L RECORD
This button sets the instrument to Record or Sampling mode
(depending on the current operating mode).
SB
Each of these buttons select one of the four variations of the current Style. Each variation can vary in patterns and sounds.
SB
I TAP TEMPO/RESET
This is a double-function button, acting in a different way
depending on the Style status (stop/play).
Tap Tempo: When the Style is not playing, you can beat the
tempo on this button. At the end, the accompaniment starts
playing, using the tapped in tempo.
Reset: When you press this button while the Style is playing
back, the Style pattern goes back to the previous strong beat.
O SHIFT
With this button held down, pressing certain other buttons
accesses to a second function.
P HELP
Press this button to open the context-sensitive Help.
SB
These buttons turn the Synchro Start and Synchro Stop functions on or off.
Start On, Stop Off
In this situation, just play a chord in the chord
recognition area (usually under the split point,
see CHORD SCANNING section on page 11)
to automatically start the Style. If you like, turn
one of the INTROs on before starting the Style.
K START/STOP
Starts or stops the Style running.
PAUSE
11
S BALANCE slider
X MENU
In Song Play mode, this slider balances the volume of the two
on-board sequencers. When fully on the left, only the Sequencer
1 can be heard. When fully on the right, only the Sequencer 2
can be heard. When in the middle, both sequencers play at full
volume.
This button opens the edit menu page for the current operating
mode or edit mode. After opening an edit menu, you can jump
to one of the edit sections by touching the corresponding button
in the display.
U TEMPO/VALUE section
Sty
SB
The DIAL and the DOWN/- and UP/+ buttons can be used to
control the Tempo, assign a different value to the selected
parameter in the display, or scroll a list of files in the Song Select
and Disk pages.
DIAL
Y TEMPO LOCK
This button turns the Tempo Lock function on or off.
On
Off
Z DISPLAY HOLD
This button turns the Display Hold function on or off.
On
Off
V AUDIO IN LED
[ SONGBOOK
This LED shows the level of the audio signal entering the INPUT
connectors. Three different colors show the level.
Off
No signal entering.
Green
Orange
Red
\ ENSEMBLE
SB
UPPER
W EXIT
Use this button to perform various actions, leaving from the current status:
SB
Introduction
Front panel
12
Front panel
SB
These buttons define how the four Keyboard tracks are positioned on the keyboard.
SPLIT
FULL UPPER
The Upper 1, Upper 2 and/or Upper 3 tracks play
on the whole keyboard range. The Lower track
does not play. By default, selecting this keyboard
mode automatically selects the Full chord scanning mode (see Chord Recognition Mode on
page 95).
a STYLE CHANGE
This button turns the Style Change function on or off.
On
Off
b PERFORMANCE SELECT
Press this button to use the SOUND/PERFORMANCE SELECT
section to select a Performance.
c SOUND SELECT
Press this button to use the SOUND/PERFORMANCE SELECT
section to select a Sound, and assign it to the selected track.
SB
SB
Upper LED On
Lower LED On
Both LEDs On
On the front panel, Sound banks are identified by the instrument names, while Performance banks are identified by numbers (1-10; 0=bank 10).
A note about Sound banks and names. Sounds from PIANO
to SFX are standard Sounds, the user cant directly modify.
Sounds USER1 and USER2 are locations where you can load
new Sounds from disk.
USER DK is where you can load new Drum Kits.
Each Sound bank contains various pages, each with up to eight
Sounds. Repeatedly press a bank button to cycle between the
available pages.
SB
SB
Each Pad corresponds to a dedicated Pad track. Use these buttons to trigger up to four sounds or sequences at the same time.
The sequences will play up to the end. Then, they will stop or
continue repeating, depending on their One Shot/Loop status
(see Pad Type on page 133).
You can stop all sequences, or just some of them, by pressing the
STOP button of the PAD section:
Keep STOP pressed and press one (or more) of the PAD
buttons to stop the corresponding sequence(s).
Note: Pads share polyphony voices with the other tracks, so avoid
using too many of them together with a dense Style or Song
arrangement.
About Pad synchronization. In Style Play mode, Pads are syncd
to the Styles tempo. In Song Play mode, they are syncd to the
last Sequencer you set to play. For example, assume you pressed
SEQ2-PLAY; when pressing one of the PAD buttons, it will play
in sync with Sequencer 2.
Note: There is no synchronization with MP3 files and Audio CD
Tracks. Pads can only be synchronized to Standard MIDI Files.
Therefore, when an MP3 file or Audio CD Track is assigned to the
last select Sequencer, Pads will synchronize to the last Standard
MIDI File that has been played back.
About Pads and the Sequencers Play command. When you
press one of the PLAY buttons to start the corresponding
Sequencer, all Pads will stop playing.
g TRANSPOSE
Sty
SB
h OCTAVE
SB
13
Introduction
Front panel
14
Rear panel
Rear panel
12
3 4 5 6
9 0
12
3 4 5 6
9 0
Rear panel
AC CABLE CONNECTOR
POWER switch
LCD CONTRAST
DIGITAL OUTPUT
ASSIGN. PEDAL
DAMPER PEDAL
OUTPUT
USB
MIDI INTERFACE
OUT A/B
These connectors receive MIDI data from a computer or a controller. Connect them to an external controllers or computers MIDI OUT.
These connectors usually work as MIDI OUTs,
but can be configured as MIDI THRU connectors. See MIDI A Out/Thru Mode and MIDI B
Out/Thru Mode on page 237 for information on
how to change their settings.
When set to OUT, these connectors send MIDI
data generated by Pa1Xs keyboard, controllers,
and/or the internal sequencer. Connect them to
an expanders or computers MIDI IN.
When set to THRU, these connectors send an
exact copy of the data received on the IN connector of the same group (A or B). Use them to cascade the Pa1X with other MIDI instruments.
EC5 MULTISWITCH
This connects to a Korg EC5 multiswitch, to control many functions in realtime. To program the EC5, see EC5-AE on
page 236.
INPUT
1/MIC
GAIN
MIC
Introduction
15
16
Welcome!
Live Performing
Welcome!
Welcome to the world of Korg Pa1X and Korg Pa1X Pro Professional Arranger! Pa1X is the most powerful arranger available
today, both for professional and home entertainment use.
Solid State Disk (SSD), for any system update a smart way
to replace the usual ROM memory.
Fully editable music database, for fast song retrieving, supplied by the SongBook
Live Performing
Pa1X has been carefully designed to be used live. The realtime
word has its full meaning in this instrument. Performances
allow the instant selection of all the tracks on the keyboard and a
suitable Style; STSs allow an instant selection of the keyboard
tracks; Styles are the realtime backing companions for your realtime playing; the SongBook is the quick way to select a song
from a sophisticated music database.
Useful links
Your preferred Korg dealer not only carries this keyboard, but
also a whole bunch of hardware and software accessories. You
should ask him for more Sounds, Styles, and other useful music
materials.
Each Korg distributor can give you useful information. Just give
them a call for additional services. In the English-speaking
world, here are the relevant addresses:
USA
Canada
UK
Many Korg distributors also have their own web page on the
internet, where you can find infos and software. Useful web
pages in English are the following:
www.korg.com
www.korg.co.uk
www.jam-industries.com
A place to find operating system updates and various system files (for
example, a full backup of the factory data) is at the following link:
www.korgpa.com
Other useful information can be found worldwide by accessing
to other Korg web sites, like the following:
www.korg.co.jp
www.korgfr.net
Welcome!
Whats in the box
17
www.korg.it
www.letusa.es
After you buy your Pa1X, please check all the following items are
included in the package. if some of them are missing, immediately contact your Korg dealer.
If you own a standard Pa1X, not fitted with a hard disk right at
the factory, we suggest you make a backup copy of all data,
including Sounds, Performances and Styles, to a set of floppy
disks, in case the internal data is changed.
Music stand
Power cable
Owners Manual
SB
Introduction
www.korg.de
18
Start up
Connecting the AC power cord
Start up
Connecting the AC power cord
Connect the supplied power cord
to the dedicated socket on the
rear of the instrument. Then,
plug it into a wall socket. You
dont need to worry about the
local voltage, since the Pa1X uses
a universal power adapter.
Press again the POWER switch on the rear panel to turn the
instrument off.
Warning: When turning the instrument off, all data contained in RAM (Song recorded or edited in Sequencer mode,
Samples in edit and not yet saved) will be lost. MIDI Grooves
generated by the Time Slice function will be lost, too.
On the contrary, data contained in the SSD memory (Factory
data, User Sounds, Performances, Styles and Multisamples)
will be preserved. Samples will be preserved, too.
Note: When turning the instrument on, move this slider to the center, to avoid starting a Song at the minimum level.
Headphones
Connect a pair of headphones to the HEADPHONES output,
under the left part of the keyboard (just under the joystick). You
can use headphones with an impedance of 16-200 (50 suggested). Use a headphone amplification distributor to connect
more than one pair of headphones.
Audio Outputs
Audio outputs allows you to connect the Pa1X to an external
amplification system. Apart for headphones, this is the only way
to listen to the sound of the Pa1X Pro, since it is not fitted with
internal speakers.
Stereo. Connect two mono cables to the main (LEFT/MONO,
RIGHT) OUTPUTs. Connect the other end of the cables to a stereo channel of your mixer, two mono channels, two powered
monitors, or the TAPE/AUX input of your audio system. Dont
use the PHONO inputs of your audio system!
Mono. Connect a mono cable to the LEFT/MONO OUTPUT.
Connect the other end of the cable to a mono channel of your
mixer, a powered monitor, or a channel of your TAPE/AUX
input of a hi-fi system (you will hear that channel only, unless
you can set the amplifier to Mono mode).
Separate outputs. You can connect your Pa1X to four channels
of a mixer. This is very useful when recording, or if you want to
send a sequencers or backing track to a separate channel. For
example, by using the separate outputs, you may send the Drum
or Bass track to an external compressor or reverb unit, or mix
the separate tracks on an external mixer.
Connect four mono cables to each of the main (LEFT/MONO,
RIGHT) and 1, 2 OUTPUTs. To feed the sub-outputs (1, 2) you
must program the track(s) you wish to send them (see the
Audio Output section in the Global, starting from page 239).
19
Damper Pedal
Audio Inputs
Demo
Connect your microphone, guitar, or any other musical instrument, to the INPUTs on the back of the instrument. The microphone signal may also be sent to the Voice Processor for
sophisticate processing.
Depending on the connected device(s), you must choose a suitable signal routing, by using the 1/MIC switch in the INPUT section. Select the MIC position to connect a microphone to the
MIC input, or the 1 position to connect a mono or stereo linelevel source (like a synthesizer or an external CD player) to the 1
& 2 INPUTs.
At this point, if you dont press any other button, all the Demo
Songs will be played back.
1.
2.
3.
A music stand comes standard with your Pa1X. Insert its legs
into the two dedicated holes on the rear panel.
Introduction
Start up
Audio Inputs
20
Glossary of Terms
Sound
Glossary of Terms
Before you begin, take a few moments to familiarize yourself
with the names and terms we will be using to talk about the various elements of the Pa1X.
In this section, you will find a brief description of various key
elements of the Pa1X. A professional arranger (Pa) keyboard
uses different terminology than a traditional synthesizer or
workstation. By familiarizing yourself with the names and functions in this section, you will get a better understanding of how
all the different parts of the Pa1X work together to create a realistic musical performance. This will also help you to get the most
out of the rest of the Users Manual.
Sound
A Sound is the most basic unit of an Arranger Keyboard performance. A Sound is basically a playable instrument timbre
(piano, bass, sax, guitar) that can be edited, saved, recalled
and assigned to any track. An individual Sound can be played on
the keyboard in the Sound mode. In the Style Play mode or
Sequencer mode, Sounds may be freely assigned to Sequencer
tracks, Style tracks, or Keyboard tracks.
Style
The Style is the heart of a professional arranger keyboard. At its
basic level, a Style will consist of up to eight parts, or Tracks.
Drums
The Drum track will provide a repeating rhythmic phrase,
played by the standard instruments of a Drum Kit.
Percussion
Variation
For each Style, there are four Variations. In general, each Variation is a slightly different version of the others. As you progress
from Variation one to Variation four, the arrangements will
become more complex, and more parts (Tracks) may be added.
This allows your performance to have a more dynamic arrangement, without losing the original feel of the Style.
Fill-in
During a performance, a drummer may often perform a fill such as when transitioning from a verse to a chorus adding
extra dynamics and keeping the beat from getting too repetitive.
The Pa1X offers three Fill-ins specifically programmed for each
Style. A Fill-in may be drums alone, drums with instrumentation, of even a silent break.
Keyboard tracks
In addition to the Style tracks, up to four additional parts can be
played on the keyboard in real-time. Each of these Keyboard
tracks can be limited to a particular range of keys or velocities,
but in general three can be assigned to play above the split point
(Upper), and one below (Lower). This allows the Upper Sounds
to be layered together. The split point can be set to any note on
the keyboard. In addition to performing along with a Style, these
same Keyboard tracks will allow you to play along with the
Sequencer.
The Drum and Percussion tracks will play the same phrase
repeatedly, regardless of the notes and chords being played on
the keyboard, although it is possible to assign a different Drum
Kit to either part, or to edit the Kit itself.
Ensemble
By turning the Ensemble feature on, a single note played on one
of the Keyboard tracks will be embellished by additional notes to
create a complete chord voicing. The Ensemble knows which
notes to add by looking at the chord that the Style is playing. In
addition, the Ensemble parameters allow you to select the type
of voicing that will be added from a simple one-note harmony
to a full Brass section even a marimba-style trill!
Performance
21
mances, etc...) intact when the power is off. The SSD also allows
for easy updating of the operating system via the floppy drive.
Performance
The Performance is the most encompassing setting on the Pa1X
a single setting that can remember a Style (with all the appropriate sounds), the Keyboard tracks (with all the appropriate
sounds) and all their Single Touch Settings, Tempo, transposition, etc A Performance can be stored in one of the Performance Banks, or it can be saved in a database format using the
SongBook function.
Sequencer
The Sequencer acts as a recorder, so you can capture and playback your performances. The Pa1X sequencer can function in
different modes. In the Backing Sequence mode, each Style element and each Real-Time (Keyboard and Pads) element can be
recorded on a separate track in a single pass. This can be a big
help in getting a song recorded quickly. The sequencer can also
behave as a traditional 16-track linear sequencer, where each
track is recorded individually one at a time.
A variety of professional
vocal effects are provided by
the Pa1X including reverb,
delay, compression, and even four-part vocal harmonies! Pitch
correction and vocal modeling are available as optional
upgrades. All of the vocal effects are provided by TC Helicon, the
leader in vocal processing technology.
Introduction
Glossary of Terms
22
Interface basics
The Color TouchView graphical user interface
Interface basics
The Color TouchView graphical user
interface
Dialog boxes
Similar to selecting windows, dialog boxes overlap the underlaying page. Press one of the button on the display to give Pa1X an
answer, and the dialog box will close.
Pages
Parameters are grouped into separate pages, to be selected by
touching the corresponding tabs on the lower part of the display.
Page menus
Press the icon on the upper right corner of each page, and a
menu with suitable commands for the current page will appear.
Touch one of the available commands to select it. (Or, press anywhere else on the screen to make it disappear, with no command
selected).
Pop-up menus
When an arrow appears next to a parameter name, press it to
open a pop-up menu. Select any of the available options (or anywhere else on the screen to make the menu disappear).
Overlapping windows
When you press a Sound, Style, or Song name, a selecting window overlaps the current page. After you select an item in the
window, or press the EXIT button, the window closes, and the
underlying page is shown again.
Checkboxes
This kind of parameters are on/off switches. Press them to
change their status.
Operative modes
Numeric fields
When a numeric value is underlined, press it a second time to
open the Numeric Keypad.
23
Operative modes
Pa1X pages are divided into various operating modes. Each
mode is accessed by pressing the corresponding button in the
MODE section on the control panel.
Each operating mode is marked with a different color code, that
helps you understand at first sight where you are.
Three special modes (Global, Disk, and SongBook) overlap the
current operating mode, that remains active in the background.
The SongBook mode can recall the Style Play or Song Play
modes.
Alphabetic fields
When a textual option is underlined, press it a second time to
open a list of options.
Editable names
When the
(Text Edit) button appears next to a name, press
it to open the Text Edit window and edit the name.
Scrollbar
List
Icons
Various icons help identifying the type of a file, a Song, a folder.
Introduction
Interface basics
24
Interface basics
Non-available, grayed-out parameters
Quick Guide
26
Display
Power switch
Style name
Style Element
measure number
Page menu
Sounds assigned to the
Upper Keyboard tracks
Upper Keyboard tracks status
Style bank
Sound name
Style meter
Sound bank
Volume sliders. They can be controlled using the Assignable Sliders on the control panel
(provided the VOLUME LED is
turned on)
Play/Mute status
Tabs
To open the Demo page, press the STYLE PLAY and SONG PLAY buttons at
the same time.
Playing Sounds
Selecting a Sound and playing it on the keyboard
27
Playing Sounds
You can play up to three sounds at the same time on the keyboard. You can also split the keyboard
into two parts, to play up to three sounds with your right hand (Upper), and one with your left hand
(Lower).
Keyboard mode (split/full) select
buttons
If you want to play the Sound on the whole keyboard, be sure the keyboard is in Full Upper mode. If it is split in two par ts, press the FULL
UPPER button in the KEYBOARD MODE section on the control panel.
(Full) Upper
Quick Guide
28
3
Playing Sounds
Selecting a Sound and playing it on the keyboard
Press the Upper 1 tracks area in the display, to open the Sound Select
window.
Sound bank
Sounds name
i Note: You
can leave the
Sound Select
window open
in the display, even after
selecting a Sound. Just
press the DISPLAY HOLD
button to turn its LED
on.
Playing Sounds
Playing two or three Sounds at the same time
29
Press the
(Mute) icon in the Upper 2 status box, to set the Upper 2
track to play.
Quick Guide
Note how the Dark Pad sound (assigned to the Upper 2 track) has been
layered with the Grand Piano (assigned to the Upper 1 track).
Press the
(Mute) icon in the Upper 3 status box, to set the Upper 3
track to play.
30
Playing Sounds
Playing two or three Sounds at the same time
Press the
track again.
Note how the StringEns2 sound (assigned to the Upper 3 track) has
been muted again. Only tracks Upper 1 and Upper 2 can be heard at this
time.
Press the
track again.
Note how the Dark Pad sound (assigned to the Upper 2 track) has been
muted again. Only track Upper 1 can be heard at this time.
Playing Sounds
Playing different Sounds with your left and your right hand
31
Playing different Sounds with your left and your right hand
You can play a single Sound with your left hand, in addition to playing up to three Sounds with your
right hand.
Press the SPLIT button in the KEYBOARD MODE section on the contr ol
panel, to split the keyboard into Lower (left hand) and Upper (right hand)
parts.
Upper
Lower
Quick Guide
Lower
Upper
Return to the full keyboard playing mode by pressing the FULL UPPER
button in the KEYBOARD MODE section on the control panel.
(Full) Upper
32
5
Playing Sounds
Changing the split point
Upper
Touch the keyboard in the display, then play a note on the keyboard. Or,
press the Split Point parameter to select it, and use the DIAL to select the
new split point.
Playing Sounds
Raising or lowering the Upper octave
33
Use the UPPER OCTAVE buttons on the control panel, to transpose all
Upper tracks at the same time.
Quick Guide
Digital Drawbars
A special sound in the Pa1X is the Digital Drawbars. This sound simulates the classic tonewheel
organs of the past. You can use the Assignable Sliders of the Pa1X to adjust each drawbar, and then
save these settings to a Performance (see Saving your settings to a Performance on page 37).
Mute all Upper tracks, apart for the Upper 1 track. Select the Upper 1
track.
The Upper 1 track is set to
play and selected.
i Note: You
can select a
Digital Drawbar
Sound
also by pressing the DIGITAL DRAWBAR button
in the PERFORMANCE/
SOUND SELECT section.
34
3
Playing Sounds
Digital Drawbars
Select the Digi Organ bank, then choose the DigDrawbars Sound.
Due to the nature of these Sounds, there is only one Digital Drawbar Organ Sound. Different
drawbar settings may be stored with each Performance. So, selecting a different Performance will
select different settings for the Digital Drawbar Organ.
As soon as the Drawbar Setting page appears in the display, the Assignable Sliders will function as organ drawbars (the sliders DRAWBAR LED
will be lit). Move the Assignable Sliders to change the various drawbar
settings.
Select different parameters in this page, and change their settings to see
how each setting affects the sound.
When you have found some settings that you like, you can save them to
a Performance, as described later in this section.
Playing Sounds
Digital Drawbars
Quick Guide
35
36
Selecting a Performance
1
37
Page menu
i Note: If
the LED of
the
STYLE
CHANGE
button
is
turned on, selecting a
Performance may automatically select a different Style and its settings
(Sounds, effects, Drawbar settings for the Style
tracks)
Quick Guide
38
2
39
or
The selected Performance location is
highlighted. Press a
Performances name
to select it.
B)
Note: A Performance
can be saved to an
Empty location. An
Empty locations
currently contains
no data.
When you have changed the name to the Performance, and selected the
target location, press OK to save the Performance to memory (or cancel
to stop the operation).
! Warning: Saving a
Performance
to
an
already used location
overwrites any existing
data at that location.
Quick Guide
A)
40
Style Elements
Style Controls
Press the Style area in the display. The Style Select window appears.
i Note: You
can leave the
Style
Select
window open
in the display, even after
selecting a Style. Just
press the DISPLAY HOLD
button to turn its LED
on.
41
Quick Guide
42
Tempo
While a Tempo setting is saved with each Style or Performance, you can change it to be whatever you
like. You can use either of the following two methods.
When the Tempo parameter is not selected, keep the SHIFT button
pressed, and use the DIAL to change the Tempo. The selected tempo will
be shown in a small window.
Press the UP and DOWN buttons at the same time to recall the saved
Tempo.
Press one of the INTRO buttons to set the corresponding Intro to play.
43
When the Fill ends, the selected Variation will start playing.
Quick Guide
When you like to stop playing, press one of the ENDING buttons to stop
the Style with an Ending.
When the Ending is finished, the Style automatically stops.
Try all the other STSs, and see how settings change with each of them.
44
The Pads
Each Performance and STS can assign different sounds or patterns to the four PADS. These sounds or
patterns can be played along with the Keyboard and Style tracks.
While the Style is playing, use the ACC/SEQ VOLUME slider to adjust the
Style volume. Keyboard tracks volume does not change when moving
the slider.
45
To separately adjust each Style track, press the TRK. SEL. (TRACK SELECT)
button to change tracks view.
Quick Guide
46
While the Style is playing, touch anywhere in the ACCOMP tracks channel strip to select the track (volume value highlighted), then touch it again
to set the track to Mute.
To set tracks back to the Play status, press the Mute icon on the ACCOMP
track.
To mute/unmute each single Style track, press TRK. SEL. to switch to the
Style Tracks view.
Press the TRK. SEL. button again to go back to the Normal view.
The LED on the TRK. SEL. button will turn off.
Press the SPLIT button in the KEYBOARD MODE section to split the keybord.
The Ensemble function only works in Split mode.
Play chords with the left hand and single notes in the right hand.
47
When the right harmonization type has been selected, press the EXIT button to go back to the main page.
Press the ENSEMBLE button again to turn its LED off. The automatic harmonization will be turned off.
Quick Guide
48
Song Play
Selecting a Song to play
Song Play
Pa1X is equipped with two onboard sequencers that can be run at the same time to mix between different Songs. Songs are read directly from disk, so there is no need to load them to memory before
playing them back.
Pa1X can read Songs of various kinds: Standard MIDI Files (SMF), KAR, MP3 and Audio CD (MP3
and Audio CD playback only available as options). Please remember that the Double Sequencer
(XDS) function is not available with two MP3s or two CD tracks at the same time. You can, however,
run a CD track on one sequencer, and an MP3 on the other one.
It may be of great interest to singers and guitar players to know that if a midifile contains lyrics and
chords, they can be seen in the display. Lyrics can also be seen on an external video monitor, provided
you have the (optional) Video Interface installed.
The SONG PLAY button
Sequencers controls
Press the SONG PLAY button to switch to the Song Play mode.
Song Play
Selecting a Song to play
49
Press the Sequencer 1 area to open the Song Select window (or press the
SELECT button of the Sequencer 1 section on the control panel).
When the Song is selected, press the Select button to confirm your selection, and close the Song Select window.
Selected Song
Quick Guide
50
Song Play
Playing back a Song
Press the
playback.
When you want to stop the song and go back to the first measure, press
the
(PLAY/STOP) button again.
When the Song is
stopped, the LED on the
PLAY/STOP button goes
dark.
Song Play
Changing tracks volume
51
Keyboard tracks
Quick Guide
In Normal view
(Keyboard
tracks shown)
this LED is
turned on.
In Normal view
(Keyboard
tracks shown)
both LEDs are
turned off.
Press the TRK. SEL. (TRACK SELECT) button once to see tracks 1-8 (Track 18 view).
i Note: Changes to
Song tracks will not be
saved, and will be reset
each time you press the
(PLAY/STOP) button.
To save changes, you
must edit the Song in
Sequencer mode.
In Track 1-8 view, the
first 8 tracks of the
selected Song are
shown, and can be
controlled using the
corresponding Assignable Sliders.
VOLUME LED
turned on.
52
3
Song Play
Changing tracks volume
Press TRK. SEL. once again to see tracks 9-16 (Track 9-16 view).
VOLUME LED
turned on.
Press TRK. SEL. again, to return to the Normal view (Keyboard tracks).
Keyboard tracks
Press the
While listening to the Song, switch from Normal view to Track 1-8 and
Track 9-16 view, to see which tracks are playing.
Each track has a sound assigned to it, so look for the name of the Sounds you are listening to.
Song Play
Turning Song tracks on/off
Touch each tracks channel strip, to see each tracks detail in the Track
Info line.
Selected track
Sound bank
Alternatively, you can see the Sound assigned to each track in the Sound
area of the Track 1-8 and Track 9-16 views.
Octave Transpose
Sounds. Names are abbreviated,
to fit the limited space. Press to
open the Sound Select window.
Quick Guide
53
54
Song Play
Mixing two Songs
Press the Sequencer 1 area to open the Song Select window and select
the Song to be played by Sequencer 1. Press Select to confirm.
Keep the SHIFT button pressed, and press any of the two
buttons, to start both Sequencers at the same time.
(PLAY/STOP)
During playback, move the BALANCE slider, to mix between the two Songs.
Song Play
Listening to a CD
55
Listening to a CD
Select any of the tracks contained in the CD, and press Select to assign it
to the selected Sequencer.
Quick Guide
If your Pa1X is fitted with the (optional) CDRW-1 CD Player, you can listen to songs from any Audio
CD. Please note that, while you can assign a single CD track to either sequencers, you can mix it with
a midifile assigned to the other sequencer.
56
The SongBook
Selecting the desired entry from the Main List
The SongBook
One of the most powerful features of the Pa1X is the onboard music database, that allows you to organize your Styles and Songs (in SMF, KAR and optionally MP3 format) for easy retrieving. Each
entry of this database may include the artist, title, genre, number, key, tempo, and meter of a specified
song. When selecting one of the entries, the associated Style, MP3 or Standard MIDI File is automatically recalled.
In addition to helping you organizing your shows, the SongBook allows you to associate up to four
STSs to each Standard MIDI File or MP3. This way, it is easy to recall a complete setup for Keyboard
tracks, effects, and the Voice Processor, for realtime playing over a Standard MIDI File or MP3.
You can add your own entries to the SongBook, as well as edit the existing ones. Korg has already supplied some hundred entries as standard. Furthermore, the SongBook allows you to create various custom lists, that may suit your different shows.
While you are in Style Play or Song Play mode, press the SONGBOOK
button to open the SongBook window.
Style or Standard MIDI Files(s) currently
assigned to the arranger or sequencer(s)
SongBook Main
List
Press this checkbox to turn the
view filter on.
The SongBook
Displaying Artist or Genre
57
When the entry is visible in the display, select it and press the Select button in the display.
After selecting an entry, the corresponding Style, SMF, KAR file, or MP3 (optional) will be
recalled, together with the relevant operating mode (Style Play or Song Play). Up to four STSs
will also be recalled.
The selected Style, SMF, KAR file, or MP3 is shown in the higher part of the screen.
Choose Show Artist (now Genre) to switch from Genre to Artist in the List
view. The Artist column will be shown.
Open the page menu again, and choose the Show Genre (now Ar tist)
item. The Genre column will be shown again.
Quick Guide
58
The SongBook
Sorting entries
Sorting entries
You can change the order entries are shown in the display.
Searching entries
The SongBook database may be really huge. You can, however, look for (say) specific artists or song
titles, using the filtering functions.
Press the Filter button in the display, to open the Filter dialog box.
Available
search criteria.
Genre and
Artist are
both considered, even
though only
one of them
may be shown
in the List
Press the
(Text Edit) button next to the search criteria (even more
than one) you want to enter.
For example, you may want to find all songs containing the word love in the title. If so, select
the Name criterion, and enter the word love. Capitals are not relevant for the search.
Adding entries
Press OK in the display, and close the Text Edit dialog box. The entered
text is now the search criteria.
Press OK to close the Filter dialog box and return to the SongBook page.
Once the Filter dialog box has been closed by pressing OK, the Filtered check box is automatically checked, and the filter is activated. Only entries matching the entered criterion are seen in
the Main List.
To see the whole SongBook database again, press the Filtered check box
again, to make the check mark disappear.
Adding entries
You can add your own entries to the SongBook database.
Go to the Style Play or Song Play mode, depending on the type of entry
you want to add to the SongBook database.
Select the Style, Standard MIDI File or MP3 file (optional) to be added to
the SongBook.
Assign the selected Song to Sequencer 1. Songs assigned to Sequencer 2 will not be saved in the
SongBook entry.
59
Quick Guide
The SongBook
60
5
The SongBook
Adding entries
When your entry is ready, press the SONGBOOK button, then the Book
Edit 1 tab to see the Book Edit 1 page.
Name of the Style, SMF, KAR or MP3 file, memorized with the entry (provided Write Current
Entrys parameters
Resource is selected when saving it).
Entrys name
Currently selected resource. If a
different Style, SMF, KAR or
MP3 file has been selected, it
may differ from the saved
resource (shown on top of the
page).
Press the New Song button in the display to add a new item to the SongBook list.
Press the
(Text Edit) button next to the field(s) you want to edit, and
write the name. Set all other parameters.
You can write the genre, artist name, and name of the associated STS. Select a Tempo matching
the songs tempo, and select the Meter and Key of the song. You can also specify a Master Transpose value, to be automatically selected when selecting the entry.
After having filled up all the desired fields (be as comprehensive as you
can), press the Write button in the display to open the Write dialog box.
The SongBook
Creating a Custom List
61
Press the
(Text Edit) button to assign a name to the new entry, then
press OK to save the entry to the SongBook database.
Entrys name. A good idea may be to assign the entry the same
name of the associated Standard MIDI File or MP3 file, or a
name suitable for the use of the associated Style.
Select Rename/Overwrite to overwrite an existing entry. Warning: the
older entry will be deleted!
While in SongBook mode, open the page menu and check the Enable List
Edit item.
Press the Book tab to open the Book page and see the full database. Use
the various sorting, searching and filtering options (seen above) to find
Quick Guide
62
The SongBook
Creating a Custom List
the entries you are looking for. Press the Add to List button when the
desired entry has been selected.
SongBook list
When finished adding entries to the Custom List, press the List Edit tab to
go to the List Edit page, and use the various commands to edit the list.
List name
Scrollbar
When the Custom List is ready, press the Write button in the display to
save it to memory. If you like, assign a new name to the Custom List.
Press Symbol to
enter special charachters.
Use alphabetic
characters to
enter text.
The SongBook
Selecting and using a Custom List
63
Press the Custom List tab to select the Custom List page.
Use the List pop-up menu to select one of the available Custom Lists.
Select one of the entries in the list (it turns blue), then press the Select button in the display (the selected entry turns green) to start playing back
from there.
Press the Lyrics/STS tab to open the Lyrics/STS page and see the four
STSs associated to the current SongBook entry.
Select the desired STS by touching its name in the display. As an alternative, press the SINGLE TOUCH BUTTON corresponding to the desired STS.
The STS is selected. Keyboard tracks and Voice Processor settings may change.
Quick Guide
64
Access Voice Processor editing from the main page (tab Mic)
and the GLOBAL button (items Voice Processor Setup and
Voice.Processor Preset)
Connecting a microphone
To sing along with the Pa1X, you must first connect a suitable microphone to its MIC input. Any
dynamic microphone is directly supported. To connect a phantom-powered condenser microphone,
you need an external phantom power supply. You can also connect the microphone though an external mixer, and connect one of the mixers line outputs to the line input IN1 of the Pa1X.
Connect a microphone.
If you connect a microphone to the MIC input, move the MIC/IN1 switch to the MIC position.
This allows the microphone signal to pass through the built-in high-quality preamp of the Pa1X.
If you connect a microphone to the IN1 input, passing through a mixer or a preamp, move the
MIC/IN1 switch to the IN1 position. This will allow you to use the Pa1X as a powerful outboard
effect processor.
65
Go to the main page of the Style Play or Song Play mode, and select the
Mic tab. Uncheck all the master switches.
Sing into the microphone, and adjust the input gain and the Audio In
tracks volume, until you achieve the correct settings.
Adjust the input level by using the MIC
GAIN knob. Sing into the microphone, and
watch at the AUDIO IN LED on the control
panel. If it goes red too often, turn down
the input gain; if it turns on green too
often, increase the input gain. No hint of
distortion should be heard in the audio system when you sing.
Microphone muted
Microphone set to
play
Quick Guide
66
If you like, start a Style or Song. Adjust the microphone final volume
using the AUDIO IN Assignable Slider.
Adjust the other settings, balancing the Style/Song and microphone with
the ACC/SEQ VOLUME slider and the AUDIO IN Assignable Slider.
The settings for the ACC/SEQ VOLUME and AUDIO IN sliders are not saved in memory, so
they stay consistent when selecting different Styles, Performances, Songs or Voice Processor settings.
Be sure you are in Style Play mode, and select a Style you especially like.
Press the Mic tab to show the Microphone panel, and select one of the
available Voice Processor Presets.
Voice Processor Presets are settings for the various Voice Processor modules (Effects, Harmony,
Voice Modeling, Pitch Correction, Thickening). By selecting a Preset, all processing parameters
may change.
A Voice Processor Preset is assigned to each Performance or STS. When selecting a different Performance or STS, the Voice Processor Preset may change (depending on the Mic panel lock status), changing the type of processing applied to your voice.
Mic panel lock
Sing along with the chords and melody you play on the keyboard.
67
While in the main page of the Style Play or Song Play mode, press the
Mic tab to see Voice Processors master switches.
During playback, press the Talk checkbox, making the check mark
appear.
To turn the TalkBack function off, press the Talk checkbox again, making
the check mark disappear.
The background music returns to the original volume.
While the Microphone panel is shown in the display, press the lock icon
to freeze it.
Quick Guide
Sometimes, during a live show, you might like to talk to your audience. Use the TalkBack function to
attenuate the music, and let your voice pass through clean and clear.
68
Style Elements
Style Controls
Sequencer 1 controls
Press the RECORD button to open the Song Record Mode Select dialog
box.
69
Select the Backing Sequence (Quick Record) option and press OK to enter
the Backing Sequence Record mode.
Quick Guide
Preparing to record
When you enter Backing Sequence Record, the most recently used Style is already selected, and all
tracks are ready to record. You could simply start recording as if you were playing in realtime with the
Styles. However, there are some settings that you may wish to edit.
70
Recording
1
Select the Style Element you wish to use before starting to play.
Select one of the Intros to start with an introduction. Select any of the Variations before starting
to record.
To edit the Song, press MENU to enter the Edit mode (see instructions
starting from page 178).
71
Press the REC button to enter Record again. When the Song Record Mode
Select dialog box appears, select Backing Sequence (Quick Record)
again.
If you are recording just one of the grouped tracks, set the track to be
preserved to the Play mode.
While in the main page of the Sequencer mode, press the page menu
icon to open the page menu.
Quick Guide
You may wish to re-record, and add one of the two grouped tracks, or overwrite a bad recording
with a new one. Usually, you will record all chord and Style Element changes during the first take, and
record Keyboard tracks and Pads during the second take.
72
2
Select the Save song command to open the Save Song window.
Select a device and folder where you want to save your Song.
Press the Save button in the display to open the Save Song dialog box.
Press the Text Edit
icon to edit the
Songs name.
Press OK in the display to save the Song to disk, or Cancel to stop the
Save operation.
Reference
74
Selecting elements
Sound Select window
Selecting elements
The following windows are shown in the various operating
modes, whenever you try to select a Sound, Performance, Style
or Song.
Sounds
Press one of these buttons in the display to select a Sound. Unless
the DISPLAY HOLD LED is turned on, the window automatically closes short after you select a Sound.
Sounds
Lower tabs (pages)
Performances
Lower tabs (pages)
Selecting elements
Style Select window
Previous/Next tabs
Scroll the lower tabs to the left or the right, when additional tabs
are available but cannot be seen in the display.
75
After selecting a Style from this window, its name begins to flash,
meaning it is ready to start playing at the beginning of the next
measure.
Performances
Press one of these buttons in the display to select a Performance.
Unless the DISPLAY HOLD LED is turned on, the window automatically closes short after you select a Performance.
Press EXIT to exit from this page and go back to the previous
page without selecting any Pad.
Press the Pad area whereas it appears in the display, to open the
Pad Select window.
Bank groups
Pads
Bank groups
Styles
Bank groups
Use these tabs to select one of the available pages in the selected
bank.
Pad
Press one of these buttons in the display to select a Pad. Unless
the DISPLAY HOLD LED is turned on, the window automatically closes short after you select a Pad.
STS Select
If you press again the same STYLE SELECT button on the control panel, the next page in the same bank is selected. This way,
you do not need to press one of the corresponding tabs in the
display in order to select a different page.
Styles
Press one of these buttons in the display to select a Style. Unless
the DISPLAY HOLD LED is turned on, the window automatically closes short after you select a Style.
Press the STS tab on the main page of the Style Play and Song
Play mode, or the Info tab on the SongBook mode, to see the
name of the available STSs.
Reference
76
Selecting elements
Song Select window
Directory
File size
Scrollbar
In SongBook mode:
Type of the
file or folder
Directory
Page menu
icon
File or folder
name
Modification
date
File/folder type
Standard MIDI File (SMF)
Audio CD track
Storage device
Jukebox file (JBX)
Folder
A file or folder may be in one of the following status. (See Protect and Unprotect on page 277 for information on how to
change the file status).
Status icon
File/folder status
Protected
Unprotected
Selecting elements
Song Select window
Storage device
Use this pop-up menu to select one of the available storage
devices.
Device
Type
FD
Floppy disk
HD
CD
CD (optional)
Open
77
Opens the selected folder (item whose icon looks like this one:
).
Close
Closes the current folder, returning to the parent (upper)
folder.
Sync P. (Synchronized Path)
1.
2.
Select the Export Song List command from the page menu.
Select
3.
4.
Select an option.
When this button is pressed, all midifiles and MP3 files contained in the current directory are added to a new Jukebox list,
that is automatically assigned to Sequencer 1. The order in
which they are played depends on the current sorting method,
i.e., how the files are shown in the display.
You can use this Jukebox list as any other list of this type (i.e.,
start the playback with SEQ1 PLAY/STOP, jump to the next Song
in the list with SHIFT + >>, edit it in the Jukebox page).
Note: A Jukebox list can include up to 127 Songs. If your folder contains more items, only the first 127 will be considered.
Hint: If you dont want to lose the list when turning the instrument
off, go to the Jukebox page and save it to disk as a .JBX file.
Reference
Play All
78
Start-up settings
Since Performance 1 of Bank 1 (Performance 1-1) is automatically selected when turning the instrument on, you can save to it
your preferred start-up settings.
Just select the Sounds, Effects, MIDI channels, Voice Processor
Preset, and other settings you would like to have automatically
selected when turning the instrument on, and select the Write
Performance from the page menu. When the Write Performance window appears, save the settings to Performance 1 of
Bank 1. (See Write Performance dialog box on page 98).
Note: If you like some settings are preserved even when selecting
different Performances, STSs and Styles, turn on the desired locks
to avoid changes to the selected parameters (see General Controls:
Lock on page 232). Save these locks to the Global (see Write Global - Global Setup dialog box on page 257).
Page header
Performance/
STS
area
Keyboard
tracks
area
Sequen
cer 1/2
area
Panels
Page header
This line shows the current operating mode, transposition and
recognized chord.
Operating mode
name
Master Transpose
(in semitones)
Recognized
chord
Sty
79
Recognized chord
Performance/STS area
Selected Performance
or STS
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. See Page menu on
page 97 for more information.
Style area
This is where the Style name is shown, together with its tempo
and meter parameters.
Style name
To select a different STS, use the four SINGLE TOUCH SETTING buttons under the display.
Current
beat
Style bank
Current
tempo
Song name
Style name
Currently selected Style. Press the Style name to open the Style
Select window. As an alternative, use the STYLE SELECT section
on the control panel.
Song name
Style bank
Current measure
Measure number of the current Style Element, that is currently
playing.
Current beat
Beat number of the current measure, that is currently playing.
Current tempo
Sty
Reference
80
Panels
The lower half of the main page contains the various panels, you
can select by pressing the corresponding tabs. See more information in the relevant sections, starting from page 81.
Tracks octave
transpose
Sound
name
Volume panel
Track name
Sound
bank
Track status
Sound name
Tabs
Program Change
Program Change number. Shown only when the Show Program
Change number parameter is turned on in Global mode. (See
page 234).
Selected track
info area
Sounds area
Upper 1
UP2
Upper 2
UP3
Upper 3
LOW
Lower
This parameter lets you select different Sounds for the Style
tracks, other than those recorded in each Style Element pattern.
Sounds assigned when this parameter is checked are shown in
the Sounds area of this page.
You can also transpose all Upper tracks by using the UPPER
OCTAVE buttons on the control panel.
Keyboard track status
Play/mute status of the current track. Select the track, then press
this area to change the track status.
Off
Sty
81
Track name
Press the Volume tab to select this panel. This is where you can
set the volume of each track, and mute/unmute tracks.
Use the TRK. SEL. (TRACK SELECT) button to switch from
Normal view (Keyboard and grouped Style tracks, Mic/In controls) to Style Tracks view (Style tracks).
Sound bank
Sound name
Volume panel
Program Change
Track name
Name of the selected track.
Sty
Sound name
Sty
Sound bank
Bank the selected Sound belongs to.
Sty
Program Change
The Style Tracks view shows individual Style tracks (lower sliders LED turned on):
Sounds area
This area lets you see Sounds and octave transposition for the
eight Style tracks.
Virtual slider
Sound name
Sty
Sty
Reference
Octave icon
82
Sty
Mic panel
Press the Mic tab to select this panel. This is where you can turn
on/off the various Voice Processor sections.
Play/mute status of the current track. Select the track, then press
the track area again to change its status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
Track names
Under the sliders, a label for each track is shown. Use the TRK.
SEL button to switch between the various track views.
MIC/IN
Harm/Mod (Harmony/Modeling)
VPp
LOWER
Lower track.
ACCOMP
DR/PERC
BASS
DRUM
V1V4
PERC
ACC15
VPp
Turns the Lead (singers) voice on/off. This switch only works
when the Harmony module is turned on. if it is turned off, the
Lead voice will be always heard, whichever the status of this
switch.
Pitch
VPp
VPp
Thicken
VPp
Effects
VPp
Tlk
Check this switch to soften all music generated by the Pa1X, and
speak on the microphone at normal level. This is useful to speak
with your audience, while automatically lowering the background music volume.
Note: You cannot edit STS names with this panel. To edit a name,
select the STS to be renamed, then select the Write Single Touch
Setting command from the page menu (see Write Single Touch
Setting dialog box on page 98).
VP lock icon
Gbl
83
This lock is reset when turning the instrument off, unless you
write Global settings to memory (see Write Global - Global
Setup dialog box on page 257).
For more information on parameter locks, see General Controls: Lock on page 232.
Split panel
Press the Split tab to select this panel. This is where you can set
the split point and Chord Recognition mode.
Sub-Scale panel
Press the Sub-Scale tab to select this panel. This panel replicates
the Mixer/Tuning: Sub Scale edit page (see page 86).
Split Point
Use this parameter to select a different split point. A full-range
piano keyboard is shown in the display, divided at the selected
split point. Upper tracks play on the right of this point, while the
Lower track plays on the left.
Keyboard diagram
Press the Pad tab to select this panel. This is where you can
assign a different Hit or Sequence Pad to each of the four pads,
and see at a glance how pads are programmed. For more
options, go to the Pad/Switch: Pad page (see page 94).
Pad
assignment
Older
sounds
Pad assignment
For more information on the various options, see Chord Recognition Mode on page 95.
SB
Name of the Hit or Sequence assigned to each Pad. Press the box
to make the Pad Select window appear (see Pad Select window
on page 75).
Note: This parameter is the same you can find in the Preferences:
Style Preferences page (see page 95).
Split Point and Chord Recognition lock icons
Older sounds
SB
To warrant compatibility with data generated prior to OS version 2.0, the name of the older sounds assigned to the Pads is
shown under each Pad assignment box. As soon as you select a
new Hit or Sequence, the name of the older sound disappears.
Volume D Send
SB
Volume, Pan, Send to the FX C and D values for each of the four
Pads.
Pads lock icon
Gbl
Gbl
Reference
Pad panel
84
Parameters area
Edit menu
From any page, press the MENU button to open the Style Play
edit menu. This menu gives access to the various Style Play edit
sections.
When in the menu, select an edit section, or press EXIT or
STYLE PLAY to exit the menu and return to the main page. To
return to the main page, you can also select the Main Page menu
item.
When in an edit page, press EXIT or the STYLE PLAY button to
return to the main page of the Style Play operating mode.
Mixer/Tuning: Volume/Pan
This page lets you set the volume and pan for each of the Keyboard or Style tracks. Volume settings are the same as in the Volume panel of the main page.
Use the TRK. SEL. button to switch from the Keyboard to the
Style tracks, and vice versa.
Keyboard tracks
Edit section
Page menu
icon
Selected
track info
Individual
Style tracks
Parameters
area
Tabs
Operating mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Style Play mode.
Off
Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 84).
Page menu icon
Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 97).
Sty
Sty
Pan
Track position in the stereo field.
L-64L-1
85
C0
Center.
R+1R+63
Off
Volume
Tracks volume.
0127
Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
Mixer/Tuning: FX Send
0127
This page lets you set the level of the tracks direct (uneffected)
signal going to the Internal FX processors. The effect processors
included in Pa1X are connected in parallel, so you can decide
which percentage of the direct signal can be effected:
Track
Out L/R
Sty
Play/Mute icon
Sty
In case you do not want to send a tracks direct signal to the output, but only the effected signal (as when using insert effects,
like Rotary, Distortion, EQ), just set the Pan to Off (see Pan
above):
Track
Out L/R
FX Processor
There are four Internal FX processors in Style Play mode (two
for Keyboard and Pad tracks, two for Style tracks). You can
assign them any kind of available effects, but we found it convenient to arrange them in the following way, for most of the
Styles, STS and Performances included with the Pa1X:
FX A
FX B
FX C
FX D
Reference
FX Processor
86
Mixer/Tuning: Tuning
This page is where you can set the octave transpose and fine tuning for each track. Plus, you can program the Pitch Bend range
for each track.
This page lets you program an alternative scale for the tracks
selected with the Scale Mode parameter (see page 95). The
Use the TRK. SEL. button to switch from the Keyboard to the
Style tracks, and vice-versa.
remaining tracks (if any) use the basic scale set in Global
mode (see Main Scale on page 231).
Sty
These parameters show the Pitch Bend range for each track, in
semitones.
112
Octave Transpose
Sty
Lowest octave.
Standard tuning.
+3
Highest octave.
Sty
Detune
This is the fine tuning value.
-64
Lowest pitch.
00
Standard tuning.
+63
Highest pitch.
Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
Key
Sty
Keyboard diagram
When Quarter Tone is checked, or a User scale is selected, this
diagram allows you to modify each notes pitch.
87
Gbl
When locked, Scale parameters remain unchanged when selecting a different Performance or STS.
4.
This lock is reset when turning the instrument off, unless you
write Global settings to memory (see Write Global - Global
Setup dialog box on page 257).
For more information on parameter locks, see General Controls: Lock on page 232.
Effects: FX Select
This page allows you to select the A/B (Style) and C/D (Keyboard and Pads) effects.
Sty
FX AD
Wet/Dry
Mix between the effected (Wet) and direct (uneffected, Dry) signal.
Dry
Wet
nn:nn
1.
B to A, D to C
Program a footswitch, one of the EC5 pedals, or an Assignable Switch, to be the Quarter Tone switch.
Simply go to the Global mode, and reach the Controllers:
Pedal/Switch or Controllers: EC5 page. There, you will
find the Pedal/Footswitch and EC5-AE parameters,
to which you can assign the Quarter Tone function.
While still in Global mode, select the Write Global-Global
Setup command from the page menu, to save these settings
to the Global (see Write Global - Global Setup dialog box
on page 257).
2.
3.
Sty
Sty
Reference
After selecting the User scale, touch a note in the keyboard diagram, and use TEMPO/VALUE controls to adjust the selected
note tuning in cents.
88
Effects: FX AD
These pages contain the editing parameters for the four effect
processors. Here is an example of the FX A page, with the Reverb
Smooth Hall effect assigned.
This page lets you connect each track to the internal sound generator and to external MIDI devices. This is very useful to let a
Style track drive an external expander, or play a digital piano
with one of Pa1Xs Keyboard tracks. In addition, here you can set
the polyphony mode for each track.
Selected effect
FX parameters
Selected effect
Sty
SB
Select one of the available effects from this pop-up menu. This is
equivalent to the FX AD parameters found in the Effects:
FX Select page (see above).
Note: Effects can be different for each of the four editing pages.
FX parameters
Sty
SB
Sty
SB
Mix between the effected (Wet) and direct (uneffected, Dry) signal. This is the same as the Wet/Dry parameters found in the
Effects: FX Select page (see above).
Src (Source)
Sty
SB
Sty
Internal
External
89
CC#0
CC#32
In this page you can adjust the volume for each family of Drum
and Percussion instrument for the selected track. A list of families is shown below.
PC
When touching the Sound area, the numeric keypad appears, instead of the Sound Select window.
You can enter the Control Change/Program
Change bundle shown above, separating the three
parts with a dot (.). If entering just one of the
three numbers, a Program Change message is
sent.
Both
Type
Drum
Mono
Mono Right
Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
Sty
Drum families
Kick
Snare
Tom
Toms volume.
HiHat
Hi-Hat volume.
Cymbal
Perc.1
Perc.2
EFX
Sty
Select
Use these buttons to select the track to edit. The button corresponding to the selected track turns green.
Reset Track
Press this button to reset all changes to percussive instrument
volumes in the selected track.
Reset All Tracks
Press this button to reset all changes to percussive instrument
volumes in all tracks.
Reference
Poly
90
Play/Mute icon
Sty
Decay
Release
Cutoff
Resonance
LFO Depth
LFO Speed
LFO Delay
2.
3.
4.
While listening to the Style, select the Cymb. knob, and use
TEMPO/VALUE controls to turn the volume completely
off.
Youll notice how all cymbals stops sounding.
5.
Select
Use these buttons to select the track to edit. The button corresponding to the selected track turns green.
Reset Track
Press this button to reset all changes to Sound parameters in the
selected track.
Reset All Tracks
Press this button to reset all changes to Sound parameters in all
tracks.
Play/Mute icon
Sty
If needed, while in this page press TRK. SEL. to see Keyboard tracks.
2.
3.
4.
Parameters
Attack
Sty
91
This page lets you program a key and dynamic (velocity) range
for each of the Keyboard tracks.
Key range is useful to create a set of Keyboard tracks playing in
different zones of the keyboard. For example, you may have
french horns and woodwinds playing in the center range of the
keyboard, while only woodwinds play on the higher range.
Velocity range is useful to create a sound made of up to three
dynamic layers, assigning each of the Upper tracks to a different
dynamic range.
As an example, you may assign the El.Piano 1 Program to the
Upper 1, and the El.Piano 2 Program to the Upper 2 track. Then,
set Upper 1 to [Bottom=0, Top=80], and Upper 2 to [Bottom=81, Top=127]. The El.Piano 1 will play when playing softer,
the El.Piano 2 when playing louder.
Damper
On
Off
Joystick X
This enables/disables the left/right movement of the Joystick
(Pitch Bend, and sometimes a Sound parameters control; for
Pitch Bend settings, see Mixer/Tuning: Tuning on page 86).
Joystick Y
Top/Bottom Key (Key Range)
This parameter pair sets the Top and Bottom key range for the
track.
C-1G9
Expression
This parameters allows you to switch the Expression control on/
off on each individual Keyboard track. The Expression control is
a relative level control, always subtracted from the Volume value
of the track.
As an example, imagine you have a Piano sound assigned to
Upper 1, and a Strings sound assigned to Upper 2. If you turn
the Expression switch on on Upper 2, and off on Upper 1, you
can use a continuous pedal to control only the Strings volume,
while the Piano remains unchanged.
To program a pedal or Assignable Slider to act as an Expression
control, see Controllers: Pedal/Switch on page 235 or Controllers: Assignable Sliders on page 235. You can only assign this
function to a volume-type pedal, not to a switch-type one.
Assign the KB Expression option to the pedal or Assignable
Slider, then select Write Global-Global Setup from the page
menu to save the setting to the Global.
Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
Selected key.
127
Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
Reference
92
Echo
Keyboard/Ensemble: Ensemble
This page lets you program the Ensemble function. This function harmonizes the right-hand melody (played in realtime)
using the recognized chords of the left-hand.
Note: The Ensemble function only works in Style Play mode, with
the Split Keyboard Mode.
Note Velocity
This parameter sets the velocity difference between the righthand melody and the added harmonization notes.
-100
Tempo
Note: This parameter only appears when the Trill, Repeat or Echo
options are selected.
Note value for the Trill, Repeat or Echo Ensemble options. This
is in sync with the Metronome Tempo.
Feedback
Note: This parameter only appears when the Echo option is
selected.
This parameter sets how many times the original note/chord is
repeated by the Echo option.
Ensemble
Harmonization type.
Duet
Close
Open 1
Off
Open 2
Normal
Block
Mute
Power Ensemble
Adds a fifth and an octave to the melody, as heard
in hard rock.
Fourths LO
Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Fourths UP
Fifths
Octave
Dual
Brass
Reed
Trill
Repeat
93
To Var.1To Var.4
Fill to Variation (->1, ->2, ->3, ->4) automatically selects one of the four available Style Variations at the end of the fill.
Fill Mode lock icon
Gbl
This lock prevents the Fill Mode being changed when selecting a
different Performance or Style.
This lock is reset when turning the instrument off, unless you
write Global settings to memory (see Write Global - Global
Setup dialog box on page 257).
Sty
For more information on parameter locks, see General Controls: Lock on page 232.
Sty
Track status
Track play/mute status. Press these icons to change it.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
Standard mapping.
Drum Mapping 17
Drum Map number. Mapping 1 is soft-sounding, while mapping 7 is loud-sounding.
Sty
Off
Type 13
Reference
Sty
V1&V2 V3&V4
The specified Variations will be alternatively
selected. For example, with the V1&V2 option,
Variation 1 and Variation 2 will be alternatively
selected after the end of the Fill.
Var.Up/Var.Down
The next higher/lower numbered Variation is
selected, in cycle. After Variation 4, an Up command will select Variation 1. After Variation 1, a
Down command will select Variation 4.
Var.Inc/Var.Dec
The next higher/lower numbered Variation is
Sty
Off
94
Sty
Wrap Around
Pan
The wrap-around point is the highest register limit for the backing track. The accompaniment patterns will be transposed
according to the detected chord. If the chord is too high, the
Style tracks might play in a register that is too high, and therefore unnatural. If, however, it reaches the wrap-around point, it
will be automatically transposed an octave lower.
C Send
-64-1
Center.
+1+63
D Send
112
Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Gbl
For more information on parameter locks, see General Controls: Lock on page 232.
Pad/Switch: Pad
Pad/Switch: Assignable Switch
This page lets you select a different sound for each of the four
PAD buttons.
This page lets you select a different function for each of the four
ASSIGN. SWITCH buttons.
Pad
assignment
Older
sounds
Note: You can also assign different Sounds from the Pad panel of
the main page.
Pad assignment
SB
Name of the Hit or Sequence assigned to each Pad. Press the box
to make the Pad Select window appear (see Pad Select window
on page 75).
Older sounds
SB
To warrant compatibility with data generated prior to OS version 2.0, the name of the older sounds assigned to the Pads is
shown under each Pad assignment box. As soon as you select a
new Hit or Sequence, the name of the older sound disappears.
Volume
Volume for each of the four Pad tracks.
Switch 14
Each of the four ASSIGN. SWITCH buttons. Use these pop-up
menus to assign a function to each switch. See List of Assignable Switches functions on page 380.
Assignable Switch lock icon
Gbl
Velocity Control
95
SB
Set this parameter to trigger one of the following functions simply by playing louder with your left hand. When playing with a
velocity value higher than the value set by the Velocity Control
Value parameter (see page 96), the selected function will be
activated.
This function only works in SPLIT Keyboard Mode, with the
LOWER or no Chord Scanning mode selected.
It does not work in FULL Chord Scanning mode, or in SPLIT
Keyboard Mode, with the UPPER Chord Scanning mode
selected.
Off
Fingered 2
Fingered 3
One Finger
Expert
This mode is an extension of the Fingered 2, adding rootless and slashed chord recognition, often
used in jazz, fusion, modern pop and light music.
This type of chord recognition is very useful to
play piano chords typical of jazz piano players.
You dont need to play the root note, doubling the
note already played by the bass track.
Start/Stop
Bass Inversion
When playing with a velocity higher than the
trigger value, the Bass Inversion function will be
activated.
Memory
Scale Mode
This parameter defines which tracks are affected by the selected
alternative scale (see Scale on page 86).
Keyboard tracks
The scale will only affect Keyboard tracks.
Upper tracks The scale will only affect Upper 1-3 Keyboard
tracks.
All Tracks
Memory Mode
This parameter sets the way the MEMORY button works.
Chord
Chord + Lower
When its LED is on, the MEMORY button keeps
the recognized chord in memory, and keeps the
Lower track held until the next note or chord is
played. When its LED is off, the chord is reset
when raising the hand from the keyboard, and
the Lower track is not sustained.
Fixed Arr. + Lower
When its LED is on, the MEMORY button keeps
the Lower track held until the next note or chord
is played. When off, the Lower track is not sustained when raising the hand from the keyboard.
The chord is always kept in memory.
Reference
96
Lock icon
Gbl
Sty
This lock is reset when turning the instrument off, unless you
write Global settings to memory (see Write Global - Global
Setup dialog box on page 257).
On
At startup, the LED of the STYLE CHANGE button will automatically turn on.
Off
At startup, the LED of the STYLE CHANGE button will stay off.
For more information on parameter locks, see General Controls: Lock on page 232.
Sty
Use this parameter to set a velocity value over which to automatically trigger the Style Start/Stop or select a Style Element (see
Velocity Control above).
In this page you can set various general parameters for the Style
Play mode.
Off
Midi Setup
On
Sty
Sty
When the SPLIT Keyboard Mode is selected, and the Style is not
running, this function lets you play a simple accompaniment
with your left hand.
Sty
Sty
Off
Page menu
97
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.
Select the track to be soloed, and check this item. You will hear
only the selected track, and the Solo warning will flash on the
page header.
Uncheck this item to exit the Solo function.
The Solo functions works in a slightly different way, depending
on the selected track:
Keyboard track: The selected Keyboard track is the only track
you can hear when playing on the keyboard. All other Keyboard
tracks are muted. The status of the Style tracks is unaffected.
Style track: The selected track is the only Style track you can
hear. All other Style tracks are muted. The status of the Keyboard
tracks is unaffected.
Copy/Paste FX
You can copy a single, or all four effects, between Styles, Performances, STSs and Songs. To do this, choose the Copy FX and
Paste FX commands from the page menu of the Style Play,
Song Play or Sequencer modes.
3.
Select this command to open the Write Current Style Performance dialog box, and save Style track settings to the Style Performance of the current Style.
4.
See Write Single Touch Setting dialog box on page 98 for more
information.
2.
3.
4.
Reference
Write Performance
98
Name
Name
Perf Bank
Current Style
Non editable. Settings are saved in one of the four STSs belonging to the current Style. This parameter displays the name of the
parent Style.
Performance
STS
Target STS location. The name of the STS currently saved at the
target location is shown. Use TEMPO/VALUE controls to select
a different location.
Select button
Press this button to open the Performance Select window, and
select a target location.
symbol
99
You can expand the internal memory User Styles with nine additional banks residing on the hard disk (optional on the Pa1X
with speakers). When both LEDs of the leftmost STYLE button
are lit, the DIRECT HD banks are selected. No loading is
required.
Use the first nine STYLE bank buttons to select these banks.
Each bank can include up to 32 Styles; browse them using the
PAGE buttons.
The DIRECT HD Styles are contained in three folders, inside the
DIRECTHD folder you can find in the hard disks root. These
folders, automatically created by the Pa1X, have fixed names:
Style Bank
Non editable. Bank of Styles the current Style belongs to. Each
bank corresponds to one of the STYLE buttons.
Folder name
BANK123.SET
1, 2, 3
BANK456.SET
4, 5, 6
BANK789.SET
7, 8, 9
Current Style
Non editable. Name of the current Style.
While in Disk mode, you can save any Style into the
DIRECT HD folders. See below the relevant procedure.
More information on the disk procedures are in the Disk
chapter.
2.
Parameters saved in the Style Play Setup area of the Global are
marked with the
Sty
Reference
Sty
100
3.
While the All item is selected, press Open to open it. The
internal memory content appears.
Note: Reading from floppy disk may take some seconds, before the
Styles are shown.
When the Style Select window opens, browse through the
DIRECT FD Styles. There are up to 12 pages, and up to 96
DIRECT FD Style locations in a disk.
Note: Reading from floppy disk is a little slower than reading from
the internal memory or the hard disk. So, there is a chance that you
will have to wait some beats, before the selected DIRECT FD Style
is ready to play. The Style will start at the next beginning of measure.
Select the Style folder, and press Save To, to make the target device directory appear.
6.
7.
8.
9.
2.
3.
4.
While the All item is selected, press Open to open it. The
internal memory content appears.
5.
Select the Style folder, and press Save To, to make the target device directory appear.
101
7.
8.
9.
Press the
(Text Edit) button. When the Text Edit dialog box opens, name the new folder DIRECTFD. Press
OK to confirm.
Reference
6.
10. Press OK to close the Create New SET Folder, and return to
102
Chord
Pop Ballad
CV1 CV6
CV1 CV2
Maj
6
Variation 1
Variation 2
M7b5
um
rc
ss
Variation 3
Sus4
Variation 4
Sus2
M7sus4
Intro1
min
m6
c3
c4
c5
CV2
M7
CV1
m7
CV2
m7b5
mM7
Intro 2
CV3
Intro 3/C.In
7
7b5
7sus4
CV4
Fill 1
dim
Fill 2
dimM7
CV5
CV6
aug
Fill 3/Break
Ending 1
aug7
augM7
no 3rd
Ending 2
no 3rd, no 5th
103
What to record
Recording a Style is a matter of recording tracks, inside a series
of Chord Variations, inside a series of Style Elements, inside the
Style itself.
When editing an existing Style, the original Style Performance is recalled, but the following parameters are reset to
their default values: Drum Mapping (Off), Kick & Snare
Designation (Off), Original Style Sound (On), Keyboard
Range (On). This means that you can hear some differences
between the Style in play and the same Style being edited;
for example, resetting the Drum Mapping may lead to
some instruments being replaced.
While the Style Record mode is where you can create or edit
music patterns for the Style, track parameters (like Sounds, Volume, Pan, Octave Transpose, FX settings) have to be edited in
Style Play mode.
Style Import/Export
As an alternative to creating Styles on the Pa1X, you can use
Korgs Style To Midi application to import a Standard MIDI
Files (SMF) from your computer to a Pa1Xs Style. The application is freely downloadable from www.korgpa.com. Please read
the included instructions.
After editing the Style, please save it (see Exit by saving or deleting changes below) and exit the Style Record mode. Then, while
in Style Play mode, edit the Style Performance to adjust track
settings (Tempo, Volume, Pan, FX Send see page 84 and following in the Style Play operating mode chapter) and save it by
selecting the Write Current Style Performance from the page
menu (see Write Style Performance dialog box on page 99).
Note: After a record or edit operation, the memory is automatically reorganized. Therefore, when you press START/STOP
there is a delay before you can actually listen to the Style. This
delay is higher with a Style containing more MIDI events.
Note: While in Record mode, the footswitch and EC5 pedals are
disabled. On the contrary, volume/expression-type pedals can
be used.
Reference
You dont need to record all Chord Variations for all Style Elements. It is often only needed to record just a Chord Variation
for each Style Element. Exceptions are the Intro 1 and Ending 1,
where we suggest to record both a Major and minor Chord Variations.
104
The Style Record mode filters out some events that may cause
wrong operation of the Style. Here are the recorded events, and
the most important filtered-out events.
Control function
Note On
Note Off (a)
Pitch Bend
Modulation 1
Modulation 2
Pan
10
Expression
11
While you are in Style Record mode, you can listen to the
selected Chord Variation or to the whole Style, depending on
the page you are in.
CC#12
12
CC#13
13
Damper
64
Filter Resonance
71
74
CC#80
80
CC#81
81
CC#82
82
When you are in the Main, Event Edit, Quantize, Transpose, Velocity, or Delete pages, you can listen to the
selected Chord Variation. Press START/STOP to check
how it works. Press START/STOP again to stop the playback.
Not allowed
Program Change
After Touch
(a). A Note Off will always be inserted at the end of the Chord Variation.
Volume
105
Measure number
After pressing the REC button, and having chosen whether you
want to edit an existing Style or create a new one, the main page
of the Style Record mode appears, with the tab Record 1
selected.
Page sub-header
Page header
Recording
parameters area
Selected
track info
area
Key/
Chord
area
Note: When this parameter and the assigned value is in small letters (cv1cv6), the Chord Variation is empty; when it is in capitals
(CV1CV6), it is already recorded.
Track volume/status area
Page header
This line shows the current operating mode, transposition and
recognized chord.
If Style Element is Var1, Var2, Var 3 or Var4, you can select one
of 6 Chord Variations to edit.
If Style Element is Intro1, Intro2, Intro3, Fill1, Fill2, Fill3,
Ending1 or Ending2, you can select one of 2 Chord Variations to
edit.
Resolution
Use this parameter to set the quantization during recording. Quantization is a way of correcting timing errors;
notes played too soon or too later are moved to the nearest
axis of a rhythmic grid, set with this parameter, thus
playing perfectly in time.
Master Transpose
(in semitones)
Master transpose
Master transpose value in semitones. This value can be changed
using the TRANSPOSE buttons on the control panel.
High
No quantization applied.
(1/32) (1/8)
Grid resolution, in musical values. For
example, when you select 1/16, all notes are
moved to the nearest 1/16 division. When
you select 1/8, all notes are moved to the
nearest 1/8 division. A 3 after the quantization
Page sub-header
This area shows some performing info on the Style.
Style in record/edit
Beat counter
Measure number
Style in record/edit
No quantization
1/16
1/8
This indicator shows the current beat inside the current measure.
Reference
Operating mode
name
106
This is not the total length of the Chord Variation, but just of the
current track. For example, you may have a Chord Variation
eight measures long, with a drum pattern repeating each two
measures. If so, set the CV Length parameter to 8, and the Rec
Length parameter to 2 before starting recording the Drum
track. When playing back the Style, saving it or executing any
edit operation on the Style, the 2-measures pattern will be
extended to the full 8-measures length of the Chord Variation.
Warning: If you assign CV Length a value lower than Rec
Length, the value of Rec Length is not immediately updated in
the display. Therefore, you are still free of changing the value of
CV Length, before the measures exceeding its value are deleted
(see warning in CV Length (Chord Variation Length) below).
However, if you press START/STOP to begin recording, the real
Rec Length value is changed to the new one, even if the display
still shows the old value.
For example, you may have CV Length = 4 and Rec Length = 4.
If you set CV Length to 2, and press START/STOP to begin
recording, Rec Length is still shown as 4, but it is in reality set to
2, and recording will cycle for just 2 measures. After you press
START/STOP to stop recording, Rec Length is updated to 2, and
all measures after the second measure are deleted.
Meter
This is the meter (time signature) of the Style Element. You can
edit this parameter only when the Style Element is empty, i.e.
before you begin recording anything.
NTT (Note Transposition Table)
The Note Transposition Table (NTT) determines how the
arranger will transpose pattern notes, when a chord is recognized that does not exactly match the original chord of a Chord
Variation. For example, if you only recorded a Chord Variation
for the CMaj chord, when a CMaj7 is recognized on the keyboard the arranger must transpose some notes to create the
missing 7th.
Note: To conform to Korg specifications, it is advisable to set the
NTT to No Transpose on the Intro 1 and Ending 1.
Root
Fifth
i-Series
NoTrnsp
As recorded with
NTT = Root or 5th
(Key/Chord = CMaj)
Metro (Metronome)
As recorded with
NTT = i-Series
(Key/Chord = CM7)
No metronome click will be heard during recording. In any case, a one-bar precount will be
played before starting recording.
On1
On2
This line lets you see the Sound assigned to the selected track.
Tempo
Track name
Sound bank
Sound name
Hint: You can always change the Tempo, when other parameters
are selected, by keeping the SHIFT button pressed, and rotating the
DIAL.
Track name
Note: The actual tempo of the Style will be the one shown when
saving the Style Performance in Style Play mode (see Current
tempo on page 79).
Sound name
Program Change
Sound assigned to the selected track. The triangle means you can
press the name to open the Sound Select window, and select a
different Sound.
107
Sound bank
Program Change
Program Change number. Shown only when the Show Program
Change number parameter is turned on in Global mode. (See
page 234).
Key/Chord area
Key/Chord
This parameter pair allows you to define the tracks original key
and chord type, for the current Chord Variation. When in Style
Play mode, this chord will be played back exactly as it was
recorded, without any NTT processing (see above).
To record just one Chord Variation for a Style Element, the suggested original key/chord is maj7 (with NTT = i-Series). Be
very careful to play the 7th+ note (i.e., with a Cmaj7th key/
chord, the B), to avoid the lack of notes, or a bad NTT conversion when playing different chords.
In the example above, you will record the Acc1 track in the AMajor key, with notes pertaining to the A7th scale. This exact pattern will be recalled, when an A7th chord will be recognized.
Reference
108
While in the main page, press the Record 2 tab to see this page.
Most parameters in this page are the same as in Main page Record 1. In addition, here you can see and select Sounds for
each Style track.
Sounds
area
Preparing to record
1.
2.
Press the REC button to enter the Style Record mode. You
are prompted to select either the Current Style, or a New
Style.
Sounds area
This area lets you see Sounds and octave transposition for the
eight Style tracks.
Octave icon
Sound name
3.
After you select your preferred option, the main page of the
Style Record mode will appear.
4.
Octave icon
Non editable. This indicator shows the tracks octave transposition. To change this value, go to the Mixer/Tuning: Tuning edit
page in the Style Play mode (see page 86). Save this value to the
Style Performance.
Sound name
Name of the Sound assigned to the track. Touch a name a first
time to select the corresponding track (detailed information are
shown on the Selected Track Info area, see above). Touch it a second time to open the Sound Select window.
Note: These Sounds can be replaced by Sounds selected by a Performance, provided the Original Style Sounds parameter is left
unchecked in Style Play mode (see page 80).
6.
7.
8.
Press the Record 2 tab to see the Sounds area. Here you can
assign the right Sound to each Style track. You cannot select
Digital Drawbars Sounds. (For more details, see Sounds
area on page 108).
9.
109
1.
1.
While in the main page of the Style Record mode, select the
Overdub Step Recording command from the page menu,
to enter the Overdub Step Record mode.
2.
3.
To change the step value, use the Step Time values area in
the display.
4.
To insert a rest, just press the Rest button in the display. Its
length will match the step value.
To insert a chord or a second voice, see Chords and second voices in Step Record mode below.
5.
6.
At this point, you may go on, inserting new events in overdub mode (the previously inserted events will not be
deleted). This is very useful when recording a drum or percussion track, where you may want to record the bass drum
on a first cycle, the snare drum on the second cycle, and the
hi-hat and cymbals during the following cycles.
Note: You can select a different track only when the arranger
is not running.
4.
When finished recording the Chord Variation, select a different Chord Variation or Style Element to go on recording
the full Style.
5.
7.
When finished recording, press the Done button in the display to exit the Step Record mode.
When back to the main page of the Style Record mode, you
may turn all tracks to the play status, then press START/
STOP to listen to the Style. Press START/STOP again to
stop the playback.
8.
From the main page of the Style Record mode, select either
the Write Style or the Exit from Record command to
exit from the Style record mode, respectively by saving the
Style to memory, or by canceling any change (see Write
Style dialog box on page 123).
Reference
Ex.2:
You are not obliged to insert single notes in a track. There are
several ways to insert chords and double voices. Lets look at
some.
Step Time =
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
On
Press C
Ex. 1:
Off
Release E (continue holding C)
Step Time =
On
Press G
Off
Release G and C
Off
Release G and C
On
Press F and C
Step Time =
Step Time =
Step Time =
Off
Release F
(continue holding C)
Step Time =
On
Press E and C
Step Time =
Off
Release G
(continue holding C)
Step Time =
On
Press G (continue holding C)
Ex.3:
Step Time =
Entering a second voice. You can insert passages where one note
is kept pressed, while another voice moves freely.
Step Time =
Tie
110
On
Press E
(continue holding C)
On
Press G
(continue holding C)
On
Press D
(continue holding C)
Step Time =
Off
Release E and C
Step Time =
Off
Release D
(continue holding C)
111
Edit menu
Operating mode
Edit section
Page menu
icon
From any page (apart for Step Record), press the MENU button
to open the Style Record edit menu. This menu gives access to
the various Style Record edit sections.
When in the menu, select an edit section, or press EXIT to exit
the menu and return to the main page. To return to the main
page, you can also select the Main Page menu item.
Parameters
area
Track status
Tabs
Operating mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Style Record mode.
Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 111).
Selected Style Element
Note: While the Style is in play, you cannot access the Edit section
pages from the main page (see page 105). Stop the playback before
pressing MENU.
Note: When switching from the Edit section pages (Quantize,
Transpose, Velocity, Delete) to the other pages, or vice-versa, the
Style (if in play) is automatically stopped.
Edit section
Track status
Selected Style
Element
Page menu
icon
Selected
track info
Parameters
area
Tabs
Reference
112
Position
The Event Edit is the page where you can edit each single MIDI
event of the selected Chord Variation. You can, for example,
replace a note with a different one, or change its playing strength
(i.e., velocity value). See Event Edit procedure on page 113 for
more information on the event editing procedure.
Page sub-header
Page header
You can edit this parameter to move the event to a different position. You can edit a position in either of the following ways:
(a) select the parameter, and use the TEMPO/VALUE controls
to change the value, or
(b) select the parameter, then touch it again; the numeric keypad will appear. Enter the new position by dialing in the
three parts of the number, separated by a dot. Zeroes at the
beginning can be omitted, as well as the least important
parts of the number. For example, to enter position
002.02.193, dial 2.2.193; to enter position 002.04.000 dial
2.4; to enter position 002.01.000, simply dial 2.
Event list
Tabs
Scrollbar
Page header
See Page header on page 105.
Page sub-header
This area shows some performing info on the Song.
Event type
Value 1
Value 2
Note
Note name
Velocity
Ctrl
Bend
Bending value
To change the event type, select the Type parameter, then use the
TEMPO/VALUE controls to select a different event type. A set of
default values will be automatically assigned to the event.
To select and edit the events value, select the corresponding
parameter, and use TEMPO/VALUE controls.
Length
Selected track
Selected Style
Element
Selected Chord
Variation
Selected track
Name of the track in edit. Use the Track pop-up menu to select
one of the Style tracks.
SE/CV (Style Element/Chord Variation)
Selected Style Element and Chord Variation. This parameter
cannot be edited. To select a different Style Element and Chord
Variation, press EXIT to go back to the main page of the Style
Record mode (see Main page - Record 1 on page 105).
Length of the selected Note event. The value format is the same
as the Position value. This is only available for Note events.
Note: If you change a length of 000.00.000 to a different value,
you cant go back to the original value. This rather uncommon
zero-length value may be found in some drum or percussion tracks.
Scrollbar
Use the scrollbar to browse the event through the list.
Other elements
Track pop-up menu
Event list
Use the Event list to see all events contained in the selected track
in the selected Style Element.
Use the scrollbar to browse through the events. You can also
scroll by using the SHIFT + DIAL combination.
Touch the event to be selected. Selected events are highlighted
and can be heard.
Use this pop-up menu to select the track to edit, inside the current Chord Variation.
DrumAcc5 Style track.
Go Meas./Catch
This is a dual-function command.
While the sequencer is not running, it works as a Go to Measure command. Press it to open the Go to Measure dialog box:
9.
113
For more information on the event types and their values, see Event Edit: Event Edit on page 112.
Select the Style to edit, and press the REC button. Select the
Current Style option to enter recording. The main page
of the Style Record mode will appear.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Press MENU, and select the Event Edit section. The Event
Edit page appears (see Event Edit: Event Edit on page 112
for more information).
17. When finished editing the whole Style, select the Write
Press START/STOP to listen to the selected Chord Variation. Press START/STOP to stop it. Chord Scanning does
not work, so you will listen the pattern at the original Key/
Chord.
Press the Filter tab to select the Filter page, and uncheck the
filters for the event types you wish to see in the display (see
Event Edit: Filter on page 114 for more information).
6.
Press the Event Edit tab to go back to the Event Edit page.
7.
Use the Track pop-up menu to select the track to edit (see
Track pop-up menu on page 112).
8.
Reference
When in this dialog box, select a target measure, and press OK.
The first event available in the target measure will be selected.
114
This page is where you can select the event types to be shown in
the Event Edit page.
The quantize function may be used to correct any timing mistake after recording, or to give the pattern a groovy feeling.
Turn On the filter for all event types you do not wish to see in
the Event Edit page.
Note: Some of the events are ghosted, and non editable, since the
corresponding events are not editable in a Style.
Note/RX Noise
Control
Track
Control Change events. Only the following Control Change numbers are allowed with Styles.
Control function
Use these parameters to select the Style Element and Chord Variation for editing.
Modulation 1
Resolution
Modulation 2
Pan
10
Expression(a)
11
CC#12
12
This parameter sets the quantization after recording. For example, when you select 1/8, all notes are moved to the nearest 1/8
division. When you select 1/4, all notes are moved to the nearest
1/4 division.
CC#13
13
Damper
64
Filter Resonance
71
74
CC#80
80
CC#81
81
CC#82
82
No quantization
1/8
1/4
(1/32) (1/4)
Grid resolution, in musical values. A bf character added after the value means swing-quantization. A 3 means triplet.
Start / End Tick
Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to quantize.
If a Chord Variation is four measures long, and you want to
select it all, the Start will be positioned at 1.01.000, and the End
at 5.01.000.
Bottom / Top Note
Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to quantize. If you select the same note as the Bottom and
Top parameters, you can select a single percussive instrument in
a Drum or Percussion track.
Note: These parameters are available only when a Drum or Percussion track is selected.
Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.
Track status icon
Status of tracks. Press this icon to change the status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
115
Track names
Under the buttons, a label for each track is shown.
Reference
All
All
116
Value
Advanced
When this checkbox is checked, the Intensity, Curve, Start
Velocity Value and End Velocity Value parameters can be
edited.
Intensity
(Only available in Advanced mode). Use this parameter to specify
the degree to which the velocity data will be adjusted toward the
curve you specify in Curve.
0100%
Intensity value. With a setting of 0 [%], the velocity will not change. With a setting of 100 [%], the
velocity will be changed the most.
Curve
Use these parameters to select the Style Element and Chord Variation for editing.
Curve 2
127
127
Velocity
Velocity
Velocity
Start
Value
End
Value
Start
Value
Curve 3
127
End
Value
Start
Length
Number of measures to be cut.
Start
Value
End
Value
Execute
Curve 5
Curve 4
Curve 6
127
127
127
Velocity
Velocity
Velocity
Start
Value
End
Value
Start
Value
End
Value
RANDOM
Start
Value
(Only available in Advanced mode). Velocity change at the starting and ending ticks of the selected range.
Track names
0100
Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.
117
Execute
Use these parameters to select the Style Element and Chord Variation for editing.
Track
Play status. The track can be heard.
Event
Type of MIDI event to delete.
All events. The measures are not removed from
the Chord Variation.
Note
Dup.Note
After Touch
Ctl.Change
Track
CC00/32CC127
Single Control Change events. Double Control
Change numbers (like 00/32) are MSB/LSB bundles.
All
Drum-Acc5
Reference
All
118
Use these parameters to select the Style Element and Chord Variation for editing.
Use these parameters to select the source and target Style Elements or Chord Variations.
All
All
Var1End2
Var1CountIn
Single Style Element.
V1-CV1CI-CV2
V1-CV1E2-CV2
Single Chord Variation.
From To Track
Use this parameter to select the source and target track to copy.
You can double a track, to strengthen a pattern.
All
Drum-Acc5
1 2 3 4
After setting the various parameters, press Execute.
Note: If you copy too many events on the same tick, the Too
many events! message appears, and the copy operation is aborted.
Note: When you copy over an existing Chord Variation, Program
Change data is not copied, to leave the original Sounds unchanged
for that Chord Variation.
From Style
Choose this option to select the source Style to copy the track,
Chord Variation or Style Element from. Press the Select button
to open the Style Select window and select the source Style.
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4
the source will be copied once, then the fist 2 measures will
be copied to fit the remaining 2 measures.
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 1 2
Note: Avoid copying to a Chord Variation with a different meter,
for example a 4/4 Chord Variation onto a 3/4 one.
119
Expression area
Use these knobs to set the Expression (CC#11) value for the corresponding track. This value can be seen at the beginning of the
Event Edit list (see Event Edit: Event Edit on page 112).
Different Expression values can be defined for each Style Element. This way, you can set a different volume in each Style Element, relative to the general Volume value set in the Style
Header.
Volume area
Use these controls to set the volume and status of each track. See
page 107 for more information.
The Volume value is the same for the whole Style. Use the
Expression controls to adjust the relative balance between tracks
in each Style Element.
Reference
Different Keyboard Range values can be set for each Style Element.
When in this page, press the corresponding button on the control panel to select a Style Element (VARIATION1
ENDING2).
To copy the settings of this page to another Style Element, use
the Copy Sound and Copy Expression commands from the
page menu (see Copy Sounds dialog box and Copy Expression dialog box starting from page 124).
Sounds area
See Sounds area on page 108 for detailed information.
120
Volume area
Use these controls to set the volume and status of each track. See
page 107 for more information.
Perc
Bass
Acc
This is the page where you can assign a Chord Variation to each
of the most important recognized chord. When a chord is recognized, the assigned Chord Variation will be automatically
selected by the arranger to play the accompaniment.
Trigger Mode
This setting lets you define how Bass and Acc-type tracks are
retriggered when the chord is changed.
Off
Rt
Rp
When in this page, press the corresponding button on the control panel to select a Style Element (VARIATION1
ENDING2).
Chord / Chord Variation
Use these parameters to assign a Chord Variation to each of the
most important chords.
When in this page, press the corresponding button on the control panel to select a Style Element (VARIATION1
ENDING2).
Track Type
Use this parameter to set the type of the corresponding track.
Drum
Tension
Tension adds notes (a 9th, 11th and/or 13th) that have actually
been played to the accompaniment, even if they haven't been
written in the Style pattern. This parameter specifies whether or
not the Tension included in the recognized chord will be added
to the Acc-type tracks.
On
Off
121
The Import SMF function allows you to import MIDI data from
a Standard MIDI File (SMF) created on your preferred external
sequencer, and transform them in a Chord Variation.
Reference
Note: You cannot use this function to import data from any generic
Song. The Standard MIDI File to be imported must be programmed as if it was one of Pa1Xs Chord Variations.
122
Pa1X Track
Bass
10
Drum
11
Percussion
12-16
Accompaniment 1-5
Export SMF
The Export SMF function allows you to export a Chord Variation as a Standard MIDI File (SMF), and edit it on your preferred external sequencer.
To Song
Initialize
Check this parameter if you want all settings of the target Style
Element (i.e., Key/Chord, Chord Table, Sounds) are reset
when loading the SMF.
Hint: It is a good idea to check the Initialize parameter when
importing the first Chord Variation of a Style Element, and
uncheck it when importing the following Chord Variations.
From E/CV
Use this pop-up menu to select one of the available Chord Variations from the current Style.
Execute
To E/CV
Use this parameter to select a target Chord Variation.
Execute
After setting all parameters in this page, press this button to
import the Standard MIDI File into the target Chord Variation.
123
Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the page menu. Press a command to select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the
menu without selecting a command.
Only available while in the Style Element Chord Table page. Select
this command to open the Cpy Chord Table dialog box (see
Copy Chord Table dialog box on page 124).
Delete Current Track
Select this command to delete the selected track.
Overdub Step Recording
Select this command to open the Overdub Step recording window (see Overdub Step Recording window on page 125).
Solo Track
Select the track to be soloed, then check this item. You will hear
only the selected track, and the Solo warning will flash on the
page header.
Uncheck this item to exit the Solo function.
Exit from Record
Select this command to exit from Record without saving changes
to the Style.
Write Style
Select this command to open the Write Style dialog box, and save
the Style to the internal memory.
See Write Style dialog box on page 123 for more information.
Undo
Only available in Record mode. While in Record mode, cancels
the latest recorded data and restores the previous situation.
Selected a second time, it restores recorded data again (Redo
function).
Open this window by choosing the Write Style item from the
page menu. Here you can save the recorded or edited Style to
memory, by choosing either a User or Direct HD bank.
Copy Expression
Name
See Copy Expression dialog box on page 124 for more information.
Copy Keyboard Range
symbol
Style Bank
Target bank of Styles. Each bank corresponds to one of the
STYLE SELECT buttons. Use TEMPO/VALUE controls to select
a different bank.
Style
See Copy Key Range dialog box on page 124 for more information.
Note: A User Style is usually prompted when writing a Style. However, you can overwrite a Factory Style, when the Factory Style
and Pad Protect parameter is left unchecked (see page 272).
Reference
Copy Sound
124
Select button
Var1CountIn
Single Style Element where to copy settings to.
Press this button to open the Style Select window, and select a
target location.
While in the Style Select window, use the buttons on top of the
window to select either the User or the Direct HD banks.
To Style Element
Target Style Element.
To Style Element
All
Var1CountIn
Single Style Element where to copy settings to.
Var1CountIn
Single Style Element where to copy settings to.
Open this window by choosing the Copy Chord Table item from
the page menu. Here you can copy the Chord Table of the current Style Element to a different Style Element.
To Style Element
From Style Element
All
To Style Element
Var1CountIn
125
Free Memory
Staccatissimo.
50%
Staccato.
85%
Ordinary articulation.
100%
Legato.
Velocity
Set this parameter before entering a note or chord. This will be
the playing strength (i.e., velocity value) of the event to be
inserted.
Kbd
Keyboard. You can select this parameter, by turning all counter-clockwise the dial. When this
option is selected, the playing strength of the
played note is recognized and recorded.
1127
Style track.
SE (Selected Style Element)
See Element (Style Element) on page 105.
Rest
Press this button to insert a rest.
Tie
Back
Pos (Position)
Event list
Previously inserted events. You may delete this event, and set it
in edit again, by pressing the Back button.
Step Time values
Length of the event to be inserted.
Note value.
Triplet (3)
Meter
Meter of the current measure. This parameter cannot be edited.
You can set the Meter in the main page of the Style Record mode,
before actually starting recording (see step 6 on page 108 for
more information).
Goes to the next measure, and fills the remaining space with
rests.
Done
Exits the Step Record mode.
Reference
DRUMACC5
126
By entering the Pad Record mode, you can create your own Pads,
or edit an existing Pad.
To enter Pad Record mode, go to the Style Play mode and press
REC. The Style/Pad Record Select window appears.
Pad
CV1
Pad Track
CV2
CV3
CV4
CV5
CV6
What to record
Recording a Pad is a matter of recording a single track, inside a
series of Chord Variations, inside the Pad itself.
You dont need to record all Chord Variations. It is often only
needed to record just a Chord Variation.
127
The Main page of the Pad Record mode looks like a simplified
version of the Main page of the Style Record mode, with just a
single track to be recorded and no Style Elements to be chosen.
The only addition is the Pad Sync parameter.
When you are in the Main, Event Edit, Quantize, Transpose, Velocity, or Delete pages, you can listen to the selected
Chord Variation. Press START/STOP to check how it
works. Press START/STOP again to stop the playback.
When you are in the Sounds/Expression, Keyboard Range,
Chord Table, Trigger/Tension, Delete All, Copy, Style Element Controls or Style Control pages, you can listen to the
whole Pad. Press START/STOP and play some chords to do
your tests.
Note: In this mode, the pattern is always played back in loop, even
if the Pad Type parameter is set to One Shot (see page 133).
Note: While in Pad Record mode, the Fingered 3 Chord Scanning
mode is automatically selected.
PAD
Continued
Reference
While you are in Pad Record or Pad Edit mode, you can listen to
the selected Chord Variation. To select a Chord Variation, go to
the Main page of the Record/Edit mode.
128
Beat
Root
Fifth
i-Series
NoTrnsp
PAD
for the CMaj chord, when a CMaj7 is recognized on the keyboard the arranger must transpose some notes to create the
missing 7th.
As recorded with
NTT = Root or 5th
(Key/Chord = CMaj)
As recorded with
NTT = i-Series
(Key/Chord = CM7)
PAD
This parameter sets the total length (up to 32 measures) for the
selected Chord Variation. When playing a Style, this will be the
length of the accompaniment pattern, when the chord corresponding to the Chord Variation is recognized on the keyboard.
Warning: If you reduce the Chord Variation Length after
recording, any measure after the selected length will be deleted.
Be very careful when setting the CV Length to a lower value
after recording! If it happens, we suggest to exit from record
without saving (see Exit from Record on page 136).
Note: The NTT does not work if the Track Type parameter is set
to Drum.
Metro (Metronome)
This line lets you see the Sound assigned to the selected track.
Off
No metronome click will be heard during recording. In any case, a one-bar precount will be
played before starting recording.
On1
On2
Tempo
Select this parameter to use TEMPO/VALUE controls to set the
tempo.
Note: This value will not be recorded, and will only be used for testing the pattern at various speeds while editing or recording.
Hint: You can always change the Tempo, when other parameters
are selected, by keeping the SHIFT button pressed, and rotating the
DIAL.
Meter
Sound name
Program Change
Sound name
PAD
Sound assigned to the Pad track. The triangle means you can
press the name to open the Sound Select window, and select a
different Sound.
Sound bank
PAD
PAD
PAD
This is the meter (time signature) of the sequence. You can edit
this parameter only when the sequence is empty, i.e. before you
begin recording anything.
NTT (Note Transposition Table)
Sound bank
PAD
129
Virtual slider
Edit menu
Key/Chord area
Key/Chord
PAD
This parameter pair allows you to define the tracks original key
and chord type, for the current Chord Variation. When playing
the pattern back, this chord will be played back exactly as it was
recorded, without any NTT processing (see above).
Note: The Pad Edit pages are a simplified version of the Style Edit
pages. See the Users manual for information on the various
parameters.
Note: While the Pad is in play, you cannot access the Edit section
pages from the main page (see page 127). Stop the playback before
pressing MENU.
Note: When switching from the Edit section pages (Quantize,
Transpose, Velocity, Delete) to the other pages, or vice-versa, the
Pad (if in play) is automatically stopped.
Operating mode
Edit section
Page menu
icon
Pad track
info
Parameters
area
Tabs
Reference
130
Edit section
Page menu
icon
Parameters
area
Tabs
Operating mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Pad Record mode.
After setting the various parameters, press Execute.
Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 129).
CV (Chord Variation)
Use this parameters to select the Chord Variation for editing.
Resolution
Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 135).
Parameters area
Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to quantize.
Tabs
Use tabs to select one of the edit pages of the current edit section.
Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.
Page header
Event list
Tabs
Scrollbar
This is very similar to the Style Records Event Edit page. See the
Users Manual for more information on the event editing procedure.
131
Value
Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to be modified.
Advanced
When this checkbox is checked, the Intensity, Curve, Start
Velocity Value and End Velocity Value parameters can be
edited.
Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.
Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.
CV (Chord Variation)
CV (Chord Variation)
Start
Value
Length
Number of measures to be cut.
Intensity
(Only available in Advanced mode). Use this parameter to specify
the degree to which the velocity data will be adjusted toward the
curve you specify in Curve.
Curve
(Only available in Advanced mode). Use this parameter to select
from six types of curve, and specify how the velocity will change
over time.
Start / End Vel. Value
(Only available in Advanced mode). Velocity change at the starting and ending ticks of the selected range.
Start / End Tick
Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to be modified.
Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.
Reference
132
Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to delete.
Note: These parameters are available only when the All or Note
option is selected.
Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.
Note
CV (Chord Variation)
Dup.Note
After Touch
Pitch Bend
All
CV1CV6
Execute
Here you can copy a track from a Style, and transform it into a
Pad pattern.
CC00/32CC127
Single Control Change events. Double Control
Change numbers (like 00/32) are MSB/LSB bundles.
Warning: The Copy operation deletes all data at the target location
(overwrite).
Ctl.Change
Note: If you copy too many events on the same tick, the Too
many events! message appears, and the copy operation is aborted.
Note: When you copy over an existing Chord Variation, Program
Change data is not copied, to leave the original Sounds unchanged
for that Chord Variation.
133
From Pad
Choose this option to select the source Pad to copy the Chord
Variation from. Press the Select button to open the Pad Select
window and select the source Pad.
From CV (Chord Variation)
From Style
Choose this option to select the source Style to copy the track
from. Press the Select button to open the Style Select window
and select the source Style.
All
CV1CV6
V1-CV1E2-CV2
To CV (Chord Variation)
Use this parameter to select a target Chord Variation inside the
current Pad.
CV1CV6
To CV (Chord Variation)
Use this parameter to select a target Chord Variation inside the
current Pad.
CV1CV6
In this page you can assign a Sound to the Pad track, adjust its
Volume (CC#07) and Expression (CC#11) values, and set various other parameters, like the Keyboard Range, Track Type,
Trigger Mode, Tension and Wrap Around.
Execute
Press this button to execute the operation set in this page.
Reference
Sound/Bank
PAD
PAD
Use this parameter to decide if the Pad will play once or if it will
loop.
Note: While in Pad Record mode, the pattern is always played back
in loop, even if this parameter is set to One Shot.
One Shot
When you press one of the PAD buttons, the corresponding Pad is only played once. This is useful
for playing Hits or Sequences than must only play
once.
Loop
When you press one of the PAD buttons, the corresponding Pad plays up to the end, then continues playing from the start. Press STOP in the PAD
section to stop it playing. This is useful for playing cyclic sequences.
134
Expression
PAD
Use this knob to set the Expression (CC#11) value for the Pad
track. This value can be seen at the beginning of the Event Edit
list.
The Expression is useful to balance the Pad with the other Pads.
For example, if you want the Pad you are recording is mellower
than the average, just lower the Expression value.
Volume
Use this slider to set the Volume (CC#07) value for the Pad track.
This value is not saved with the Pad, and is only used to test the
Pads volume during editing or recording.
Keyboard Range
PAD
PAD
Wrap Around
PAD
The wrap-around point is the highest register limit for the Pad
track. The Pad pattern will be transposed according to the
detected chord. If the chord is too high, the Pad track might play
in a register that is too high, and therefore unnatural. If, however, it reaches the wrap-around point, it will be automatically
transposed an octave lower.
The wrap-around point can be individually set in semitone steps
up to a maximum of 12 semitones, relative to the chord root set
in the main page of the Pad Record mode (see Key/Chord on
page 129).
112
(Not available if Track Type = Drum). This setting lets you define
how Bass and Acc-type tracks are retriggered when the chord is
changed.
Off
Rt
Rp
Track Type
PAD
PAD
Bass
Acc
Tension
PAD
Tension adds notes (a 9th, 11th and/or 13th) that have actually
been played, even if they haven't been written in the Pad pattern.
This parameter specifies whether or not the Tension included in
the recognized chord will be added to an Acc-type track.
On
Off
135
From
Use this parameter to select one of the MIDI Groove patterns
(.GRV files) generated when saving data after a Time Slice
operation.
To CV (Chord Variation)
Export: SMF
The Export SMF function allows you to export a Chord Variation as a Standard MIDI File (SMF), and edit it on your preferred external sequencer.
To Song
This (non-editable) parameters shows the name of the Standard
MIDI File to be generated. The (automatically assigned) name
will be the same of the exported Chord Variation.
From CV
Use this pop-up menu to select one of the available Chord Variations from the current Pad.
When programming a Chord Variation on the external
sequencer, please assign the Pad track to the MIDI channel #10.
Note: Only SMF in format 0 can be loaded.
Execute
After selecting a Chord Variation, press this button to export it as
a Standard MIDI File. A standard file selector will appear. Select
the target device and directory, then press Save.
From Song
Select
Press this button to open the file selector and load the SMF.
Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the page menu. Press a command to select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the
menu without selecting a command.
Initialize
Check this parameter if you want all Pad settings (i.e., Key/
Chord, Chord Table, Sound) are reset when loading the SMF.
Hint: It is a good idea to check this parameter when importing the
first Chord Variation of the Pad, and uncheck it when importing
the following Chord Variations.
To CV
Use this parameter to select a target Chord Variation.
Execute
After setting all parameters in this page, press this button to
import the Standard MIDI File into the target Chord Variation.
Write Pad
When done recording or editing a Pad, and you want to save the
changes, select this command to open the Write Pad dialog box,
and save the Pad to the internal memory.
See Write Pad dialog box on page 136 for more information.
Undo
Only available in the Main page of the Pad Record mode, and in
some Pad Edit pages. While in Record mode, cancels the latest
recorded data and restores the previous situation. Selected a second time, it restores recorded data again (Redo function).
Reference
136
Parameters saved in the Pad are marked with the PAD symbol
through the users manual.
Name
PAD
137
Sequencer 1
Sequencer 2
Track parameters
Keyboard track settings made in Song Play mode may be saved
to a Performance. You can recall different settings by just selecting a different Performance.
Settings for Song tracks, like pan, volume and FX sends, depend
on the midifile.
Changes to Song tracks made in Song Play mode cannot be
saved to the midifile, and are intended just for realtime editing.
To permanently save changes to the various Song parameters,
use Sequencer mode.
Transport controls
You can use the separate transport controls for each of the two
onboard sequencers. Use the SEQUENCER 1 controls for
Sequencer 1, and SEQUENCER 2 controls for Sequencer 2. See
SEQUENCER 1 TRANSPORT CONTROLS on page 10 for
more information).
Reference
The native Song file format of the Pa1X is the Standard MIDI
File (SMF), an universal standard set by all manufacturers. You
can read these files with any musical instrument or computer.
MIDI Clock
138
CC#99
(MSB)
CC#98
(LSB)
CC#06
(Data Entry)
Vibrato Rate
0127(a)
Vibrato Depth
0127(a)
Vibrato Decay
10
0127(a)
Filter Cutoff
32
0127(a)
Resonance
33
0127(a)
EG Attack Time
99
0127(a)
EG Decay Time
100
0127(a)
EG Release Time
102
0127(a)
20
dd(b)
0127(a)
21
dd(b)
0127(a)
22
dd(b)
0127(a)
23
dd(b)
0127(a)
24
dd(b)
0127(a)
25
dd(b)
0127(a)
Drum Volume
26
dd(b)
0127
Drum Panpot
28
dd(b)
0127(a)
29
dd(b)
0127(a)
30
dd(b)
0127(a)
NRPN
Note: These control s are reset when stopping the Song, or selecting
a new Song.
Press here to
select a Performance
Press here to
select a Style
Keyboard
tracks volume and Play/
Mute status
139
Recognized chord
Main page
Press SONG PLAY to access this page from another operating
mode.
Note: When switching from Style Play to Song Play, the Song Setup
is automatically selected, and various track parameters may
change.
To return to this page from one of the Song Play edit pages, press
the EXIT or SONG PLAY button.
Page header
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. See Page menu on
page 155 for more information.
Songs area
This is where Song names are shown, together with parameters
depending on the selected type of Song.
The following illustration shows parameters appearing when a
Standard MIDI Files has been selected.
Song type icon
Song name
Current measure
Meter
Tempo
Keyboard
tracks
area
Style
area
Song name
Total
time
Elapsed time
All Songs
Seq.1
Seq.2
Page header
This line shows the current operating mode, transposition and
recognized chord.
Master Transpose
(in semitones)
Recognized
chord
Song name
Elapsed time
Total
time
Seq.1
Seq.2
Panels
Operating mode
name
Seq.1
Seq.2
SB
Seq. 1/2
A different Song may be assigned to each of the two onboard
sequencers (Seq.1 and Seq.2). Each sequencer has its own
parameters.
Reference
Perf./
STS
area
140
Meter
Performance/STS area
When the Song Select window appears, you can select a single
Song or a Jukebox file (see Song Select window on page 76).
If you select another Song while a Song is in play within the same
Sequencer, the old Song stops, and the new Song will be selected,
ready to play.
To select a Song, you can also press the SELECT button (on the
control panel) corresponding to the desired sequencer. Press
SELECT a second time to select a Song by dialing in its ID number (see Selecting a Song by its ID number on page 77).
Selected Performance
or STS
Style area
Upper 1
UP2
Upper 2
UP3
Upper 3
LOW
Lower
You can also transpose all Upper tracks by using the UPPER
OCTAVE buttons on the control panel.
Track name
Track status
Sound name
SB
Note: You can save this setting into the Global-Song Play Setup (by
choosing the Write Global-Song Play Setup command from the
page menu), to leave the track status unchanged when selecting a
different Standard MIDI File. This way, you can leave, for example,
the bass track in mute, and let you bassist play it live.
SB
However, the above is not true when reading a Standard MIDI File
created with a Pa-Series instrument. These files do include special
commands to force the Play/Mute status of each track.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Panels
Sound bank
The lower half of the main page contains the various panels, you
can select by pressing the corresponding tabs. See more information in the relevant sections, starting from page 143.
SB
Volume panel
Program Change
SB
Tabs
Reference
Sound
bank
SB
Selected Style
Sound
name
141
142
Program Change
Sounds area
This area lets you see Sounds and octave transposition for the
eight tracks currently displayed.
Selected track
info area
Song track octave
transpose
Sounds area
Sound name
Sound name
Name of the Sound assigned to the track. Touch a name a first
time to select the corresponding track (detailed information are
shown on the Selected Track Info area, see above). Touch it a second time to open the Sound Select window.
Songs area
Despite a different layout, it works as the Song area in the Normal view.
Track name
Sound bank
Sound name
Program Change
Track name
Name of the selected track.
Sound name
Sound assigned to the selected track. Press anywhere in this area
to open the Sound Select window, and select a different Sound.
Sound bank
Bank the selected Sound belongs to.
143
Volume panel
Press the Volume tab to select this panel. This is where you can
set the volume of each track, and mute/unmute tracks.
Use the TRK. SEL. (TRACK SELECT) button to switch from
Normal (Keyboard and Mic/In tracks) to Song Tracks 1-8 and
Song Tracks 9-16 views.
If the VOLUME LED above the SLIDER MODE button is turned
on, the Assignable Sliders LEDs show which view is currently
selected.
The assigned function may be saved to a Performance. Therefore, when selecting a Performance, the assigned function may
change.
Track status icons
The Normal view shows grouped Style tracks, Mic/In controls,
Keyboard tracks (upper sliders LED turned on):
SB
Play/mute status of the current track. Select the track, then press
this area to change the track status. The status of Keyboard
tracks may be saved to a Performance or STS.
See Keyboard track status on page 141 for more information.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
The Song Tracks 1-8 view shows individual Song tracks 1-8
(third sliders LED turned on):
Track names
Under the sliders, a label for each track is shown. Use the TRK.
SEL button to switch between the various track views.
MIC/IN
The Song Tracks 9-16 view shows individual Song tracks 9-16
(last sliders LED turned on):
LOWER
Lower track.
T01T16
Jukebox panel
Track status icon
Virtual slider
SB
SB
Reference
144
Jukebox file
Song list
Use this list to browse through the Songs in the Jukebox list. Use
the scrollbar to scroll the list.
Selected Song
Current measure
Press this button to select the Song highlighted in the list, and
assign it to Sequencer 1. If a Song is already playing, it will be
stopped, and the selected Song will start playing back.
Recorgnized chord
Selected
sequencer
Jukebox file
Song
name
Name of the selected Jukebox file. To edit this file, see Jukebox
Editor on page 151.
Display
options
PAUSE
While the Song is playing, the text flows in the display. Chord
abbreviations (if any) will appear above the lyrics, in time with
the music (depending on the Show Chords parameter status,
under the Options side tab). Lyrics at the current position are
highlighted.
Song chords
Chords contained in the midifile (if any). This indicator may be
easier to read than chords shown within the lyrics.
(PLAY/STOP)
Starts or stops the current Song. When you stop
the Song, the sequencer goes back to measure 1 of
the current Song.
If the Jukebox panel is open, you can select the
Song from which to start. See Jukebox panel
above.
Current measure
Current measure number.
Recognized chord
Chords played on the keyboard, and recognized by the chord
scanning engine.
Selected sequencer (SEQ 1/SEQ 2)
Use these side tabs to select a sequencer whose Song to show.
Note: You can have Sequencer 2 selected in the Main page of the
Song Play mode, and Sequencer 1 selected in the Lyrics page, or
vice-versa. This way, you can select a Song whose lyrics to display
on the external video monitor, while selecting a different sequencer
for editing operations.
145
Song name
Song assigned to the selected sequencer. Use the side tabs SEQ 1
and SEQ 2 to select a sequencer whose Song to show.
1.
2.
Press this side tab to access the Options panel, and adjust the
various video settings (see details below).
1.
2.
3.
Display Controls
If you press Add within the first beats of the measure, the
beginning of the current measure is saved as a marker.
Use these parameters to define how lyrics are shown in the display.
If you press Add within the last beat of the measure, the
beginning of the followng measure is saved as a marker.
Characters
4.
5.
2.
Sng
Sng
Sng
1.
2.
3.
While in Edit Marker window, you can edit the name and
position of the marker being edited.
When linking a .TXT file to a Song, you scroll the text by using
the Text Down and Text Up assignable commands. Unlike the
reading of Lyrics events contained in a Standard MIDI File, there
is no automatic scrolling, that make the current verse start on
top of the internal and the external display at the same time.
Sng
Reference
146
choose the internal or the external display as the one that must
be perfectly lined.
Int. Video
Ext. Video
Mic panel
Select this panel to set parameters for the microphone input. See
Mic panel on page 82 for details.
Sub-Scale panel
Pad panel
Select this panel to see which Hit or Sequence Pads are assigned
to the four Pads. See Pad panel on page 83 for details.
However, unlike ordinary Lyrics, the text will not scroll automatically while the Song is playing back. You must scroll it with the
DIAL. As an alternative, you can use an assignable switch or
footswitch, with the Text Page Up or Text Page Down functions
assigned, to scroll (respectively) to the previous or next text
page.
Note: When a .TXT file is loaded with the Song, it overrides any
included Lyrics data.
Split panel
Select this panel to adjust the split point for the Keyboard tracks.
See Split panel on page 83 for details.
147
Parameters area
Edit menu
From any page, press the MENU button to open the Song Play
edit menu. This menu gives access to the various Song Play edit
sections for the currently selected sequencer (see Songs area
on page 142).
Page menu
icon
Selected
track info
Parameters
area
Mixer/Tuning: Volume/Pan
This page lets you set the volume and pan for each of the Keyboard or Song tracks.
Note: Song parameters cannot be saved when saving to a Performance or STS.
Note: A muted track may be reset when selecting a different Song.
Tabs
Operating mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Song Play mode.
Selected sequencer
Before entering edit, select one of the two sequencers, by using
the Song area of the main page (see Switching between
sequencers during editing below).
Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 147).
Page menu icon
Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 155).
Reference
Selected
Operating mode sequencer
148
Use the TRK. SEL. button to switch from the Keyboard to the
Song tracks, and vice versa.
Off
Volume
SB
Tracks volume.
0127
Play/Mute icon
SB
Sng
Mixer/Tuning: FX Send
This page lets you set the level of the tracks direct (uneffected)
signal going to the Internal FX processors.
Note: Song parameters cannot be saved when saving to a Performance or STS.
The effect processors included in Pa1X are connected in parallel,
so you can decide which percentage of the direct signal can be
effected:
Upper Volume Link
Track
Sty
Off
FX Processor
In case you do not want to send a tracks direct signal to the output, but only the effected signal (as when using insert effects,
like Rotary, Distortion, EQ), just set the Pan to Off (see Pan
above):
Track
Pan
SB
Center.
+1+63
Out L/R
Out L/R
FX Processor
There are four Internal FX processors in Song Play mode. Usually, they are arranged as follows:
FX A
FX B
FX C
FX D
149
Mixer/Tuning: Tuning
Parameters in this page let you set various tuning settings. See
Mixer/Tuning: Tuning on page 86 for details.
Parameters
SB
Note: Song track values edited in this page are not saved, and are
only intended for realtime use.
Effects: FX Select
This page allows you to select effects to be assigned to the four
Internal FX processors (A-D).
Note: When you stop the Song, or select a different Song, the
default effects are selected again. You can, however, stop the Song,
change the effects, then start the Song again. Edit the Song in
Sequencer mode to permanently change the effects.
Note: When you stop, then start the Song again, or select a different
Song, the default Song track settings are selected again. You can,
however, pause the Song, change the effects, then exit fro pause and
start the Song again. Edit the Song in Sequencer mode to permanently change the effects.
SB
SB
Play/Mute icon
SB
Sng
Sng
SB
Sng
Mix between the effected (Wet) and direct (uneffected, Dry) signal.
Dry
Wet
nn:nn
B to A, D to C
SB
Sng
Sng
Reference
FX AD
150
Wet/Dry
Mix between the effected (Wet) and direct (uneffected, Dry) signal. This is the same as the Wet/Dry parameters found in the
Effects: FX Select page (see above).
Src (Source)
SB
SB
Sng
Sng
Parameters
SB
Sng
These parameters let you adjust the volume for each percussive
instrument family. See Track Controls: Drum Volume on
page 150.
Effects: FX AD
Parameters
These pages contain the editing parameters for the four effect
processors. Here is an example of the FX A page, with the Reverb
Smooth Hall effect assigned.
SB
Note: Song track values edited in this page are not saved, and are
only intended for realtime use.
Selected effect
SB
Note: Song track values edited in this page are not saved, and are
only intended for realtime use.
Selected effect
SB
Sng
Select one of the available effects from this pop-up menu. This is
the same as the FX AD parameters found in the Effects: FX
Select page (see above).
FX parameters
SB
Sng
Parameters
SB
151
These parameters let you select a note and velocity range for the
Keyboard tracks. See Keyboard/Ensemble: Key/Velocity Range
on page 91.
To create a new Jukebox file, press Del All to remove all Songs or
the current list. Add new Songs, then press Save and enter a different name before confirming. A new Jukebox file will be saved
to disk.
Parameters
Move Up/Down
SB
Keyboard/Ensemble: Ensemble
Add
Adds a Song at the end of the current list. You can add up to 127
Songs in a list.
SB
Note: A Jukebox list can include only Songs contained in the same
folder.
Hint: Instead of a single Song, you can select a Jukebox file, and
add its whole content to the current Jukebox list.
Pad/Switch: Pad
Insert
See Pad/Switch: Pad on page 94.
Parameters
SB
Hint: Instead of a single Song, you can select a Jukebox file, and
insert its whole content to the current Jukebox list.
SB
This command lets you delete the selected Song from the list.
Jukebox Editor
The Jukebox function lets you play a list of Songs (127 max), at
the simple touch of a button. You can play a Jukebox file by
assigning it to Sequencer 1, after having selected it in the Song
Select page, just as if it was an ordinary Song (see Jukebox
panel on page 143).
Press this button to save the Jukebox file to disk. The Save Jukebox File dialog box appears, allowing you to edit the name and
save your file to disk.
Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window,
and edit the name.
In this page, you can create, edit and save a Jukebox file. A Jukebox list can contain Standard MIDI Files, Karaoke files, and
MP3 files. (Note: MP3 files are only supported with the EXBPMP3 option installed).
If you are editing an existing list, and do not change its name, the
old file is overwritten. If you change it, a new file will be created
on disk.
If you are saving a new list, the NEWNAME.JBX name is automatically assigned, and you can edit it.
Note: You can save your .JBX file only in the same folder as the
Song files included in the list.
Reference
Del All
152
Groove Quantize
No quantization
1/8
1/4
100
Swing
Note: Groove Quantize parameters are not saved, as they are only
intended for realtime use.
50
100
Enable
Enables/disables quantization. It is automatically set to Off each
time the instrument is turned on, or when selecting a different
Song.
Hint: You can enable/disable the Groove Quantize also by selecting
the Seq.1-Groove Quantize Enable command from the page
menu.
Swng=50
Swng=25
Note Start
Enables/disables quantization of the Note On event (i.e. beginning of the note).
Swng=75
Note Duration
Enables/disables quantization of the Note Off event (i.e. the
length of the note).
Window
Resolution
100
The quantize window extends to the nearest window; all events are quantized.
(1/32) (1/4)
Grid resolution, in musical values (a 3 after the
value means triplet). For example, when you
select 1/8, all notes are moved to the nearest 1/8
Win=0
Win=50
Win=100
153
Global
Note: These settings are stored in the Song Play Setup area of the
Global file (together with all the other parameters marked with the
abbreviation in the manual). After changing these settings,
select the Write Global-Song Play Setup command from the page
menu to save them to the Global.
Sng
Melody
Sng
This parameter selects the Songs Melody track. This track can be
muted using the Melody Mute function, assignable to an
Assignable Switch, Footswitch or EC5 pedal.
Drum
Sng
Midi Setup
Bass
Sng
This parameter selects the Songs Bass track. This track is left set
to play (together with the Drum track) when selecting the
Drum&Bass function, assignable to an Assignable Switch,
Footswitch or EC5 pedal.
Harmony Track
Sng
The Voice Processor gets the chord notes (as well as Program
Change messages) from the track selected with this parameter.
No track sends notes to the Harmony module of
the Voice processor. Chords can still be received
from the MIDI IN.
Seq.1-Track 116
Chords are sent from one of Sequencer 1 tracks.
Seq.2-Track 116
Chords are sent from one of Sequencer 2 tracks.
Seq.1+2 Track 116
Notes are sent by a track with the same name
from both Sequencer 1 and Sequencer 2.
Warning: If both sequencers are generating notes at
the same time, the harmonizer will receive notes
from both sequencers. Be warned that notes are sent
to the harmonizer even when the BALANCE slider
Sng
Sng
On
Reference
This parameter selects the Songs Drum track. This track is left
set to play (together with the Bass track) when selecting the
Drum&Bass function, assignable to an Assignable Switch,
Footswitch or EC5 pedal.
Off
Note: These settings are stored in the Song Play Setup area of the
Global file (together with all the other parameters marked with the
154
Sng
On
Seq.2 FX Mode
CD
Lyrics
Markers
Seq.1
Lyrics
Markers
Seq.2
Fast Play
SEQ 1 Best GM Sound
SEQ 2 Best GM Sound
Sng
Sng
Sng
Sng
Sng
Note: This function does not work on songs created or edited with
the Korg Pa1X, or any other a Pa-Series instrument. This is to prevent changing the original users sound assignment.
Press this button to see the current path of each sequencer. This
lets you know where currently selected Songs are located in the
disks.
If you save these paths to the Global, by selecting the Write Global-Song Play Setup command from the page menu, the first
time you will open the Song Select window, after turning the
instrument on, the selected path will be selected by default.
Link Mode
Sng
Measure
Beat
155
Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.
Note: When saved, the text file will be named after the selected
Jukebox file. For example, a Jukebox file named Dummy.jbx will
generate a Dummy.txt file. A new, unnamed Jukebox file will
generate a New_name.txt file. If a file with the same name
already exists on the floppy disk, it will be overwritten without
waiting for any confirmation.
The list will include the progressive number assigned to each Song,
file names in MS-DOS format (8.3), the total number of files in the
list.
For the correct display and printing of the list on a personal computer, use a fixed size (i.e., non-proportional) character in your text
editor.
Seq.1-Groove Quantize Enable
Enables/disables the groove quantize (see Groove Quantize on
page 152). It is automatically unchecked each time the instrument is turned on, or when selecting a different Song.
Note: Groove Quantize only works on Sequencer 1.
Write Performance
Solo Track
Select the track to be soloed, and check this item. You will hear
only the selected track, and the Solo warning will flash on the
page header.
Select this command to save the current Jukebox list as a text file
to a disk. Here is how it works.
1.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Select an option.
If you select the floppy disk, insert a floppy disk in the
disk drive, and press OK to confirm.
1.
2.
Reference
156
3.
4.
Parameters saved in the Song Play Setup area of the Global are
marked with the
Sng
SongBook
Book
157
SongBook
The SongBook is an onboard database that allows you to organize various musical resources (Style, Standard MIDI Files,
KAR files, and optionally MP3 files) for easy retrieving.
The SongBook mode overlaps the Style Play and Song Play operating modes. When you select an entry from the database, the
Style Play or Song Play mode is automatically selected, depending on the type of file associated with the entry.
In addition to helping you organize your shows, the SongBook
allows you to associate up to four STSs to each Standard MIDI
File or MP3, played back in Song Play mode. This way, it is easy
to recall a complete setup for Keyboard tracks, effects, and the
Voice Processor, for realtime playing over a midifile or MP3.
For more information on using the SongBook, see the Quick
Guide (starting from page 56).
Note: SongBook entries do not include actual data, but only a
pointer to a Style in memory, a Standard MIDI File, or an MP3
file. When you copy a SongBook file, referenced files are not copied
with it.
Warning: If you load a SongBook list from disk (.SBD file), the
existing one in memory is deleted. Save your old SongBook list
before loading a new one.
List Header
The List Header may change, depending on the type of data
associated with the selected entry.
Book
The Book page contains the full database of song entries (i.e., an
.SBD file). While in this page, you can select an entry, and press
the Select button in the display to start playback.
You can touch one of the heading labels above the list to change
the order in which entries are shown. For example, by touching
the Name label, the list is alphabetically re-ordered according
to the file names. The selected label turns red, showing the currently selected ordering.
Main list
Scrollbar
Scrollbar
Use the scrollbar to scroll the entries.
Commands
Commands
Each entry of this database may include the songs author, name,
genre, original key, tempo and meter. When selecting one of the
entries, the associated Style, MP3 or Standard MIDI File is automatically recalled.
Filtered
When this box is checked, only entries matching the selected filter criteria are shown in the Main list. The box is automatically
checked when you exit from the Filter dialog box by pressing OK
(see below).
Reference
Main list
158
SongBook
Book
Filter
Press this button to open the Filter dialog box, and select one or
more filter criteria, to show a restricted set of entries in the main
list.
Press the
(Text Edit) button next to the search criteria you
want to edit (Name, Genre, or Artist). You can also select a
Meter, or a range of Tempo values.
Press the Clear button next to the search criterion you want to
delete or set to a default value.
To see the Key column again, select the Show Key (now Song
Numbers) command from the page menu.
To select a SongBook entry by entering its number, press the
SONGBOOK button again while you are in any page of the
SongBook mode. The numeric keypad will appear, allowing you
to enter the number corresponding to the desired entry.
Add to list
Select an entry, then press this button to add the selected entry
to the current Custom List (see Custom List on page 162).
Select
Press this button to confirm selection of the highlighted entry in
the main list. After pressing this button, the name of the selected
entry appears in the left upper corner of the display (N:).
When you select a song in any of the SongBook lists, its name
appears in reversed text, over a dark-blue background. While in
this situation, the song is selected, but not yet in play.
Then go to the Global > MIDI > Midi In Channel page, to assign
a MIDI channel to the special Control channel. Assign the Control option to one of the sixteen available MIDI channels (usually one of the higher-numbered ones).
When you press the Select button in the display, the song starts
to play. The blue background turns to green, to show the Song is
selected and currently in play.
If you plan to use a different MIDI channel for the Style Play and
Song Play modes, repeat the above to create a second MIDI
Setup.
SongBook
Book Edit 1
the Style Play mode. Select the Write Global-Song Play Setup
command from the page menu.
159
Book Edit 1
After the initialization string has been sent, you must send the
selection string, made of two Control Change messages: CC#06
(Data Entry MSB) for the thousands and hundreds, and CC#38
(Data Entry LSB) for the tens and units. The range of the Data
Entry controls, in this case, is 0~99 (instead of the typical
0~127).
The following examples show some typical situations.
Header
Name
Name of the selected song entry. The name is assigned after you
press the Write button to save the entry to the SongBook list.
Resource
Style, Standard MIDI File or MP3 associated with the saved
entry.
Warning: If you replace this resource with a different one, carrying
the same disk path and name (in case of a Standard MIDI File or
MP3) or memory location number (in case of a Style), the SongBook entry will no longer point to the right data. Be careful not to
delete or move a Style or a file associated with a SongBook entry
from the original location.
Database Area
Genre
Music genre associated with the entry.
Artist
Name of the artist of the song associated with the entry.
Reference
160
SongBook
Book Edit 1
Key Info
Write STS
Original key of the entry. The first field is the key name, the second one is the mode (major or minor).
Tempo
Meter Info
Basic meter of the Style, or starting meter of the Standard MIDI
File associated with the entry. This may change, if a Meter
Change event is included with the associated resource.
M.Transp. (Master Transpose)
Master Transpose. When the entry is selected, the Master Transpose for the whole instrument is automatically changed (unless
the Master Transpose is locked).
Note: The Master Transpose value saved with the SongBook entry
overrides any Master Transpose setting contained in the referenced
Song.
Resource Area
One of the four STS available for each entry, where you can save
the current settings for Keyboard tracks and the Voice Processor.
Buttons
Press this button to create a new entry. Settings are copied from
the currently selected Style, Standard MIDI File or MP3. The
selected resource will be shown in the Resource Name field
(see above).
New Song
Del Song
Press this button to delete the current entry.
Resource Name
Write
Press this button to open the Write Song dialog box, and save the
current entry to the main list of the SongBook.
(Text Edit)
SongBook
Book Edit 2
161
Book Edit 2
The Book Edit 2 page is where you select Style options to be
memorized, link a .TXT file, and assign a unique number to
the current entry.
Reset
Browse
SB
Here you can select a unique number (up to 9,999) to be associated to the current SongBook entry. By typing this number after
pressing the SONGBOOK button again, you will be able to
quickly recall an entry from the Book page (see Numeric selection of entries on page 158).
Assigning a number is not mandatory, but may help you to organize your entries. For example, you can use the different 100s to
create a different way of categorizing your entries by genre or
age.
SB
Off
On
Linked .TXT
SB
You can select a text (.TXT) file, and link it to the Style or Song
associated with the current SongBook entry. When you select
this entry, the text file is automatically loaded.
Text files can be seen in the display and in an external monitor
(provided the VIF-3 Video Interface has been installed). Since
there is no automatic synchronization between this kind of lyrics
and the associated songs, you must scroll them manually. This
can be accomplished in either of two ways:
Track Number
The chosen track is selected when choosing the (SMFbased) SongBook entry.
Reference
162
SongBook
Custom List
Custom List
List Edit
Use this page to select and use one of the available Custom Lists
(i.e., one of the .SBL files saved in the same folder as the .SBD
SongBook file). Custom Lists are lists made of entries extracted
from the main SongBook list (as seen in the Book page). They
allow the use of smaller, customized SongBook lists, suitable for
a single gig or your own music tastes.
This page is only available after checking the Enable List Edit
command in the page menu (see page 164).
Use this page to edit the available Custom Lists. A Custom List is
a set of SongBook entries, created by selecting items from the
Main List.
To add entries to a Custom List, first create or select the list to be
edited in this page. Then, go to the Book page, select the entry to
be added, and press the Add to list button. When finished adding entries, return to this page and edit the selected list.
List Header
Custom list
List Name
Scrollbar
Custom list
Scrollbar
Commands
Hint: You can jump to this page by keeping SHIFT pressed, and
pressing the SONGBOOK button.
Commands
List header
See List Header on page 157.
List Name
Custom list
Name of the selected list. To select a Custom List, go to the Custom List page and use the List pop-up menu.
List of files contained in the selected Custom List. Use the scrollbar to browse through the list.
Scrollbar
Custom list
List of songs contained in the selected Custom List. Use the
scrollbar to browse through the list.
Scrollbar
Commands
List pop-up menu
Use this pop-up menu to select one of the available lists.
Commands
Next
Move
Del Song
Select
Press this button to delete the selected song entry from the list.
New List
Hint: This command is useful to browse through the list, and select
an entry different than the following one in the list.
Del List
SongBook
Lyrics/STS
163
Write
Press this button to save changes to the selected Custom List.
Lyrics/STS
The Lyrics/STS page is where you can see Lyrics and select STSs.
Note: You cannot scroll a single line of text at a time; you always
scroll by a whole page of text, either if you press on the scrollbar or
one of the small scrolling arrows.
In Song Play mode, you can see lyrics contained in a Standard MIDI File as Lyrics events, or in an MP3 with Lyrics
file. To see this kind of lyrics you must press the Lyrics tab
in the Song Play mode.
In SongBook mode, you can see lyrics contained in a Standard MIDI File as Lyrics events, or in an MP3 with Lyrics
file. To see this kind of lyrics you must press the Lyrics/STS
tab in the SongBook mode.
Reference
164
SongBook
Info
Info
Page menu
Use the Info page to see the name of the selected entry, the associated resource(s), the total number of Songs in the SongBook,
the number of filtered entries, the number of available Custom
Lists, and the number of Songs in the current list.
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.
Artist/Genre
Select this command to toggle between the Artist and Genre column on the SongBook list, appearing in the Book and Custom
List page.
Associated
resource(s)
Ascending/Descending
Select this command to toggle between the ascending and
descending view order of the SongBook list. The sorting order is
selected with one of the following commands.
Sort by Type/Name/Genre/Artist/Key/Tempo/Meter
Select one of these command to select the sorting order. The
selected option is shown in red above the entry list.
Enable List Edit
Select this command, and make the checkmark appear, to make
the List Edit page available.
Export as text file
Selected entry
This parameter shows the currently selected entry. If it is blank
(---), the latest selected entry has been modified, or no entry has
been selected yet.
Associated resource
Select this command to open the Export dialog box, and save the
SongBook or Custom List as a text file. The selected filtering will
be applied to the exported list, assuming the Filter button is
checked.
The dialog box is a little different, depending on the page where
you selected this command.
SongBook
Page menu
165
Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window
and assign a name to the text file to be saved to disk.
If you select the floppy disk, insert a floppy disk in the disk
drive, and press OK to confirm.
Reference
Then, select either the floppy disk or the hard disk to save the
file.
166
Transport controls
To play back a Song, use SEQUENCER 1 transport controls.
While in Sequencer mode, Sequencer 1 is used for all functions.
See SEQUENCER 1 TRANSPORT CONTROLS on page 10 for
more information.
Page header
Selected
track info
area
Sounds
area
The native Song format for Pa1X is the Standard MIDI File.
When saving a Song as a SMF, an empty measure in automatically inserted to the beginning of the Song. This measure contains various Song initialization parameters.
When an SMF is loaded, the empty measure is automatically
removed.
Page header
This line shows the current operating mode, transposition and
recognized chord.
Operating mode
name
Master Transpose
(in semitones)
167
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. See Page menu on
page 187 for more information.
This line lets you see the Sound assigned to the selected track.
Not only it is shown on the main page, but also in several edit
pages.
Song area
Track name
This is where Song name is shown, together with its tempo and
meter parameters, and the current measure.
Song type icon
Song name
Current measure
Sound bank
Sound name
Program Change
Track name
Name of the selected track.
Meter
Tempo
Sound name
Sound assigned to the selected track. Press anywhere in this area
to open the Sound Select window, and select a different Sound.
Sound bank
Bank the selected Sound belongs to.
Program Change
Touch the Song name to make the Song Select window appear,
allowing for selection of a different Song (see Song Select window on page 76).
To select a Song, you can also press the SELECT button in the
SEQUENCER 1 section of the control panel. Press SELECT a
second time to select a Song by dialing in its ID number (see
Selecting a Song by its ID number on page 77).
Sounds area
This area lets you see Sounds and octave transposition for the
eight tracks currently displayed.
Octave icon
Sound name
Meter
Current Song meter.
Measure number
Sound name
Metro
This area is where you can set the volume of each Song track,
and mute/unmute tracks.
Auto
Reference
168
The Song Tracks 1-8 view shows individual Song tracks 1-8
(third sliders LED turned on):
The Song Tracks 9-16 view shows individual Song tracks 9-16
(last sliders LED turned on):
Virtual slider
Seq
Play/mute status of the current track. Select the track, then press
this area to change the track status. The status of Song tracks is
saved when saving the Song.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Song tracks.
169
Page header
Recording
parameters area
Selected
track info
area
Multitrack Sequencer
Sounds
area
See Multitrack recording procedure on page 171 for information on the record procedure.
Page header
See Page header on page 166.
Page sub-header
This area shows some performing info on the Song.
Song name
Beat counter
Measure number
Song name
Name of the Song in record.
Beat counter
This indicator shows the current beat inside the current measure.
Measure number
Current measure you are recording.
Reference
170
Overwrite
Auto Punch
PedalPunch
Tempo
Select this parameter, and use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to
set the tempo.
Note: You can always change the Tempo, when other parameters
are selected, by keeping the SHIFT button pressed, and rotating the
DIAL.
Note: The tempo is always recorded in overwrite mode (old data is
replaced by the new data).
Meter
This is the basic meter (or time signature) of the Song. You can
edit this parameter only when the Song is empty, i.e., before you
begin recording anything. To insert a meter change in the middle
of the Song, use the Insert Measure function (see page 185).
Free memory
Remaining memory available for recording.
Resolution
Use this parameter to set the quantization during recording. Quantization is a way of correcting timing errors;
notes played too soon or too later are moved to the nearest
axis of a rhythmic grid, set with this parameter, thus
playing perfectly in time.
High
No quantization applied.
Manual
Auto
Record
(1/32) (1/8)
Grid resolution, in musical values. For
example, when you select 1/16, all notes are
moved to the nearest 1/16 division. When
you select 1/8, all notes are moved to the
nearest 1/8 division.
No quantization
Sounds area
1/16
This area lets you see Sounds and octave transposition for the
eight tracks currently displayed. See Sounds area on page 167
for more information.
1/8
No metronome click will be heard during recording. A one-bar precount will be played before
starting recording.
On1
On2
This area is where you can set the volume of each Song track,
and change track status. See Track volume/status area on
page 167.
Track status icons
Play/mute/record status of the current track. Select the track,
then press this area to change its status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
Record status. After pressing
(PLAY/STOP) to
start recording, the track will receive notes from
the keyboard and the MIDI IN connector.
2.
3.
4.
171
Page header
Note parameters
6.
7.
Press
(PLAY/STOP) to start recording. Depending on
the Metro option you selected, a 1- or 2-bars precount may
play before the recording actually begins. When it begins,
play freely.
If you selected the Auto Punch recording mode, the
recording will begin only when reaching the Start point.
If you selected the Pedal Punch recording mode, press the
pedal when you want to begin recording. Press it again to
finish recording.
Note: The Punch functions will not work on an empty Song.
At least one track must already be recorded.
8.
9.
Step
time
Buttons
Event list
Page header
This line shows the current operating mode.
Page sub-header
Track
Name of the selected track in record.
S1Tr01Tr16
Sequencer 1 track. In Sequencer mode, you
always work with Sequencer 1.
Warning: Save the Song to disk, to avoid it is lost when turning the instrument off.
Pos (Position)
10. If you wish, edit the new Song, by pressing the MENU but-
Note value.
Triplet (3)
Reference
5.
172
Back
Goes to the previous step, erasing the inserted event.
Meter
Meter of the current measure. This parameter cannot be edited.
You can set a Meter change by using the Insert function of the
Edit menu, and inserting a new series of measures with a different Meter (see Song Edit: Cut/Insert Measures on page 185).
Free Memory
Duration
Relative duration of the inserted note. The percentage is always
referred to the step value.
50%
Staccato.
2.
85%
Ordinary articulation.
100%
Legato.
3.
Velocity
Set this parameter before entering a note or chord. This will be
the playing strength (i.e., velocity value) of the event to be
inserted.
Kbd
1127
Keyboard. You can select this parameter, by turning all counter-clockwise the dial. When this
option is selected, the playing strength of the
played note is recognized and recorded.
Velocity value. The event will be inserted with
this velocity value, and the actual playing
strength of the note played on the keyboard will
be ignored.
5.
To insert a rest, just press the Rest button in the display. Its
length will match the step value.
To insert a chord or a second voice, see Chords and second voices in Step Record mode on page 110 of the Style
Record mode chapter.
Note/RX Noise
Name of the inserted Note or RX Noise. When
entering a chord, a series of dots is shown after
the name of the root note.
Vel.
Dur.%
6.
7.
When finished recording, press the Done button in the display. The main page of the Multitrack Recording mode will
appear again.
8.
Buttons
Rest
Press this button to insert a rest.
Tie
Press this button to tie the note to be inserted to the previous
one. A note with the same pitch, and the specified length, will be
created, and tied to the previous one.
With Pa1X, you are not obliged to insert single notes in a track.
There are several ways to insert chords and double voices. For
more information, see Chords and second voices in Step
Record mode on page 110 of the Style Record mode chapter.
Page header
Recording
parameters area
Selected
track info
area
B.S.
grouped
tracks area
Page header
See Page header on page 166.
Page sub-header
See Page sub-header on page 169.
No quantization applied.
Reference
173
174
(1/32) (1/8)
On2
Tempo
Metronome tempo. Select this parameter and use the TEMPO/
VALUE controls to change the tempo. As an alternative, when a
different parameter is selected, or you are in a different page,
keep the SHIFT button pressed and use the DIAL to change the
tempo of the sequencer.
Meter
(Non-editable). This parameter shows the meter of the selected
Style for reference.
1/8
Song track/Channel
Upper 1
Upper 2
Upper 3
Lower
Pad 1
Pad 2
Pad 3
Pad 4
This parameter shows the selected Performance or STS (depending on the last item selected).
To select a Performance, either press it, or press one of the PERFORMANCE/SOUND buttons (provided the PERFORMANCE
SELECT LED is turned on), to open the Style Select window and
select a different Performance (see Style Select window on
page 75).
To select an STS, use the four SINGLE TOUCH SETTING buttons under the display.
Play
Mute
The Backing Sequence track is in record. All previously recorded data will be deleted. After pressing
(PLAY/STOP) to start recording, the track
will receive notes from the keyboard and the
MIDI IN connector.
Rec
Metro (Metronome)
This parameter sets the metronome mode during recording.
Off
On1
No metronome click will be heard during recording. A one-bar precount will be played before
starting recording.
Metronome on, with a one-bar precount before
starting recording.
This area is where you can set the volume of each single Keyboard track, and mute/unmute tracks.
7.
Play your music. You can even stop the Style by pressing
START/STOP. If you stop the Style while recording, start it
again with the START/STOP button.
8.
Under the sliders, a label for each track is shown. Use the TRK.
SEL button to switch between the various track views.
MIC/IN
Audio inputs.
Lower track.
You may also edit the Song by pressing the MENU button
(see Edit menu on page 178).
9.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
(PLAY/STOP) but-
Reference
Track names
175
176
Measure
Beat
Tick
In this mode, you can only edit Songs created on the Pa1X.
When saving a Song created using the Backing Sequence (Quick
Record) recording mode, all Chord/Acc data is preserved, and
can be loaded later, to be edited again by using the Step Backing
Sequence mode.
This is the last selected Style. To insert a Style change at the current position, touch the Style name to open the Style Select window, or follow the standard selecting procedure using the
buttons of the STYLE SELECT section.
While in Sequencer mode, press the REC button and select the
Step Backing Sequence option. The Step Backing Sequence
window appears.
Page menu
icon
Parameters
area
Style
Note: Any Style Change inserted after the beginning of the measure
(i.e., to a position other than Mxxx.01.000) will be effective at the
following measure. For example, if a Style Change event has been
inserted at M004.03.000, the selected Style will be effectively
selected at M005.01.000. (This works exactly as in Style Play
mode).
Note: When inserting a Style Change, you may also insert a Tempo
Change at the same position. A Style Change will not automatically insert the Styles Tempo.
Performance
See Step Backing Sequence procedure on page 178 for information on the record procedure.
Parameters area
Side arrow ( )
The small arrow next to a parameter means that its value is effective at the current position. For example, if you are at the
003.01.000 position, and an arrow lights up next to the Chord
parameter, this means that a chord change happens at the
003.01.000 position.
Measure
This parameter shows the current position of the Step Editor. To
go to a different position within the Song, use one of the following systems:
Select this parameter, then use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to go to a different measure.
Use the Measure buttons in the display to move to a different measure. Use the Step buttons in the display to move in
steps of 1/8 (192 ticks). Use the Event buttons in the display
to jump to the next event.
Name
Type
Tension
Extension
177
Hint: Save the Song to disk, by selection the Save Song command
from the page menu, to avoid losing it when turning the instrument
off.
Hint: Insert a Style Element Off event exactly where the automatic
accompaniment must stop (at the end of the Song).
Length
This parameter will let you know where to place the following
Style Element Change. For example, if you inserted an Intro
event lasting for 4 measures, you can insert 4 empty measure
after this event, and a Variation event at the end of the Intro,
beginning at the 4th empty measure.
Done button
Done
Press this button to exit the Step Backing Sequence mode. All
changes will be saved to memory.
Insert Measure
Use this command to insert an empty measure starting from the
current measure. All Chord/Acc events contained in the current
measure will be moved to the following measure. The event at
the Mxxx.xx.000 position (i.e., exactly at the beginning of the
measure, like a Time Signature or Style change) will not be
moved.
Cut Measure
Use this command to delete the current measure. All Chord/Acc
event contained in the following measures will be moved one
measure back.
Delete All from Selected
Use this command to delete events of all types, starting from the
current position.
Note: All events on the very first tick (M001.01.000), like Perf,
Style, Tempo, Chord, Style Element selection, cannot be deleted.
Delete All Styles/Perfs from Selected
Delete All Styles Elements from Selected
Delete All Chords from Selected
Delete All Tempos from Selected
Select one of these commands to delete all events of the corresponding type, starting from the current position to the end of
the Song. To delete all events of the same type from the whole
Song, go back to the M001.01.000 position, and select one of
these commands.
Note: All events on the very first tick (M001.01.000), like Perf,
Style, Tempo, Chord, Style Element selection, cannot be deleted.
Reference
178
Edit menu
From any page, press the MENU button to open the Sequencer edit
menu. This menu gives access to the various Sequencer edit sections.
When in the menu, select an edit section, or press EXIT to exit
the menu.
When in an edit page, press EXIT or the SEQUENCER button to
go back to the main page of the Sequencer operating mode.
2.
Select the Measure parameter, and go to the desired position in the Song, by using the TEMPO/VALUE controls.
Alternatively, you can move the locator using the soft
transport buttons in the display. See Soft transport buttons on page 177.
3.
4.
5.
Exit the Step Backing Sequence recording mode, by pressing the Done button in the display.
6.
Press
(PLAY/STOP) in the SEQUENCER 1 section to
listen to the consequence of your editing. If they are fine,
Operating mode
Edit section
Page menu
icon
Selected
track info
Parameters
area
Tabs
Operating mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Sequencer mode.
Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 178).
Page menu icon
Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 187).
Parameters area
Each page contains various parameters. Use the tabs to select
one of the pages. For detailed information on the various types
of parameters, see sections starting from page 179.
Tabs
Use tabs to select one of the edit pages of the current edit section.
179
Mixer/Tuning: Volume/Pan
Mixer/Tuning: FX Send
This page lets you set the volume and pan for each Song track.
This page lets you set the level of the tracks direct (uneffected)
signal going to the Internal FX processors. The effect processors
included in Pa1X are connected in parallel, so you can decide
which percentage of the direct signal can be effected:
Use the TRK. SEL. button to switch between Song tracks 1-8 and
9-16.
Track
Out L/R
FX Processor
In case you do not want to send a tracks direct signal to the output, but only the effected signal (as when using insert effects,
like Rotary, Distortion, EQ), just set the Pan to Off (see Pan
above):
Track
Out L/R
FX Processor
There are four Internal FX processors in Sequencer mode,
grouped in two pairs (AB and CD). Usually you will create Songs
with only a pair (preferably AB), but you can create Songs using
both FX pairs. We suggest to use A and C as reverb processors,
and B and D as modulating effect processors.
Use the TRK. SEL. button to switch between Song tracks 1-8 and
9-16, and vice-versa.
Pan
L-64L-1
C 00
Center.
R+1R+63
Off
Reference
Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
FX Groups
Use this pop-up menu to select one of the two FX groups (AB or
CD).
Send level
0127
180
Play/Mute icon
Tracks play/mute status.
Play status. The track can be heard.
Mute status. The track cannot be heard.
Effects: FX Select
This page allows you to select effects to be assigned to the four
Internal FX processors (A-D).
Mixer/Tuning: Tuning
Parameters
See Mixer/Tuning: Tuning on page 86.
tracks (if any) use the basic scale set in Global mode (see
Main Scale on page 231).
Note: When you stop the Song, or select a different Song, the
default effects are selected again. You can, however, stop the Song,
change the effects, then start the Song again. Save the Song to permanently change the effects.
FX AD
Effects assigned to the corresponding effect processors. Usually,
A and C are reverbs, while B and D are modulating effects (chorus, flanger, delay). For a list of the available effects, see
Effects on page 329.
Wet/Dry
Mix between the effected (Wet) and direct (uneffected, Dry) signal.
Dry
Wet
nn:nn
B to A, D to C
Amount of the B effect going back to the input of the A effect, or
of the D effect going back to the input of the C effect.
Mod.Track (Modulating Track)
Source track for modulating MIDI messages. You can modulate
an effect parameter with a MIDI message generated by a physical
controller.
181
Effects: FX AD
These pages contain the editing parameters for the four effect
processors. Here is an example of the FX A page, with the Reverb
Smooth Hall effect assigned.
The Event Edit is the page where you can edit each single MIDI
event of the selected track. You can, for example, replace a note
with a different one, or change its playing strength. See also
Event Edit procedure on page 182 for more information on
the event editing procedure.
Scrollbar
Selected effect
Parameters
Parameters may differ, depending on the selected effect. See
Effects on page 329 for a list of available parameters for each
effect type.
Position
Position of the event, expressed in the form aaa.bb.ccc:
You can edit this parameter to move the event to a different position. You can edit a position in either of the following ways:
(a) select the parameter, and use the TEMPO/VALUE controls
to change the value, or
(b) select the parameter, then touch it again; the numeric keypad will appear. Enter the new position by dialing in the
three parts of the number, separated by a dot. Zeroes at the
beginning can be omitted, as well as the least important
parts of the number. For example, to enter position
002.02.193, dial 2.2.193; to enter position 002.04.000 dial
2.4; to enter position 002.01.000, simply dial 2.
Type
Parameter
Type of the event shown in the display. To edit it, select the
parameter and use the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change its
value.
Value 1 and 2
Values of the event shown in the display. Depending on the
selected event, the value may change. This parameter also shows
the (non-editable) End Of Track marking, when the end of the
track is reached.
Here are the events contained in ordinary tracks (1-16).
Type
First value
Second value
Note
Note name
Velocity
RX Noise
Note name
Velocity
Prog
Ctrl
Bend
Bending value
Aftt
Reference
Select one of the available effects from this pop-up menu. This is
equivalent to the FX AD parameters found in the Effects:
FX Select page (see above).
182
While the sequencer is not running, it works as a Go to Measure command. Press it to open the Go to Measure dialog box:
Type
First value
Second value
PAft
First value
Second value
Tempo
Tempo change
Volume
When in this dialog box, select a target measure, and press OK.
The first event available in the target measure will be selected.
Meter
Meter
Scale
Altered note
Note alteration(b)
QT (Quarter Tone)
Altered note
Note alteration
change(a)
(b)
(0, 50)
QT Clear (Quarter
Tone Clearing)
FXType
Effect number(c)
FXSend
Feedback send
level
(a). Meter changes cant be edited or inserted separately from a measure. To insert a Meter change, use the Insert function in the Edit section and insert a series of measures with the new meter. Existing data
can then be copied or entered to these measures
(b). To edit User Scale and Quarter Tone settings, select the first value,
then select the scales degree to edit. Edit the second value to change
the tuning of the selected note of the scale.
(c). When selecting a different effect number during this edit, default
settings will be assigned to this event.
To edit the event Type and Values, select the parameter and use
the TEMPO/VALUE controls to change their value. In case of
numeric values, you can also press them twice to open the
numeric keypad.
1.
2.
Select the Filter page, and turn Off the filter for the event
types you wish to see in the display (see Event Edit: Filter
on page 183 for more information).
3.
4.
Length
Length of the selected Note event. The value format is the same
as the Position value. Edit it in the same way.
Note: If you change a length of 000.00.000 to a different value,
you cant go back to the original value. This rather uncommon
zero-length value may be found in the drum and percussion tracks
of Songs made in Backing Sequence mode.
Track
For more information on the event types and their values, see above.
5.
6.
7.
Master
Scrollbar
Use the scrollbar to browse the event through the list. You can
also scroll by using the SHIFT + DIAL combination.
Go/Catch
This is a dual-function command.
183
8.
9.
10. When finished editing the whole Song, select the Save Song
command from the page menu to save the Song to disk. See
Save Song window on page 188 for more information on
saving a Song.
After setting the various parameters, press Execute to start the
operation.
Track
Use this parameter to select a track.
This page is where you can select the event types to be shown in
the Event Edit page.
All
Track 116
Resolution
This parameter sets the quantization value. For example, when
you select (1/8), all notes are moved to the nearest 1/8 division.
When you select 1/4, all notes are moved to the nearest 1/4 division.
No quantization
Note/RX Noise
1/4
Control
Grid resolution, in musical values. A bf character added after the value means swing-quantization. A 3 means triplet.
(1/32) (1/4)
Pa1X Controls
Controls exclusive of the Pa1X, like the FX and
Scale settings. These controls are recorded to the
Master Track, and saved as System Exclusive data.
Reference
1/8
Turn On the filter for all event types you do not wish to see in
the Event Edit page.
184
Track 116
Selected track.
Value
Velocity change value.
Start / End Tick
Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to edit.
After setting the various parameters, press Execute to start the
operation.
Track
Track 116
Selected track.
Value
Transpose value (127 semitones).
Start / End Tick
Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to transpose.
Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to edit. If you select the same note as the Bottom and Top
parameters, you can select a single percussive instrument in a
Drum track.
Advanced
When this checkbox is checked, the Intensity, Curve, Start
Velocity Value and End Velocity Value parameters can be
edited.
Intensity
0100%
Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to transpose. If you select the same note as the Bottom and
Top parameters, you can select a single note, or a single percussive instrument in a Drum track.
Intensity value. With a setting of 0 [%], the velocity will not change. With a setting of 100 [%], the
velocity will be changed the most.
Curve
(Only available in Advanced mode). Use this parameter to select
one of the six curves, and to specify how the velocity will change
over time.
Start Value = 0%, End Value = 100%
Curve 1
Here you can change the Velocity value for the notes. An
Advanced mode is available, allowing you to select a velocity
curve for the selected range. This is useful to create fade-ins or
fade-outs.
Curve 2
Curve 3
127
127
127
Velocity
Velocity
Velocity
Start
Value
End
Value
Start
Value
End
Value
Curve 5
Curve 4
127
127
Velocity
Velocity
Velocity
Start
Value
End
Value
Start
Value
End
Value
Curve 6
127
Start
Value
End
Value
RANDOM
Start
Value
End
Value
185
Event
Note
Dup.Note
After Touch
Pitch Bend
In this page you can cut or insert measures from the Song.
Ctl.Change
After the Cut, the following measures are moved back, to fill the
cut measures.
CC00/32CC127
Single Control Change events. Double Control
Change numbers (like 00/32) are MSB/LSB bundles.
Start
First measure where to begin cutting/inserting.
Length
Number of measures to be cut/inserted.
Meter
Use these parameters to set the starting and ending points of the
range to edit.
If you wish to select a four-measure sequence starting at the
beginning of the Song, the Start will be positioned at 1.01.000,
and the End at 5.01.000.
Bottom / Top Note
Use these parameters to set the bottom and top of the keyboard
range to delete. If you select the same note as the Bottom and
Top parameters, you can select a single note, or a single percussive instrument in a Drum track.
Note: These parameters are available only when the All or Note
options are selected.
Track 116
Selected track.
Master
Note: If you copy too many events on the same tick, the Too
many events! message appears, and the copy operation is aborted.
Reference
186
Mode
Use this parameter to select the Copy mode.
Merge
Overwrite
Copied data are merged with the data at the target position.
Copied data replace all data at the target position.
Track 116
Note: These settings are stored in the Sequencer Setup area of the
Seq
Global file. (Parameter of this kind are marked with the
abbreviation through the manual). After changing these settings,
select the Write Global-Sequencer Setup command from the page
menu to save them to the Global.
Repeat Times
Midi Setup
Seq
Seq
The Voice Processor gets the chord notes from the track selected
with this parameter.
Track
Off
Track 116
Selected track.
Seq.1-Track 116
Chords are sent from one of Sequencer 1 tracks.
187
Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.
Load Song
Select this command to open the Song Select window, and load a
Song to the sequencer. (See Song Select window on page 188).
Please note that in Sequencer mode the file is loaded to memory
contrary to Song Play mode, where Songs are read directly
from disk.
2.
3.
4.
Save Song
Select this command to save the new or edited Song to disk as a
Standard MIDI File. The file is automatically added the .MID
extension. After selecting this command, the Save Song page
appears (see Save Song window on page 188).
Warning: Turning the instrument off will delete the Song from
memory. Save your Song to disk to avoid losing it.
Warning: The Song is also lost when switching from Sequencer to
Style Play or Song Play mode, without previously saving the Song
to disk.
2.
3.
4.
Undo
Reference
You can copy a single, or all four effects, between Styles, Performances, STSs and Songs. To do this, choose the Copy FX and
Paste FX commands from the page menu of the Style Play,
Song Play or Sequencer modes.
188
The recorded Song is contained in RAM, and is lost when turning the instrument off. The Song is also lost when you overwrite it in Record mode, or if you confirm the warning
message when switching to the Style Play or Song Play mode.
You must save to disk any Song you wish to preserve.
This window appears when you select the Save Song command
from the page menu.
Press EXIT to exit from this page and go back to the main page
of the Sequencer operating mode without saving the Song.
Song path
Directory
Seq
Song path
This line shows the path of the location where you are saving the
Song.
Directory
This is the list of the selected devices content.
File status
Type of the
file or folder
File size
File or folder
name
Modification
date
189
Storage device
Device
Type
FD
Floppy disk
HD
Open
Opens the selected folder (item whose icon looks like this:
).
Close
Closes the current folder, returning to the parent (upper)
folder.
Save
Press this button to open the Save Song dialog box, and save the
Song to the current directory.
You may also lock the Master Transpose, to avoid unwanted transposition. See General Controls: Lock on page 232 of the Global
chapter.
As a general rule, you should use the Master Transpose (TRANSPOSE buttons on the control panel) when you need to transpose
Keyboard tracks together with the Song. You should use the Edit
mode Transpose function (see Song Edit: Transpose on page 184)
when only the Song has to be transposed.
Note: The Master Transpose value is always shown on the page
header:
1.
2.
Note: If a file is selected, just touch the storage device name to deselect it.
Select the Save Song command from the page menu. The
Save Song page appears.
3.
Select the folder where you want to save the Song into. Use
the Open and Close commands to browse open or close
folders. Use the scrollbar to browse through the files.
4.
When you are in the directory where you want to save your
Song to, press the Save button in the display.
After pressing the Save button, the Save Song dialog box
will appear.
6.
When saving a Song as an SMF, an empty measure is automatically inserted to the beginning of the Song. This measure contains various Song initialization parameters.
7.
Reference
190
icon.
Main page
Here is the main page of the Sound operating mode.
Page header
Sound Info
area
Realtime
Controls
area
In Sound mode, Pa1X receives and transmits on the same channel of the Upper 1 track. If the Global channel is assigned, notes
can be received also on this channel. See MIDI: MIDI In Channels on page 238 and MIDI: MIDI Out Channels on page 238
for more information.
FX area
Page header
Operating mode
name
Master Transpose
(in semitones)
Resonance
CC32
PC
Legato
On
While in this page, Assignable Sliders are linked to the corresponding Realtime Controls (a.k.a. Easy Sound Edit parameters).
Assignable
Slider
Realtime
Control
Assignable
Slider
Realtime
Control
1
2
Attack
LFO Depth
Decay
LFO Speed
Release
LFO Delay
Cutoff
Resonance
Note: When selecting the Write Sound command from the page
menu, current parameter values, after editing the Realtime Controls, are saved with the Sound. After saving, Realtime Controls are
set back to the default position.
Attack
Decay
FX Area
In Sound mode, the Sound uses its own effects instead of relying
on A-D effects. Two effect processors (FX1 and FX2) are available.
On/Off
Use this button to turn on or off the corresponding effect.
Note: When an effect parameter is edited, this parameter is automatically set to On.
Release
Cutoff
Note: If the FX1 and FX2 effects have been set to Off, FX Send values are set to zero when saving the Sound.
LFO Depth
Selected Effect
LFO Speed
LFO Delay
Reference
191
192
Send
Percussion
Wet/Dry
Use this knob to adjust the mix between the wet (effected) and
dry (uneffected) signal for the corresponding effect.
On/Off
Use this parameter to turn percussion on or off.
Foot
22/3
1st
Level.
Decay time.
Hard
193
Operating mode
Edit menu
From any page, press the MENU button to open the Sound edit
menu. This menu gives access to the various Sound edit sections.
When in the menu, select an edit section, or press EXIT or
SOUND to exit the menu and return to the main page. To return
to the main page, you can also select the Main Page menu item.
When in an edit page, press EXIT or the SOUND button to
return to the main page of the Sound operating mode.
Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 193).
Page menu icon
Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 211).
Selected oscillator
Reference
Here you can make basic settings for the Sound, such as basic
oscillator settings, the oscillator count, and the polyphonic
mode.
Use these radio buttons to specify the basic Sound type; whether
it will use one or more oscillators (up to five).
Edit section
Page menu
icon
Selected
oscillator
Parameters
area
Mono
Single Trigger
Tabs
194
On
When the same note is played repeatedly, the previous note will be silenced before the next note is
sounded, so that the notes do not overlap.
Off
When the same note is played repeatedly, the previous note will not be silenced before the next
note is sounded.
Legato
This parameter is only available when the selected mode is
Mono. It is the same found on the main page of the Sound
mode.
The High and Low pop-up menus is where you select the bank
(ROM, RAM or EXB), while the numeric field under it is for
selecting the multisample inside the selected bank. The Sound
name appears on its right.
The multisample you select for the High layer will be triggered
by velocities higher than the value of the Velocity Multisample
Switch Low-High parameter (see page 195). If you do not wish
to use velocity switching, set the switch to a value of 001, and
select only the High multisample.
ROM
RAM
High
Last
Hold
Use this parameter to keep the notes sustained even after releasing the keys.
Sound Transpose Range
Use these parameters to set a range for transposition. Inside this
range notes are transposed. Outside this range, they are not
transposed. This is useful to avoid RX Sounds being transposed
when transposing a Sound.
Off
The multisample will be played in reverse. In the case of FlashROM or optional (RAM or EXB) multisamples that were originally specified to loop, the multisample will be played back in
one-shot reverse mode. If the multisample was originally set to
reverse, it will playback without change.
On
Off
Level
These parameters specify the level of each multisample.
0127
Multisample level.
Note: Depending on the multisample, high settings of this parameter may cause the sound to distort when a chord is played. If this
occurs, lower the level.
OSC Multisample
High/Low Bank/Num
Use these parameters to select a different multisample for each of
the High and Low layers. You can use velocity to switch between
the two multisamples. Offset, Reverse and Level can be adjusted
independently for the High and Low multisamples.
Pitch/Delay/Velocity Switch
Octave
Use this parameter to adjust the pitch of the selected oscillator in
octave units. The normal octave of the multisample is 0.
-2+1
Octave transposition.
195
Transpose
Scaled Velocity
-12+12
Transposition in semitones.
Tune
Use this parameter to adjust the pitch of the sample in one-cent
steps (a semitone is 100 cents) over a range of 1 octave.
-1200+1200
Fine-tune value in cents.
Delay
This parameter sets a delay time from the note-on to the real
beginning of the sound. With a setting of KeyOff, the sound will
begin when note-off occurs. This is useful to create sounds such
as the click that is heard when a harpsichord note is released.
In this case, set the Sustain parameter to 0 (see page 204).
Key Off
05000ms
This page appears when you edit a Drum Kit. Here you can
select a different percussive sample for each key and layer.
Reference
Velocity
Switches
Here you can set a note and velocity range window for the
selected oscillator.
Key
Key
Key in edit. You can press a key on the keyboard, while this
parameter is selected, to select a key.
Velocity Zone
Layers
Here you can specify the velocity range for the selected oscillator.
Note: You cannot set the Bottom Velocity higher than the Top
Velocity, nor the Top Velocity lower than the Bottom Velocity.
0127
Assigned velocity.
Keyboard Range
Here you can specify the note range for the selected oscillator.
Note: You cannot set the Bottom Key higher than the Top key, nor
the Top Key lower than the Bottom key.
C-1G9
Assigned note.
Assign
Use this parameter to turn the sample on/off.
On
Off
196
Level
Selected Layer
This parameter specifies the level of the sample. For more information, see Level on page 194.
Use these radio buttons to select the layer to edit. The available
layers depends on the Layers parameter.
Mono/Stereo indicator
Velocity Switches
Each of these values separates the two adjacent layers for the
selected sample/key. Notes stricken harder than a velocity switch
will be played by the layer on the right, while notes stricken
softer are played by the layer on the left.
Transpose
This parameter transposes the selected sample. Use it to change
the pitch of the selected key.
The first and last values are not editable, and are always 001 and
127 (respectively).
No transposition applied.
-64+63
Drum Sample
Tune
Use this parameter to fine-tune the assigned sample.
Bank/Num
Use these parameters to select a different Drum Sample for each
layer. You can use velocity to switch between the available samples. Offset, Reverse and Level can be adjusted independently for
the various multisamples.
The pop-up menu is where you select the bank (ROM, RAM or
EXB), while the numeric field under it is for selecting the sample
inside the selected bank. The sample name appears on its right.
The sample you select for the current layer will be triggered by
velocities higher than the value of the Velocity Switches
parameter (see page 196). If you do not wish to use velocity
switching, assign just one layer to the selected key, and assign a
sample only to Layer 1.
ROM
RAM
No fine-tuning.
-99+99
Cutoff
This parameter sets the cutoff frequency for the filter applied to
the selected sample.
Resonance
This parameter sets the resonance for the filter applied to the
selected sample.
Attack
This parameter is an offset to the selected samples EG Attack.
Decay
This parameter is an offset to the selected samples EG Decay.
EXB1, EXB2 EXB1 or EXB2 sample, loaded from the corresponding optional EXB board (if installed).
Note: Each sample has an upper note range limit, and may not
produce sound when played above that limit.
2nd Offset
These parameters specify the point where the sample will begin
to play. For some samples this parameter will not be available.
On
Off
Reverse
The sample will be played in reverse. For more information see
Reverse on page 194.
Key
See Key on page 195.
197
Single Trigger
Use this parameter to set the sample as a single-triggered one.
On
Off
Here you can make pitch settings for each oscillator. These settings specify how keyboard location will affect the pitch of each
oscillator, and select the controllers that will affect the oscillator
pitch and specify the depth of control. You can also specify the
amount of pitch change produced by the Pitch EG and by LFO1
and LFO2, switch portamento on/off and specify how it will
apply.
Exclusive Group
Exclusive Groups are sets of mutually exclusive keys, stopping
each other. For example, if the Open Hi-Hat and Closed Hi-Hat
are assigned the same Exclusive Group, playing an Open Hi-Hat
will stop the Closed Hi-Hat playing.
None
1127
Pitch
Pitch Slope
On
Normally you will leave this parameter at +1.0. Positive (+) values will cause the pitch to rise as you play higher notes, and negative () values will cause the pitch to fall as you play higher
notes.
Off
The diagram shows how the Pitch Slope and pitch are related:
Pitch
+2
Off
Mixer
+1
2oct
1oct
1oct
Reference
1
C4 C5
-1.0+2.0
Key
JS (+X)
Pan
This parameter sets the position in the stereo panorama of the
selected key.
This parameter specifies how the pitch will change when the joystick is moved all the way to the right. A setting of 12 produces 1
octave of change.
This parameter sets the FX1 send level for of the selected key.
For example if you set this to +12 and move the joystick all the
way to the right, the pitch will rise one octave above the original
pitch.
Send FX2
-60+12
This parameter sets the FX2 send level for of the selected key.
JS (X)
Send FX1
This parameter specifies how the pitch will change when the joystick is moved all the way to the left. A setting of 12 produces 1
octave of change.
For example, if you set this to -60 and move the joystick all the
way to the left, the pitch will fall five octaves below the original
198
Portamento
-60+12
Enabled
Intensity
On
Off
For example, if you set AMS to After Touch and apply pressure
to the keyboard, the pitch will rise if this parameter is set to a
positive (+) value, or fall if this parameter is set to a negative ()
value. The range is a maximum of one octave.
-12.00+12.00
Fingered
This parameter specifies whether the portamento effect restarts
or not with each note played.
On
Off
Time
Parameter value.
Pitch EG
000127
Velocity Intensity
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the modulation that the pitch EG specified on Pitch: Pitch EG will apply
to the pitch. With a setting of 12.00, the pitch will change a maximum of 1 octave.
-12.00+12.00
Parameter value.
Pitch EG AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)
This parameter selects the source that will modulate the pitch
EG of the selected oscillator. See AMS (Alternate Modulation
Source) list on page 213).
Pitch EG Intensity
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect
that AMS will have. For example, if you set AMS to Velocity
and set this value to +12.00, the velocity will control the range of
pitch change produced by the pitch EG in a range of 1 octave.
As you play more softly, the pitch change will draw closer to the
pitch EG levels.
Pitch change (level)
Note-on
Note-on
Note-off
Softly played
(Intensity (Pitch EG) setting)
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
199
Pitch: Pitch EG
Attack Time
Here you can make settings for the pitch EG, which creates timevariant changes in the pitch of the oscillators. The depth of pitch
change produced by these EG settings on the oscillators is
adjusted by the Intensity (AMS1/2 Intensity) parameter (see
page 199).
Specifies the time over which the pitch will change from note-on
until it reaches the pitch specified as the attack level.
099
Parameter value.
Decay Time
Specifies the time over which the pitch will change after reaching
the attack level until it reaches the normal pitch.
099
Parameter value.
Release Time
Specifies the time over which the pitch will change from note-off
until it reaches the pitch specified as the release level.
099
Parameter value.
Level Modulation
Pitch EG change (level) (AMS=JS-Y/Velocity, Intensity= positive (+) value
Diagram
Note-on
Note-on
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
Note-off
The diagram on top of the page shows the Pitch envelope line.
Level
These parameters specify the amount of pitch change. The actual
amount of pitch change will depend on the Intensity (AMS1/2
Intensity) parameter (see below). For example, with an Intensity setting of +12.00, a Level setting of +99 would raise the
pitch one octave, and a Level setting of 99 would lower the
pitch one octave.
Time-varying pitch settings (when Pitch EG Intensity = +12.00)
+99 = approximately 1 octave Attack Level
Note-off
Start Level
99 = approximately 1 octave
Decay
Time
Release Time
Start Level
Specifies the amount of pitch change at note-on.
-99+99
Parameter value.
Attack Level
Specifies the amount of pitch change when the attack time has
elapsed.
-99+99
Time
Release Level
Attack
Time
Parameter value.
Release Level
Specifies the amount of pitch change when the release time has
elapsed.
-99+99
-99+99
Parameter value.
Time
These parameters specify the time over which the pitch change
will occur.
Parameter value.
Reference
Note-on
0 = pitch when
key is held
(sustained)
200
Time Modulation
Note-on
Note-off
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
Filter Type
This parameter selects the type of filter (Low Pass Resonant, Low
Pass & High Pass) for the selected oscillator.
Low Pass Resonance
When the Low Pass filter type is selected, only filter A will be activated.
Parameter value.
Trim
Use this parameter to adjust the level at which the audio signal
output from the selected oscillator is input to filter A.
Note: If this value is raised, the sound may distort if Resonance is
set to a high value or when you play a chord.
0099
Trim level.
Filter A
0099
This is a filter that cuts the highfrequency region above the cutoff
frequency.
This is the most common type of filter,
and is used to cut part of the overtone
12dB/oct
components, making an originally bright
24dB/oct
timbre sound more mellow (darker).
When the Filter Type is Low Pass
Frequency Resonance, the cutoff will have a
steeper slope.
201
Resonance (Resonance A)
The resonance emphasizes the overtone components that lie in
the region of the cutoff frequency specified by Frequency, producing a more distinctive sound. Increasing this value will produce a stronger effect.
0099
Resonance value.
Parameter value.
Filter B
Frequency (Cutoff Frequency B)
This parameter specifies the cutoff frequency of filter B. This
parameter will be displayed when Filter Type is set to Low Pass
& High Pass.
High Pass
Level
This filter cuts the low-frequency range that
lies below the cutoff frequency. By cutting
the lower overtones, it lightens the tone.
12dB/oct
Frequency
0099
Keyboard Tracking
Key Low/High
These settings specify keyboard tracking for the cutoff frequency
of the filter for the selected oscillator. The way in which the cutoff frequency is affected by the keyboard location you play can
be specified by the Key Low, Key High, Ramp Low and
Ramp High parameters.
Keyboard tracking will apply to the range below the specified
Low note number, and above the specified High note number.
C1G9
Ramp Low/High
These parameter specifies the angle of keyboard tracking.
If Intensity to A and Intensity to B are set to +50, Ramp
Low is set to 62 and Ramp High is set to +62, the angle of
the change in cutoff frequency will correspond to the keyboard
location (pitch). This means that the oscillation that occurs
when you increase the Resonance (Resonance A) will correspond to the keyboard location.
If you set Ramp Low to +43 and Ramp High to 43, the cutoff frequency will not be affected by keyboard location. Use this
setting when you do not want the cutoff frequency to change for
each note.
-99+99
Angle value.
High Ramp=+99
High Ramp=+62
High Ramp=0
High Ramp=43
Low Ramp=+99
High Ramp=99
Low Ramp=+43
Low Ramp=0
Low Ramp=62
Low Ramp=99
Low Key
High Key
Key
Reference
202
Tracking to A/B
Selects the source that will control the depth and direction of the
effect that the time-varying changes produced by the filter EG
will have on the cutoff frequency of filters A and B. See AMS
(Alternate Modulation Source) list on page 213.
For the range of notes between Key Low and Key High, the
cutoff frequency will change according to the keyboard location
(pitch).
Int to A (Intensity to A)
-99+99
Parameter value.
Filter EG
Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that AMS will
have on filter A. For details on how this will apply, refer to Int to
A (Intensity to A).
Int to B (Intensity to B)
Note-on
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
Note-off
Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that AMS will
have on filter B. For details on how this will apply, refer to Int to
A (Intensity to A).
Note: The sum of the settings for Velocity to A/B, Intensity to A/
B, and (AMS) Intensity to A/B will determine the depth and
direction of the effect produced by the filter EG.
Softly played
Strongly played
Setting to +
Strongly played
Setting to
Velocity to B
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect
that velocity will have on the time-varying changes created by
the filter EG to control the filter B cutoff frequency (see Velocity
to A).
99+99
Int to A (Intensity to A)
Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that the time-varying changes created by the filter 1 EG will have on the filter A
cutoff frequency.
With positive (+) settings, the sound will become brighter when
the EG levels set by Filter EG Level and Time parameters are
in the + area, and darker when they are in the area.
With negative () settings, the sound will become darker when
the EG levels set by Filter EG Level and Time parameters are
in the + area, and brighter when they are in the area.
-99+99
Parameter value.
Int to B (Intensity to B)
Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that the time-varying changes created by the filter EG will have on the filter B cutoff frequency (see Int to A (Intensity to A)).
-99+99
Parameter value.
203
Intensity to A
Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that AMS will
have on filter A.
Here you can use the filter LFO to apply cyclic modulation to the
cutoff frequency of the filter (for the selected oscillator) to create
cyclical changes in tone.
Parameter value.
Intensity to B
Specifies the depth and direction of the effect that AMS will
have on filter B (see Intensity to A).
LFO 2
Adjusts the depth of the cyclic modulation applied by LFO2 (set
on LFO: LFO2) to the cutoff frequency of filters A and B. For
more information on the parameters see LFO 1 above.
LFO 1
Filter: Filter EG
Intensity to A
Specifies the depth and direction of the modulation that LFO1
(set on LFO: LFO1) will have on the cutoff frequency of filter
A. Negative () settings will invert the phase.
Change in cutoff
Low setting
-99+99
Here you can make settings for the EG that will produce timevarying changes in the cutoff frequency of filters A and B for the
selected oscillator. The depth of the effect that these settings will
have on the filter cutoff frequency is determined by the Velocity and Intensity parameters.
High setting
Parameter value.
Intensity to B
-99+99
Reference
JS (Joystick) Y Intensity to A
By moving the joystick in the Y direction (toward yourself), you
can control the depth at which LFO1 modulates the cutoff frequency of filter A. This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the control.
Higher settings of this parameter will produce greater increases
in the effect of LFO1 on the filter when the joystick is moved
toward yourself.
-99+99
Diagram
The diagram on top of the page shows the Filter envelope line.
Filter envelope
Attack Level
Note-on
Parameter value.
JS (Joystick) Y Intensity to B
By moving the joystick in the Y direction (toward yourself), you
can control the depth at which LFO1 modulates the cutoff frequency of filter B. This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the control (see JS (Joystick) Y Intensity to A).
AMS (Filter LFO1 Alternate Modulation Source)
Select a source that will control the depth and direction of cutoff
frequency change for both filters A and B. See AMS (Alternate
Modulation Source) list.
Note-off
Sustain Level
The specified
cutoff
frequency
Release
Level
Break
Point
Level
Start
Level
Attack
Time
Decay
Time
Time
Slope
Time
Release
Time
Level
These are the envelope segment levels. The result will depend on
the filter that was selected in Filter Type. For example, with the
Low Pass Resonance filter, positive (+) values of EG Intensity
will cause the tone to be brightened by positive (+) levels, and
darkened by negative () levels.
204
Level Modulation
Start
This parameter specifies the change in cutoff frequency at the
time of note-on.
Note-on
-99+99
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
Note-off
Level value.
Attack
This parameter specifies the change in cutoff frequency after the
attack time has elapsed.
-99+99
Level value.
AMS (Alternate Modulation Source)
Level value.
Sustain
This parameter specifies the change in cutoff frequency that will
be maintained from after the slope time has elapsed until noteoff occurs.
-99+99
Level value.
Release
This parameter specifies the change in cutoff frequency that will
occur when the release time has elapsed.
-99+99
Level value.
Time
These parameters specify the time over which the filter change
will occur.
Attack
This parameter selects the source that will control the Level
parameters of the filter EG (AMS (Alternate Modulation
Source) list on page 213).
Intensity (AMS Intensity)
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect
applied by AMS. With a setting of 0, the levels specified by
Frequency (Cutoff Frequency A) will be used.
For example, if AMS is Velocity, and you set St (Start Level
Swing), At (Attack Level Swing) and Br (Break Level Swing)
to + and set Intensity to a positive (+) value, the EG levels will
rise as you play more strongly. If Intensity is set to a negative
() values, the EG levels will fall as you play more strongly.
-99+99
Intensity value.
This parameter specifies the time over which the level will
change from note-on until the attack level is reached.
Decay
This parameter specifies the time over which the level will
change from the attack level to the break point level.
099
099
Time value.
Time value.
Slope
This parameter specifies the time over which the level will
change after the decay time has elapsed until the sustain level is
reached.
099
Time value.
Release
This parameter specifies the time over which the level will
change after note-on occurs until the release level is reached.
099
Time value.
Time Modulation
Note-on
Note-off
205
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
AMS1/2
Use this parameter to select the source that will control the
Time parameters of the filter EG. See AMS (Alternate Modulation Source) list on page 213.
Int (AMS Intensity)
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect
that AMS1/2 will have.
Amp Level
Volume of the selected oscillator.
Note: The volume of a Sound can be controlled by CC#7 (volume)
and #11 (expression). The resulting level is determined by multiplying the values of CC#7 and #11. The Global MIDI channel is
used for control.
0127
Pan
Pan (stereo position) of the selected oscillator.
Intensity value.
Volume level.
Random
L001
C064
R127
Pan modulation
Reference
206
as you play higher), and toward the left as the note numbers
decrease (i.e., as you play lower). Negative () values of this
parameter will have the opposite effect.
-99+99
Parameter value.
Amp Modulation
These parameters specify how the volume of the selected oscillator will be affected by velocity.
Velocity Intensity
With positive (+) values, the volume will increase as you play
more strongly. With negative () values, the volume will
decrease as you play more strongly.
Note-on
Note-on
Note-off
Softly played
-99+99
Note-off
Strongly played
Intensity value.
Keyboard Tracking
These parameters let you use keyboard tracking to adjust the
volume of the selected oscillator. Use the Key and Ramp
parameters to specify how the volume will be affected by the
keyboard location that you play.
Key Low/High
These settings specify the note number at which keyboard tracking will begin to apply. The volume will not change between
Key Low and Key High.
Keyboard tracking will apply to the range below the specified
Low note number, and above the specified Highy note number.
C1G9
Intensity value.
Ramp Low/High
These parameters specify the angle of keyboard tracking.
With positive (+) values of the Ramp Low parameter, the volume will increase as you play notes below the Key Low note
number. With negative () values, the volume will decrease.
With positive (+) values of the Ramp High parameter, the volume will increase as you play notes above the Key High note
number. With negative () values, the volume will decrease.
-99+99
Angle value.
Ramp Low=+99
Ramp High=+99
Ramp Low=0
Ramp High=0
Ramp Low=99
Ramp High=99
Key Low
Key High
Key
Amp: Amp EG
These parameters let you create time-varying changes in the volume of the selected oscillator.
207
Diagram
Slope
This parameter specifies the time over which the volume will
change from when it reaches the break point level until it reaches
the sustain level.
Level
099
Note-on
Release
This parameter specifies the time over which the volume will
change after note-off until it reaches 0.
Amplifier EG
Note-off
Attack Level
Time value.
Break Point
Volume
099
Sustain
Level
Start
Level
Time
Time value.
Level Modulation
Amp 1 EG changes (Level) (AMS=Velocity, Intensity = a positive (+) value)
Attack
Time
Decay Slope
Time Time
Release Time
Note-on
Note-on
Note-off
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
Start
099
Level value.
Attack
Softly played note when Start Level Strongly played note when Start Level Strongly played note when Start Level
Swing=0 and Attack Level Swing Swing=0 andAttack Level Swing and Swing=0 andAttack Level Swing and
Break Level Swing are set to +
and Break Level Swing are set to + Break Level Swing are set to +
This parameter specifies the source that will control the Level
parameters of the amp EG. See AMS (Alternate Modulation
Source) list on page 213.
099
Intensity
Level value.
099
-99+99
Break
This parameter specifies the volume level that will be reached
after the decay time has elapsed.
099
Level value.
Sustain
Level value.
Intensity value.
Time
These parameters specify the time over which the volume change
will occur.
Attack
This parameter specifies the time over which the volume will
change after note-on until it reaches the attack level. If the start
level is 0, this will be the rise time of the sound.
099
Time value.
Decay
This parameter specifies the time over which the volume will
change from when it reaches the attack level until it reaches the
break point level.
099
Time value.
Reference
208
Time Modulation
These parameters let you use an alternate modulation source to
modify the amp EG times that were specified in Time on
page 207.
Amp 1 EG changes (Time)
(AMS=Amp KTrk +/+, Intensity = a positive (+) value)
(When Amp Keyboard Track Low Ramp= a positive (+) value, and
High Ramp = a positive (+) value)
Note-on
Note-on
Note-off
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
Note-on
Note-off
This is another alternate modulation source for the Amp EG. See
above AMS1 parameters.
Note-on
Note-off
Note-off
LFO: LFO1
Softly played note with
Attack, Decay, Slope and
Release Time Swing at +
In this and the next page you can make settings for the LFO that
can be used to cyclically modulate the Pitch, Filter, and Amp of
each oscillator. There are two LFO units for each oscillator. By
setting the LFO1 or LFO2 Intensity to a negative () value for
Pitch, Filter, or Amp, you can invert the LFO waveform.
Intensity
This parameter specifies the depth and direction of the effect
that AMS1 will have. For example, if AMS1(T) is Amp KTrk
+/+, the (Amp) Keyboard Track settings (see Keyboard Tracking on page 206) will control the EG Time parameters. With
positive (+) values of this parameter, positive (+) values of
Ramp (Ramp Setting) will cause EG times to be lengthened,
and negative () values of Ramp (Ramp Setting) will cause EG
times to be shortened. The direction of the change is specified by
At (Attack Time Swing), Dc (Decay Time Swing), Sl (Slope
Time Swing), and Rl (Release Time).
When AMS1(T) is Velocity, positive (+) values will cause EG
times to lengthen as you play more strongly, and negative ()
values will cause EG times to shorten as you play more strongly.
With a setting of 0, the EG times will be as specified by the
Level parameters (see page 207).
Waveform
This parameter selects the LFO waveform. The numbers that
appear at the right of some of the LFO waveforms indicate the
phase at which the waveform will begin.
Triangle
Triangle
90
Triangle
Random
Saw
Step Triangle 4
Triangle wave
Step Triangle 6
Step Saw 4
Step Saw 6
Sawtooth down
Saw
180
Square
Square wave
Sine
Sine wave
Guitar
Guitar vibrato
Random1 (S/H):
Conventional sample & hold (S/H) in which the
level changes randomly at fixed intervals of
time
Random2 (S/H):
Both the levels and the time intervals will
change randomly.
Random3 (S/H):
The maximum level and minimum level will
alternate at random intervals of time (i.e., a
square wave with random period).
Exponential
Triangle
Exponential
Saw Down
Frequency
0099
Random4 (Vector)
Random5 (Vector)
Random6 (Vector)
These types cause Random 13 to change
smoothly. They can be used to simulate the
instability of acoustic instruments etc.
Exponential
Saw Up
Frequency rate.
209
Offset
offset = 99
offset = 0
offset = +99
Pitch at note-on
-99+99
Offset value.
Key Sync
-99+99
The LFO will start each time you play a note, and
an independent LFO will operate for each note.
Off
Intensity value.
Fade
MIDI/Tempo Sync
This parameter enables/disables the LFO synchronization with
Sequencer 1 Tempo.
On
Here is how Fade affects the LFO (when Key Sync is On):
Note-on
Note-off
Fade
Delay
0099
Fade rate.
Delay
This parameter specifies the time from note-on until the LFO
effect begins to apply. When Key Sync is Off, the delay will
apply only when the LFO is first started.
099
Delay time.
Base Note
When MIDI/Tempo Sync is On, these parameters set a note
length relative to (Tempo) and the multiple (Times) that
will be applied to it. These parameters will determine the frequency of the LFO1. For example if Base Note is (quarter
note) and Times is 04, the LFO will perform one cycle every
four beats.
Even if you change the (Tempo) setting of Sequencer 1, the
LFO will always perform one cycle every four beats.
Frequency Modulation
,
, ,
, ,
, ,
Note value.
Times
Reference
This parameter specifies the time from when the LFO begins to
apply until it reaches the maximum amplitude. When Key
Sync. is Off, the fade will apply only when the LFO is first
started.
210
Send to Master
LFO: LFO2
This parameters allows you to decide if the direct + effected signal must go to the Master, or just the effected signal.
Here you can make settings for the LFO2, which is the second
LFO that can be applied to the selected oscillator. See LFO:
LFO1 for more information on the parameters value.
On
Off
Effects: FX Select
Effects: FX1
Here you can select two effects for the whole Sound, switch them
on/off, and specify chaining.
In this page you can edit the effected assigned to the FX1 (A or
C) effect processor (usually reverb). See the Effects chapter for
more information.
Effects: FX2
In this page you can edit the effected assigned to the FX2 (B or
D) effect processor (usually modulating effect). See the Effects
chapter for more information.
FX 1/2 Group
Send
Send level for each effect.
Drum samples have their own send level settings (see Send
FX1 and Send FX2 on page 197). Use this parameter to
adjust the general offset of the Drum Kit.
000127
Effect level.
FX1/2
Use these parameters to select the effect type for effect 1/2. See
the Effects chapter for more information.
Note: If 000: No Effect is selected, the output from the master effect
will be muted.
Wet/Dry
Mix between the effected (Wet) and direct (uneffected, Dry) signal.
Dry
Wet
nn:nn
2>1
Use this parameter to send the output of effect 2 to the input of
effect 1.
000127
Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.
211
parameters. You cannot edit the Sound while you are in Compare mode.
While this function is on, the Compare indicator blinks on the
page header.
Copy Oscillator
Select this command to copy all settings between oscillators.
See Copy Oscillator dialog box on page 212 for more information.
Name
Name of the Sound to be saved. Press the
(Text Edit) button
next to the name to open the Text Edit window.
Copy FX
Select this command to copy all FX settings from another
Sound.
See Copy FX dialog box on page 212 for more information.
Copy Drum Kit
Select this command to copy the Drum Kit from a different
Drum Kit.
Sound Bank
Target bank of Sounds. Each bank corresponds to one of the
PERFORMANCE/SOUND buttons. Use TEMPO/VALUE controls to select a different bank.
Sound
Target Sound location in the selected bank. Use TEMPO/VALUE
controls to select a different location.
See Copy Drum Kit dialog box on page 212 for more information.
Select button
Init Sound
Press this button to open the Sound Select window, and select a
target location.
Reference
212
Open this window by selecting the Copy Drum Kit item from
the page menu. Here, you can copy settings from a range of keys
of a Drum Kit.
From Sound
Press this button to open the Sound Select window, and select
the source Sound.
Press this button to open the Sound Select window, and select
the source Drum Kit.
From Oscillator
From Key
To Oscillator
To Key
Target key. Settings are copied starting from this key, and
upwards.
From Sound
Press this button to open the Sound Select window, and select
the source Sound.
From FX
Select the source effect to copy from.
To FX
Target effect where to copy the source settings to.
213
Pitch EG
Pitch EG
Filter EG
Amp EG
LFO1
LFO2
Note Number
Note number
Velocity
Velocity
Polyphonic After Touch (transmitted from the Pa1X only as sequence data)
Joystick X
Joystick +Y
Joystick Y
Ass.Pedal
CC#18
CC#18
CC#17
CC#17
CC#19
CC#19
CC#20
CC#20
CC#21
CC#21
Damper
CC#65
CC#80
CC#80
CC#81
CC#81
CC#82
CC#82
CC#83
CC#83
Tempo
Reference
Sostenuto
+/
0/+
214
+/0
The sign of the Ramp Low setting will determine the direction of its effect. Ramp High will
have no AMS effect.
example of Amp
Keyboard Track settings
Amp
Ramp Low
= +50
Ramp High
= +50
Note Number
+ max
AMS = Amp KTrk +/+
AMS Intensity = positive (+) value
zero
Depth and direction of modulation
- max
+ max
AMS = Amp KTrk +/
AMS Intensity = positive (+) value
zero
+ max
AMS = Amp KTrk 0/+
AMS Intensity = positive (+) value
zero
Depth and direction of modulation
- max
+ max
AMS = Amp KTrk +/0
AMS Intensity = positive (+) value
zero
Depth and direction of modulation
- max
215
2.
You can also use the Export function to export samples (.KSF)
and multisamples (.KMP) in Korg proprietary format.
Watch at the AUDIO IN LED to check the input level. Ideally, the LED should turn to red only on signal peaks, and
should usually stay orange (green means too low an input
signal).
3.
4.
5.
Warning: When loading a .SET folder containing Sounds associated with PCM data, all existing PCM data in memory are deleted.
Save them before loading the folder, by selecting the PCM option
during a Save All operation (see Saving the full memory content
on page 265).
To see if a .SET folder contains PCM data, open it and look for a
PCM folder.
Note: When entering the Sampling mode, samples are automatically loaded from the (hidden) PCM folder on the hard disk. This
may take some time before this mode becomes operative.
Note: No sound will be heard when you first enter the Sampling
mode.
Note: Some demo audio grooves can be found on the Korg Pa1X
web site (www.korgpa.com).
Press the Record button in the display again to stop recording. When the memory is full, the sampling automatically
stops. A maximum of 10.9 seconds is allowed for each sample.
7.
8.
If you are not satisfied with the recorded sound, press the
Record button in the display again, to repeat recording.
Press Record again to stop recording. A new sample will be
automatically created.
9.
When finished sampling your sound, you can either save it,
or (if it is an audio groove) continue editing it with the
Time Slice function.
To save the sample, select the Write command from the
page menu. The Write Sample dialog box will appear (see
Write Sample dialog box on page 226). Assign a name to
Reference
216
the new Sample, and save it to the PCM folder on the hard
disk.
To create a series of separate percussive samples fro an
audio groove, and a MIDI Groove, go to the Time Slice
page. After creating a series of slices, use the Extend function to refine your groove. Select the Write command from
the page menu, to save the sliced samples and the MIDI
Groove to disk.
10. After saving, press the MENU button and go to the Multi-
Edit menu
From any page of the Sampling mode, press the MENU button
to open the Sampling edit menu. This menu gives access to the
various Sampling edit sections.
When in the menu, select an edit section, or press EXIT to exit
the menu and return to the Sample Edit / Sample Record page.
To return to this page, you can also select the Sample Edit / Sample Record menu item.
Sampling: Record
This page allows you to record a 16-bit, 48kHz stereo or mono
sample.
SM (Sample)
Press this area to open the Choose Sample window, and select
one of the available samples in the RAM memory for editing.
Select one of the available samples. The window will be automatically closed after selecting.
Level
Use these meters to see the level of the entering signal. When the
CLIP indicator turns red, the signal is too hot. Lower it by reducing the source output level, or by using the GAIN knob on the
rear panel of the Pa1X.
In case of mono sampling, only one of the indicators will work.
217
Sampling: Edit
This page allows you to cut, trim or normalize a sample, as well
as edit the loop points. The sample can played on the full keyboard.
REC Setup
Record Mode
Use this parameter to select the audio input on the back of the
instrument.
Channel 1 (L) Only the Input 1 is selected. A mono sample will
be produced.
Channel 2 (R) Only the Input 2 is selected. A mono sample will
be produced.
SM (Sample)
Selected sample. See SM (Sample) above.
Sample diagram
This is the graphical display of the selected sample waveform.
The area included between the Start and End points is highlighted (dark background).
Parameters
Start (Sample Start)
This is the sample start point (in samples). You may edit this
point, as well as the End point, to shorten the sample. Changing
the Sample Start cuts out the attack portion of the sound.
Note: When moving the Start point forward, the Loop Start
point is also moved forward.
Warning: When saving the edited sample (Write Sample operation), the segments exceeding the Start and End points are permanently removed.
Record button
Press this button to start recording. Press it again to stop recording. Recording will automatically stop when the maximum available space will end.
Note: Pa1X always samples at the maximum quality (16 bit,
48,000Hz). Samples of a different quality may be loaded (8 or 16
bit, 11,025Hz to 48,000Hz).
Loop Start
Note: Use the Loop On parameter on the Sampling: Loop Edit
page to turn the loop on (see page 219).
Use this parameter to adjust the Loop Start point. When you
adjust this parameter, an audible click may appear, due to a pitch
and/or level mismatch between the starting and ending points of
the loop. Move the Loop Start and Loop/Sample End point, so
that the click can no longer be heard.
Reference
218
When editing audio grooves, the Loop Start should match the
Sample Start point. This parameter usually differs from the Sample Start in ordinary sounds (i.e., a guitar, a piano, a voice).
Loop Start (L)
Loop
Turn this parameter on, to make all Sample and Loop Start and
End selections fall on zero-crossing points (i.e., points where the
waveform crosses the x-axis, and goes from negative to positive,
or from positive to negative values). This will make loops more
accurate, and will reduce the risk of clicks.
OrigNote (Original Note)
Original pitch of the sampled note. While this parameter means
nothing in this page, it will be useful when assigning a sample to
the multisample, to identify the original pitch of the sample.
For example, if you sample a C4, set this parameter to C4.
When the sample will be assigned to a keyboard zone of the multisample, it will be transposed (if needed) according to this
parameter, to avoid a change of the original pitch.
SM (Sample)
Zoom
Loop diagram
This diagram shows the End (Loop End) point on the left half,
and the Loop Start point on the right half of the screen. Use
the End and Loop Start parameters to adjust the loop.
Parameters
Start
Loop Start
See Loop Start on page 217.
Use Zero
To adjust the sample length and loop points, check the Loop
On parameter, then use the Start, Loop Start and End
parameters to create a fine sounding cycling loop.
Loop Lock
Off
On
Loop On
Power
Off
219
Crossfade
When looping the pitched sample of a complex sound such as
strings or woodwinds to make the sound sustain, it is necessary
to create a long loop to preserve the rich character of the sound.
Crossfade Loop can be used to minimize the difference in pitch
and level between the beginning and ending of the loop region,
to create a natural-sounding loop. In order to solve such problems, Crossfade Loop causes the sound to change gradually from
the end to the beginning of the loop.
SM (Sample)
Selected sample. See SM (Sample) on page 216.
Sampling Info
Samples
Number of samples in memory.
Drum Samples
Number of drum samples in memory.
Multisamples
Number of multisamples in memory.
Available Memory
RAM Bank 1/2
Crossfade Length
In Crossfade Length, specify the length of the sample that you
wish to crossfade. You can enter it either as the number of samples, or a percentage (%). If you set this as a percentage, the
number of samples will be calculated automatically.
If you set this to 50%, crossfade will be performed on the second
half of the region between loop start and loop end.
The Sample RAM memory is divided in two banks of 16 Megabytes (MB) each. Pa1X comes with 16MB of RAM already
installed, corresponding to Bank 1. You can install an additional
(optional) module of 16MB, corresponding to Bank 2, for a total
of 32MB.
Note: A sample cannot be split between the two banks. It must
reside on just one bank.
Reference
In practice, here is how it works. A specific length (the Crossfade Length value) of the waveform immediately before the
beginning of the loop is taken and mixed with the end portion.
At this time, the waveform level of the portion immediately
before the end (the length specified by Crossfade Length) will
gradually decrease, and the waveform level immediately before
the beginning of the loop will gradually increase as the two are
mixed.
220
Mono Time
Remaining sample memory (in seconds). This value is given for
mono samples. With stereo samples, this time has to be halved.
Bytes
Remaining memory for sampling (in Bytes). This value is given
for mono samples. With stereo samples, this time has to be
halved.
Sample Info
Selected Samples
Size of the selected sample (in samples).
Samples
Total size of the samples in memory (in samples).
Sampling Frequency
Sampling frequency of the selected sample (in Hertz).
Saving. After the slicing, you can select the Write command
from the page menu, to save the Sound based on sliced samples,
and the MIDI Groove containing the corresponding MIDI
sequence.
The Sound will be saved to the selected location in the User
area of the internal memory. You will be able to select it as an
ordinary Sound, and assign it to the Drum or Percussion track of
a Style.
The Multisample will be automatically saved to the next free
available location.
Samples will be permanently saved to the PCM folder on the
hard disk. They can be automatically loaded when turning the
instrument on, by checking the PCM Autoload option in Disk
mode (see page 273).
Time Slice
The MIDI Groove will be temporarily saved to the SSD memory, and will be available only when using the Import function of
the Style Record mode (see Import: Import Groove on
page 121).
Warning: All MIDI Grooves will be delete each time the Pa1X is
turned off.
Kick
Snare
Kick
Kick
Snare
Original pattern
Some theory
Analyzing and processing. This function detects the attacks
(e.g., kick and snare) inside a rhythm audio groove (a sample
that loops a drum pattern), and automatically divides the audio
groove into individual percussive samples.
Sample1
Sample2
Sample3
Sample4
Sample5
C3
Note: Sliced samples and MIDI data are saved with a Write
operation.
221
Metronome Information
Meter
Use this parameter to specify the Meter of the original sample.
90BPM
Measures
Use this parameter to specify the number of measures of the
original sample. Usually, you will load a groove 1 or 2-measures
long.
BPM
Note: To vary the grooves tempo, you must first import the
generated MIDI data into the Percussion track (Import function of the Style Record mode), and assign the new generated
Sound to the Percussion track.
Gaps between sliced samples, when slowing down the tempo,
can be automatically filled by the Extend function, smoothing
each samples tail.
This parameter specifies the tempo (in Beats Per Minute) of the
original sample. Pa1X automatically calculates this value based
on the Start, End (see page 217), Meter and Measures parameters.
The BPM can be only adjusted to values lower than the one
automatically calculated. This can be useful, for example, when
the actual sample is shorter than the entered Meter and Measures values.
Meas.1
Meas.2
In the above example, the actual groove lasts only up to the first
half of Measure 2. The recognized tempo is 130, while the real
tempo is 100. Set the BPM value to 100, and a rest will be added
to the end of the groove, to allow it to loop seamlessly.
Time Slice
See The Time Slice procedure on page 222 for more information.
Adjust the value of this parameter to change the number of recognized attacks, by varying the speed needed to the Slice engine
to start working again. For example, in the following example, if
the Release value is too high (i.e., too long), the second attack
may be lost:
Sample diagram
This diagram shows the sample waveform and the slices. Here is
how the sample diagram appears before the Slice:
Note: After changing the Release value, you must select the Slice
command again.
Threshold
and the same diagram after the Slice:
This parameter varies the threshold over which the attacks are
recognized (i.e., the Time Slice sensitivity). If it is too low,
weaker attacks may be ignored.
Note: After changing the Threshold value, you are not obliged to
select the Slice command again. The Slices value is immediately
changed.
Attacks
This (non-editable) parameter shows the number of attacks recognized. More than one attack may be recognized in a single
slice. Adjust the Release and Threshold parameters to change the
number of recognized attacks.
Reference
Release
Note: To recombine notes inside the generated MIDI sequence,
you must first import the MIDI data in Style Record mode, by
using the Import function. Then, use the Event Edit to
change the note order.
222
Slices
Long
Extend button
Press this button to execute the Extend command. After you
select it, it will return ghosted, meaning that you cant select it
again. If you change any of the parameters in this page, it will be
available again.
Extend
See The Extend procedure on page 223 for more information.
Before extending
1.
2.
3.
Added tail
The original sample will be sliced, and each generated sample assigned to a different key:
and after extending
Note: You can use the Extend function only after a Time Slice operation.
Note: The Extend function increases the original sample size.
Key
Assigned sample/pattern
Speed %
C2
50%
C#2
53%
D2
56%
D#2
60%
E2
63%
F2
67%
F#2
71%
G2
75%
G#2
80%
A2
84%
A#2
89%
B2
94%
C3
C#3 and
above
100%
4.
To test the single sliced samples, play notes from C#3 and
above. If you play a full chromatic scale, the original pattern will be sounded.
Hint: If too many samples have been generated, and the keyboard cant fit them all, use the OCTAVE buttons to transpose
the keyboard, and listen to samples exceeding the upper limit.
6.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
When the Extend is completed, you can save the sliced and
extended samples and the resulting MIDI Groove to the
internal memory.
Select the Write command from the page menu. The Write
Slice dialog box will appear (see Write Slice dialog box on
page 227). Assign a name to the new Sound, and save it to
an User Sound location.
7.
1.
5.
When the Slice is completed, you can save the sliced samples and the MIDI Groove to disk, or use the Extend function to improve the quality of the slices.
Select the Write command from the page menu. The Write
Slice dialog box will appear (see Write Slice dialog box on
page 227). Assign a name to the new Sound, and save it to
an User Sound location.
A MIDI Groove with the same name will also be saved to a
reserved area of the internal memory. Be warned, that this
area will be deleted when turning the instrument off. Convert it to an internal Style pattern, by using the Import
function of the Style Record mode, before turning the
instrument off.
To improve the quality of the slices, use the Extend function (see Extend below).
8.
9.
After exiting the Sampling mode, you may load the generated MIDI Groove by using the Import function of the
Style Record mode (see Import: Import Groove on
page 121 for more information).
8.
After exiting the Sampling mode, you may load the generated MIDI Groove by using the Import function of the
Style Record mode (see Import: Import Groove on
page 121 for more information).
Multisample: Edit MS
The Multisample is a way of organizing several samples on the
keyboard. Each sample is assigned to a Keyboard Zone (or
Index), with a higher and a lower limit.
A Multisample is then assigned to a Sound (see Basic: OSC
Basic on page 194), where it is enriched with several performance parameters, like Amplitude Envelope, LFO, Filters, etc
Reference
223
224
MS (MultiSample)
Press this area to open the Choose Multisample window, and
select one of the available multisamples in memory.
Keyboard diagram
Multisample Setup
Sample list
Index
Index number of the selected Zone of the multisample / total
number of Zones in the multisample. A Zone always corresponds to a single sample.
Sample Number / Name
Number / name of the sample assigned to the selected zone of
the multisample.
Original Note
Use this parameter to automatically transpose the assigned sample, to make it sound at the right pitch. It should match to the
OrigNote (Original Note) value assigned when editing the
sample (see page 218).
Level
Keyboard ranges
MS (MultiSample)
See MS (MultiSample) on page 224.
Sample list
List of samples assigned to the selected multisample. Use the big
button with an arrow on top and to the bottom of the list to
scroll the list up or down.
Buttons
Insert
Press this button to create a new zone (Index) after the selected
one.
Add
Press this button to add a new zone (Index) after the last one.
Delete
Press this button to delete the selected Zone/Index.
Keyboard ranges
Next to each sample name the low and high Zone limits appear.
Edit these values to change the Zone range. The Original Note is
shown in red.
225
Load Sample
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.
Write
Select this command to open the Write Sample, Write Multisample or Write Slice dialog box (depending on the page you are in),
and save the sample(s) to the hard disk (PCM folder), and the
multisample(s) or the Sound generated by the Time Slice function to the internal memory (SSD).
See Write Sample dialog box on page 226, Write MultiSample
dialog box on page 226, or Write Slice dialog box on page 227
for more information.
Delete
Select this command to delete one or all samples and multisamples from memory.
See Delete Sample dialog box on page 227, or Delete Multisample dialog box on page 227 for more information.
Normalize
The samples are loaded to the RAM memory. Before leaving the
Sampling mode, use the Write command to save samples to the
hard disk (PCM folder) as New Samples.
Note: If the sample exceeds the maximum size allowed by the Pa1X
(524,288 samples, either mono or stereo), it will be truncated.
Normalization optimizes the samples level relative to other samples, making all samples sound more uniformly. It also helps
optimizing signal/noise ratio, by preventing further stages of
amplification from increasing any residual noise.
Import
Cut
Select this command to cut the selected part of the sample
(inside the Start and End points).
Trim/Crop
Select this command to cut all parts of the sample out of the
selected range (i.e., out of the Start and End points).
Select All
Init Multisample
Only available in the Multisample page. Select this command to
create a new, blank multisample. Only one Zone will be available, with no sample assigned.
Reference
Page menu
226
Open this dialog box by selecting the Write command from the
page menu, while in the Sample Edit / Sample Record section. In
this dialog box you can save the sample to disk, inside the (hidden) PCM folder. Please always remember to save PCM samples
into a .SET folder, before turning the instrument off, or before
loading or recording new samples.
(Text
227
Open this dialog box by selecting the Write command from the
page menu, while in the Time Slice page. In this dialog box you
can save the Sound, sliced Samples and Multisample generated
by the Time Slice function, together with the generated MIDI
Groove.
Open this dialog box by selecting the Delete command from the
page menu, while you are in any page of the Sample Edit/Sample
Record section.
The Sound will be saved to the selected User bank location in the
internal, non-volatile memory (SSD). The Multisample will be
saved to a free location in the internal memory (SSD). Samples
will be saved in the PCM folder on the hard disk.
Note: The MIDI Groove is automatically saved in a reserved, temporary location on disk, and is automatically deleted when turning
the instrument off. So, import it (by using the Import: Import
Groove function in Style Record mode, see page 121), before turning the instrument off.
Note: Use this option with care, since you may delete samples
you would like to preserve, that have not yet been assigned to
a multisample or drumkit. Use it only when you are sure all
desired samples have been assigned to a multisample or
drumkit.
Name
(Text
Sound Bank
Target bank of Sounds. Each bank corresponds to one of the
PERFORMANCE/SOUND buttons. Use TEMPO/VALUE controls to select a different bank.
Sound
Target Sound location in the selected bank. Use TEMPO/VALUE
controls to select a different location.
Select button
Press this button to open the Sound Select window, and select a
target location.
Select MultiSamples to delete all multisamples. No samples will be deleted, including those associated with the
deleted multisamples.
Reference
228
Open this dialog box by selecting the Export command from the
page menu, while you are in any page of the Sample Edit/Sample
Record section.
Original Name
Name of the sample being exported.
File Name
Name of the generated file on disk.
File Type
Either of the file types you can choose as the file format.
WAV
AIFF
By using this function, you can export from the internal memory the multisample in edit in the Multisample section, and all
linked samples. The Export operation generates a .KMP file
(Korgs proprietary file format for multisamples), and a folder
containing a series of .KSF files (Korgs proprietary file format
for samples) inside the same directory.
Note: You cannot export a multisamples on more than a single
floppy disk. You can, however, export files of any size on the hard
disk.
Note: When exporting a stereo multisample, be careful to assign a
different name to the Left and Right channel files, to avoid overwriting. A -L and -R suffix is usually added after the name of
this kind of files.
229
Edit menu
From any page of the Global mode, press the MENU button to
open the Global edit menu. This menu gives access to the various Global edit sections.
When in the menu, select an edit section, or press EXIT to exit
the Global mode.
When in a page, press EXIT to go back to current operating
mode in the background (Style Play, Song Play, Sequencer,
Sound).
MIDI Setup, containing the available MIDI Setups, i.e., settings for MIDI communication.
Edit section
Page menu
icon
Parameters
area
Main page
Tabs
Edit mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Global mode.
Edit section
This identifies the current edit section, corresponding to one of
the items of the edit menu (see Edit menu on page 229).
Reference
230
+50
Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 257).
Reverb Offset
Parameters area
Each page contains various parameters. Use the tabs to select
one of the available pages. For detailed information on the various types of parameters, see sections starting from page 230.
Tabs
Use tabs to select one of the edit pages of the current edit section.
Highest pitch.
Gbl
This is the master offset for all reverbs. Use it to adjust reverb
tails to the room where you are playing. Use negative values
when you are in a very reverberant room, positive values if the
room is too dry.
By using this global control, you are not obliged to change the
reverb time in each single Performance, STS, Style Performance,
or Song.
-50
Less reverb.
Standard reverb.
+50
More reverb.
Gbl
Gbl
Time for a full fade out (from maximum volume to zero), after
you press the FADE IN/OUT button.
520
Keyboard Settings
Velocity Curve
Accelerando/Ritardando
Gbl
Soft1 Hard3
Curves, from the lightest one to the hardest one.
A.Touch Curve
Gbl
This parameter sets the sensitivity of the keyboard to the pressure you apply after first pressing a key.
Soft1 Hard2
Glide
Global Tuning/Reverb
Master Tuning
Gbl
This is the master tuning of the instrument (in cents of a semitone). Use it to adapt your keyboard tuning to an acoustic
instrument, for example an acoustic piano.
-50
Lowest pitch.
To change Pitch Bend values for each Upper track, see the PB
Sensitivity parameter in the Style Play mode (see page 86)
Time
Time needed to notes affected by the Glide to return to the normal pitch.
231
Post-KB/Pre-Scale
When this option is selected, notes will be transposed immediately after they leave the keyboard.
The Scale will be applied to the transposed notes.
For example, if you altered an E, and then set the
Master Transpose to +1, the E key will play F, and
the altered key will be E (that will play an altered
E).
This page is where you can select to which tracks the Master
Transpose is applied to, and adjust some related parameter.
Transpose
Scale
Tone
generator
Transpose Control
Transpose applies to Style and Kbd tracks
Scale
Gbl
Transpose
Tone
generator
In Sync
This page lets you select the main (or basic) scale of the instrument.
Gbl
Reference
In Realtime
Main Scale
This parameter sets the main scale (or temperament) for the
whole instrument, apart for tracks where a different sub-scale
has been selected by a Performance or STS (see Scale Mode on
page 95, Style Play mode).
This flag lets you turn the Master Transpose on or off for the two
onboard Sequencers.
Key
Gbl
This flag lets you turn the Master Transpose on or off for Note
messages received from MIDI IN.
Position
Scale and Transpose position
The Scale and Transpose Position allows you to define the relation between the Scale and the Master Transpose.
Gbl
232
Locks
Gbl
LockTuning pane
LockControl pane
Assignable Switches
When locked, selecting a Performance or STS will
not change the Assignable Switch assignment.
(See Pad/Switch:
page 94).
Slider Mode
Assignable
Switch
on
LockStyle pane
Pad
Style Preferences
When locked, selecting a Performance or STS will
not change the value of parameters contained in
the Style Preferences pages.
(See Preferences: Style Preferences on page 95,
and Preferences: Global Setup on page 96).
Bass Inversion
Reference
Split Point
233
234
Track Activity
Gbl
Help/Message Language
Language
Gbl
Use this pop-up menu to select one of the available languages for
the online help system. Operating System version 2.0 supports
the English, French, German, Italian and Spanish languages.
Light Blue
Grey
Dark Blue
No data received.
Acc/Seq Slider
Acc/Seq Slider
Change button
Press this button to apply the selected language to the users
interface.
How to select the Help language
1.
Red
2.
3.
4.
You will be asked if you want to save the Global, and select
the new language. Press Yes to confirm. The Global will be
automatically saved, and the language selected.
5.
6.
Gbl
Auto Select
Program Change
Show Program Change number
Gbl
Gbl
Gbl
235
Controllers: Pedal/Switch
See page 378 for a list of the assignable functions. The first functions are switch-type functions, while the remaining (starting
from Master Volume) are continuous-like functions.
Damper Polarity
Pedal/Footswitch
Gbl
Gbl
Gbl
Reference
This page lets you select a function to the Assignable Pedal/Footswitch, and select the polarity for the Damper and Assignable
Pedal/Footswitch.
236
Controllers: EC5
This page lets you program each of the five switches of the
KORG EC5 multiswitch controller.
Note: After selecting a MIDI Setup, you can apply any changes to
each channels settings. To store the changes in memory, select the
Write Global-Midi Setup command in the page menu to save it to
memory (see Write Global - Midi Setup dialog box on page 257).
Hint: To restore the original MIDI Setups, load the original Factory data again (downloadable from www.korgpa.com).
Note to RX Noise
RX Noises are special sounds that make Sounds be more realistic. They are usually located above C7, depending on the Sound.
Enable
See List of Footswitch and EC5 functions on page 378 for a list
of the assignable functions. The first functions are switch-type
functions, while the remaining (starting from Master Volume)
are continuous-like functions. Only switch functions can be
assigned to the EC5 switches.
General Controls
EC5-AE
Gbl
Use these parameters to set MIDI Clock, Local Off, and MIDI
OUT ports.
Mid
Clock Send
Note: In Song Play mode, only the Sequencer 1 Tempo value will be
sent to the MIDI OUT.
Off
On
Clock Source
This parameter selects the MIDI Clock source for the Style Play
and Sequencer modes.
Note: In Song Play mode, the Internal clock is always used.
Sty
Sng
Seq
MIDI A
MIDI B
Local Control On
On
Off
Off
Mid
Mid
There are two separate Chord channels. This is very useful when
you must send chords to Pa1X on two different channels (like
with some MIDI accordions).
Mid
Mid
Mid
Mid
Mid
Use this parameter to set a fixed velocity (dynamics) value for all
received MIDI notes. This is useful when playing the Pa1X with
an organ or a MIDI Accordion.
Normal
40127
Mid
Midi In Controls
Midi In Octave Transpose
Octave Transpose In
Mid
Off
Midi In Mute/Unmute
Mid
Mid
Octave transpose for all notes received via MIDI by the Harmony section of the Voice Processor.
In Note Range-High
Mid
In Note Range-Low
Mid
Reference
On
237
238
In this page, you can assign Pa1X tracks to any of the MIDI IN
channels.
In this page, you can assign Pa1X tracks to any of the MIDI OUT
channels.
Mid
Channels
Mid
Channels
Off
No track assigned.
Off
No track assigned.
Lower
Lower track.
Lower
Lower track.
Upper 13
Upper 13
Drum
Drum track.
Drum
Drum track.
Percussion
Percussion track.
Percussion
Percussion track.
Bass
Bass track.
Bass
Bass track.
Acc 15
Acc15
Seq.1 Tr 0116
Seq.1 Tr 0116
Control
Left + Right
MIDI: Filters
Use this page to set up to 8 filters for the MIDI data received or
sent by the Pa1X.
239
Track
Out 1 + 2
Track
Out 1
Selected MIDI IN filters.
Off
No filter.
Pitch Bend
Pitch Bend.
MonoTouch
PolyTouch
PrgChange
Program Change.
SysExcl
System Exclusive.
All CC
0127
Track
Out 2
Track
Mid
This page lets you connect Sequencer 1 tracks to the audio outputs. These setting are also applied to the Sequencer mode.
Tracks
Gbl
Use these parameters to assign an audio output (OUTPUT section, on the back of the instrument) to each track.
See Audio Output: Sty/Kbd on page 239 for more information.
Tracks
Gbl
Use these parameters to assign an audio output (OUTPUT section, on the back of the instrument) to each track.
Reference
Midi In Filters
Mid
1&2
240
Drum Category
Kick
Snare
Tom
Tom category.
Hi-Hat
Hi-Hat category.
Cymbals
Cymbals category.
Perc.1
Perc.2
Perc. FX
Sound FX category.
Gbl
Gbl
Use these parameters to assign an audio output (OUTPUT section, on the back of the instrument) to each track.
This page lets you connect the Audio Inputs and the Voice Processor to the audio outputs.
When set to MIC, the MIC input goes to the Voice Processor, while line inputs 1 and 2 are directly connected to
the Left and Right outputs.
Gbl
This parameter lets you decide if Drum Kit Sounds will be sent
to the single output (or output pair) defined for the track they
are assigned to, or each drum category will be sent to a different
output.
Track
Drum Category
When this option is selected, you can select a different output for each category of Drum Kit
sounds. Use the Drum Category box below, to
select an output for each category of percussive
sounds.
Mic
The microphone input is alternative to the line input In 1,
depending on the status of the SELECT switch on the rear panel.
When selected, the signal coming from a connected microphone
goes to the Voice Processor, then is output in stereo together
with any processing made inside the Voice Processor.
In 1
The line input In 1 may be routed to the Left output, or to the
Voice Processor, depending on the status of the SELECT switch
on the rear panel.
In 2
The line input In 2 may be routed to the Right output, or deactivated, depending on the status of the SELECT switch on the rear
panel.
241
Note: The selected Metronome Mode must not be Off, in order for
the click to be sent to an audio output during playback.
See Tracks on page 239 for detailed information on the available outputs.
S/PDIF Out
S/PDIF On/Off
Gbl
This page lets you define various parameters for the Metronome,
the S/PDIF output, and the Speakers (for the Pa1X with integrated speakers).
Off
Speakers
Speakers On/Off
Gbl
Metronome
Mode
Gbl
Use this parameter to activate the metronome for the Style Play
and/or Song play operating modes.
Off
No metronome is heard.
Style
Song
Style+Song
Volume
Gbl
Gbl
MP3 Board
This section only appears when the optional EXBP-MP3 board has
been installed.
Reference
Not available on the Pa1X Pro. On a Pa1X with integrated speakers, use this checkbox to turn speakers on or off. This option is
useful when the instrument is connected to an external amplification system, and you dont need the speakers.
242
Max Volume
Gbl
Harmony Settings
Audio Out
Vibrato Mode
Gbl
CD Audio
This parameter sets whether the vibrato follows the onset and
attack of the model (Boost) or is instantaneous (Manual). The
joystick controls the vibrato in both modes.
Boost
Manual
Gbl
VPs
Vibrato Rx Enable
VPs
Gbl
Octave Transpose
VPs
This transposes the harmony voices in Notes mode (see Harmony Mode on page 248). The value corresponds to octaves.
This is useful when used in conjunction with In Note RangeHigh and In Note Range-Low parameters (see page 237).
When receiving notes from MIDI, this value is summed to the
value of the Octave Transpose In parameter, found in the
MIDI: MIDI In Control page (see page 237).
Pitch Bend Range
VPs
VPs
Setup
Voice Processor Setup
Use this parameter to select a Voice Processor Setup.
Setup parameters are global and do not change when a different
preset is recalled. Setup parameters are all the parameters found
in the Voice Processor Setup edit section, including Lead input
level and pan, Compression/Gate, and EQ parameters among
many others.
They are parameters that would typically be set for a given situation based on the singer, microphone or studio configuration
and then left that way as a basis for the presets within the Voice
Processor. If you change your microphone (or singer!) the EQ/
Compression settings need to only be adjusted once in the setup
section.
If you wish to save your setup settings, just select the Write Global-Voice Processor Setup command from the page menu (see
page 257).
Off
Damper disabled.
Sustain
Harmony Hold
Harmony voices are sustained while you continue
to sing through them. On activation (press and
hold the Damper pedal), you can freeze whatever
the harmony voices are doing, and they will hold
their notes (in a very natural way) until you let
go.
Note: The Harmony Hold function can also be
assigned to an Assignable Footswitch or Switch.
243
This page lets you adjust parameters for the Lead voice (i.e., the
singers voice).
Mic Input
Assign
VPs
Low cut filter. 12dB per octave. Cutoff frequency options include
60, 80 and 120 Hz.
Delay Compensation
VPs
Turning this on delays the lead vocal so that the humanized harmony voices will be randomly ahead and behind the lead voice.
Turning this off results in minimum lead voice processing delay.
Pan/Volume
Pan knob
Dyn
VPs
Compressor/Gate assignment. The options are Off, Lead + Harmony, Harmony or Lead. The compressor has auto-makeup
gain, so there are no output levels problems when selecting a different option.
EQ
VPs
Dynamics
VPs
Adjusts panning for the lead voice. L64 (panned fully left) to R63
(panned fully right).
Level knob
VPs
VPs
Off
Ratio knob
VPs
VPs
EQ
The Voice Processor has an extremely flexible 3-band EQ with
frequency and gain-adjustable high and low shelving bands, as
well as a fully parametric band with Q control.
Low Gain knob
VPs
Frequency
VPs
center
frequency.
Range:
Reference
Low Cut
244
VPs
VPs
VPs
Reverb
Type
VPs
Tlk
High Shelving
80Hz16kHz.
Tlk
Tlk
center
frequency.
Range:
Tlk
Use this parameter to delay the reverb, and separate it from the
lead voice. With higher values, reverb may be perceived as an
echo.
Decay
This page is where you can set the Talk function, to be used to
address the audience, speaking over the background music.
Parameter contained in this page are relative to programming
parameters, and are used to attenuate the music when speaking.
Tlk
Use this parameter to set the reverbs decay time (in seconds).
The higher this value, the more difficult is to understand separate words.
Low Color
Tlk
Tlk
Thicken
On/Off
Talk
Talk
Tlk
On/off switch for the Talk function. This is the same you can
find in the Mic panel of the Style Play and Song Play modes.
Det. (Detune)
Tlk
Level
Mixer
Use this knob to set the level of the voice thickening effect.
Tlk
Use this knob to attenuate the reverb applied to the lead voice.
0dB corresponds to no attenuation.
Tlk
Sets the amount that the detuned voices are panned. A value of
100% results in the detuned voices being hard panned R and L.
A value of 0% results in the detuned voices panned to center.
Tlk
Mode
Auto (AutoTalk)
Tlk
Level knob
Tlk
245
Harmony/Modeling Select
Harmony/Voice Modeling
This page allows you to select a Voice Processor Preset, as well as
turning on or off the various Voice processor modules.
VPp
Harmony On/Off
These are switches for the Lead voice and voices generated by
the Harmony section.
Note: These parameter are the same found in the Mic panel of the
main page of the Style Play and Song Play modes.
Lead
VPp
This checkbox allows turning the lead voice On or Off, independent of the Lead Level knob in the Voice Processor Setup section
(see Level knob on page 243). This is useful in creating presets
where you want to hear harmony voices only.
Note: This parameter is only available when the Harmony section
is turned on. If it is turned off, the Lead parameter is automatically
set to On.
V1V4
VPp
Master On/Off
These are switches for the various Voice Processor sections.
Note: These parameter are the same found in the Mic panel of the
main page of the Style Play and Song Play modes.
Preset
Voice Processor Preset
VPp
This checkbox allows the enabling/disabling of the Pitch Correction module (available as an option).
SB
Thicken
VPp
VPp
VPp
This checkbox allows the enabling/disabling of the Voice Processor Effects module.
Reference
246
Root
VPp
This page contains parameters for the Thicken and the Pitch
Correction module (Pitch Correction available as an option see
Voice Processor: The optional Pitch Correction and Voice Modeling modules on page 252).
Scale Type
VPp
VPp
Pitch Correction attack rate. Sets the responsiveness of the correction. 0% is slow, and 100% is fast. Settings of between 16%
and 40% give the most transparent pitch correction. High settings can give you a robotic sounding effect.
Amount
Thicken
Thickening makes the Lead voice thicker, by adding two ghost
voices to the singers voice.
On/Off
VPp
Spread
With the amount set to 0%, a 10 cent flat input will not be
corrected and a 50 cent flat input will be corrected by
approximately 10 cents.
Window
Level
VPp
Pitch Correction
Available as an option see Voice Processor: The optional Pitch
Correction and Voice Modeling modules on page 252.
The Voice Processor will listen to the pitch of your voice, compare it to the selected correction scale, and then apply pitch correction in realtime. The amount of correction applied is
governed by the various amount and timing settings available.
Pitch correcting your lead voice not only makes for great sounding lead vocals, it can also benefit your harmonies in that the
pitch correction is applied prior to harmony voice generation.
Pitch Correction On/Off
VPp
Sets the amount that the detuned voices are panned. A value of
100% results in the detuned voices being hard panned R and L.
A value of 0% results in the detuned voices panned to center.
Level knob
Pitch Correction Amount. Scales the amount of automatic correction applied to the input voice. The range is 0% to 100%.
However, 0% does not mean that the correction is turned off.
The amount of applied correction depends on how far out of
tune the input note is. This allows for a very musical way of correcting pitch. It corrects the large pitch errors while preserving
the natural micro variations around the target pitch. For example:
VPp
VPp
VPp
VPp
VPp
Spectral
247
VPp
VPp
VPp
Reference
248
Inflection
VPp
VPp
VPp
Harmony
Harmony On/Off
This checkbox allows enabling/disabling of the Harmony module. It is the same control found on the Preset page.
Latch On/Off
Use this knob to set the position in the stereo field of the modelled voices.
VPp
VPp
VPp
VPp
VPp
VPp
VPp
VPp
The amount that the humanization style is applied to the harmony voices.
Tuning
VPp
This gives the option of either Equal temperament, Just intonation, or Barbershop tuning modes. See Harmony and Tuning
with the Voice Processor on page 253 for a full description of
each tuning mode.
In this page you can define general parameters for the Harmony
module.
Portamento
VPp
VPp
Smooth
VPp
Sets how much of the input pitch nuance is applied to the output
voice. Not applicable to Shift presets.
249
Voice
Select
buttons
VPp
VPp
Use these buttons to select one of the four available voices for
editing.
Lower
Upper
Full Keyb.
Voice On/Off
VPp
This checkbox allows enabling/disabling of the selected Harmony Voice. It is the same control found on the Preset page.
Note: The envelope can only work when the Latch On/Off
parameter is turned off (see page 248).
Attack
Gender
VPp
VPp
VPp
Sets the envelope attack time for harmony voices. Available only
in Notes and Chord mode.
Release
VPp
Sets the envelope release time for harmony voices. Available only
in Notes and Chord mode.
Level
Level knob
Sets the overall harmony voices level.
VPp
Reference
The envelope lets you set a different Attack and Release time for
the harmony voices.
250
The range of values goes from Down 5 to Unison to Up6. Additional values are Root1 and Root2 which give the root of the recognized chord as the harmony voice, and Bass1 and Bass2 (bass
voicing) which give the lowest note received. Root2 and Bass2
are the higher pitch Root and Bass settings.
Note Out
24
UNI
In this mode the voices are shifted relative to the input note. The
values range from -24 semitones to +24 semitones.
NC
No Change. The harmony voice will keep its previous pitch until the lead voice pitch changes to a
non NC note.
VPp
VPp
Copy to button
Use this button to copy the current custom map to another
voice. When you press the button, the Copy Custom Voice Mapping dialog box appears:
VPp
Pan/Level
Level knob
VPp
Sets the output level of the selected voice. Please note that there
is also a master harmony voice level found in the Harmony
page.
Pan knob
VPp
Adjusts the pan for the selected voice. L64 (panned fully left) to
R63 (panned fully right).
VPp
251
Decay
VPp
This page allows to adjust the various effect parameters for the
Voice Processor.
Low Color
VPp
VPp
Delay
Type
VPp
FX Mix
Ld to Rv (Lead to Reverb) knob
DualMono
PingPong1
VPp
PingPong2
VPp
Delay
Only available when Src = Manual (see below). Use this parameter to fine adjust (in milliseconds) the current delay time.
VPp
VPp
Feedback
VPp
VPp
Src (Source)
VPp
VPp
Reverb/Delay mix.
FX Lev (FX Level) knob
VPp
Reverb
VPp
The list of reverb types includes the following acoustic simulations: Living Room, Chamber, Club, Classic Hall, Concert Hall,
Large Cathedral, Vocal Studio, Vocal Room, Vocal Hall, Ambience, Live Reverb, Plate1, Plate2, and Spring.
Pre Delay
Manual
R (Ratio)
VPp
Sets the ratio between the tempo and the resulting delay.
Type
MIDI
VPp
Reverb Pre-delay time. Sets the delay time prior to the reverb
output. Large rooms typically have reverbs that start much later
than the initial signal.
VPp
Reference
Use this parameter to set the source of the tempo for the delay.
VPp
252
This page allows you to define four continuous and four switch
dedicated controllers for the Voice Processor, to be assigned to
any physical controller (pedal, footswitch, sliders).
For example, you can first assign the Lead Voice Level to the
Cnt. Ctl. A Voice Processor meta-controller, then assign the
Cnt. Ctl. A option to an Assignable Pedal or Slider.
Two optional software modules are available for the Voice Processor: Pitch Correction and Voice Modeling. These algorithms,
developed by TCHelicon, are the most sophisticated tools available today for voice shaping and correction.
You can purchase them as a single optional plug-in (SUG-TC1)
from our web site www.korgpa.com, or by contacting your Korg
Distributor.
To buy a licence for this software option, press the red Buy button next to each of the parameter names (pages Preset,
Thicken/Pitch Correction or Voice Modeling). The following dialog box will appear, showing you your Pa1X Purchase
Code:
Cnt. Ctl AD
VPp
VPp
Switch controllers. See List of functions assignable to Voice Processors Switch Controls on page 381 for a list of assignable
parameters.
Copy this code, and press Cancel to close the dialog box. Type
the code in the dedicated field of the purchase module (online or
on paper, depending on your purchase option).
After receiving the authorization code, open the above dialog
box again, then press the
(Text Edit) button in the display,
and type it in the Activation Key field.
Press OK to confirm. Your Pitch Correction and Voice Modeling
modules will become completely functional!
253
Chordal harmonies take your chord information to create intelligent, diatonic harmonies based on your voice. To make
Chordal harmonies, you need to input in real time the chords
of the song. This may be done either by playing on the keyboard,
via MIDI or through a programmed sequence of chords
included in the Harmony Track of a Song.
In Chordal mode the Voice Processor will only create harmony
voices that fall on the notes of the chord. Chordal harmonies are
intelligent because they decipher the chord youre playing and
the note youre singing to produce musically pleasing harmonies.
When one note above is defined as a harmony voice (Up1), the
next note from the chord above the input note is output for that
harmony voice.
The subsequent illustration shows the harmony notes for the C
major scale with a voicing selection of a C major chord and a
single one above.
Root: C, Chord Type: Maj, Voicing: Up1
Notes Mode
In this mode, you provide the Voice Processor with specific note
information to determine the pitch of the harmony voices. This
is the most direct and flexible way of creating harmonies, allowing you to weave complex melodies and counter harmonies irrespective of your lead vocal.
Shift Mode
Also known as Fixed Interval, this takes the pitch of your lead
voice and creates harmonies a set number of semitones away,
based on that pitch. The method of creating harmonies, using a
fixed number of semitones relative to an input note or pitch, is
called chromatic harmony, the theory of which well go into
later. We consider this type of harmonizing to be non-intelligent
because Voice Processor is not set to any particular key or scale.
These are pure, parallel harmonies. The most common shift harmony voices are the 5th (7 semitones) and octave (12 semitones), ranging from two octaves below the input to two octaves
above the input pitch.
Below is the C Major scale, showing third above chromatic scale
harmony, as used in Voice Processor Shift Mode.
You might have noticed that each harmony note can cover more
than one input note, or that each input note doesnt necessarily
have a unique harmony note. For instance, C and D both have E
as the 3rd above, E and F share G, and so on. This gives a more
stepped sound to the harmony as the changes are both greater in
magnitude and less frequent than when using other harmony
methods (shift mode for example). The benefit of this method is
that it is very easy to integrate vocal harmonies into your songs if
you already know their chord progressions! The following lists
the chords available with respect to the root of C:
Major
Maj7
M7sus4
min
Eb
min6
Eb
min7
Eb
Bb
min7b5
Eb
Gb
Bb
dim
Eb
Gb
[Bbb (= A)]
Bb
7b5
Gb
Bb
aug
G#
aug7
G#
sus4
sus2
7sus4
Bb
Bb
Reference
254
MAJ1
MAJ2
MAJ3
MIN1
MIN2
MIN3
The following table illustrates the third and fifth above for a
given input note to illustrate the differences between the six different scales. nc means no change, in that the harmony voice
will simply keep its previous pitch until the lead voice pitch
changes to a non nc note.
Lead Voice
C#
Eb
F#
G#
Bb
3rd above
nc
nc
nc
nc
5th above
nc
nc
nc
nc
3rd above
nc
nc
nc
nc
5th above
nc
nc
nc
nc
3rd above
nc
nc
nc
Bb
nc
5th above
nc
nc
Bb
nc
nc
3rd above
Eb
nc
nc
Ab
nc
Bb
nc
nc
5th above
nc
Bb
Bb
nc
nc
Eb
nc
nc
3rd above
Eb
nc
nc
nc
Bb
nc
nc
5th above
nc
Bb
nc
nc
Eb
nc
nc
3rd above
Eb
nc
nc
Ab
nc
nc
nc
5th above
nc
Bb
nc
nc
Eb
nc
nc
255
Just Tuning
Why just tuning? Although probably no one has ever told you
this, your expensive grand piano and the last great keyboard synthesizer you bought are both out of tune! Well, to be fair we can
say instead that they are all tuned using Equal temperament.
Harmony is the result of the interaction between differing audible frequencies in ratios that sound musical to the human ear. A
more exact ratio leads to a nicer sounding harmony.
To recap: we have three different harmony modes that use chromatic or diatonic scales.
The bottom line is that the approximations of equal temperament tuning are practical, but imperfect. Using the Voice Processor with Just tuning will definitely expand your musical
horizons!
Chordal, which uses the root, third, fifth and sometimes seventh
of the many diatonic scales, pitches the harmony voice to the
closest note contained within the chord:
Scalic, which uses one of many diatonic scales, pitches the harmony voice to the nearest note contained within the scale:
Major 3rd
5th
Barbershop differs from Just tuning in Chordal mode. Just tuning will use the root of the chord for the tuning reference, while
Barbershop tuning uses the input notes as the tuning reference.
For this reason it is better to use Barbershop in an a-cappella situation and Just when playing with other instruments, because
Just tuning sounds more in-tune with the other instruments that
most likely have equal temperament tuning.
Our best advice is to experiment and use your ears!
Reference
256
System
1.
When in this page, first touch exactly inside the upper left
set of arrows.
2.
3.
Gbl
Gbl
Gbl
Color set.
Gbl
Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.
257
This way, the next time you will turn the Pa1X on, the preferred
Styles, Sounds and Performances will be still assigned to the relevant buttons.
Gbl
See Write Global - Global Setup dialog box on page 257 for
information on the dialog box.
Write Global-Midi Setup
Select this command to open the Write Global-Midi Setup dialog box, and save the current MIDI settings to a MIDI Setup.
See Write Global - Midi Setup dialog box on page 257 for
more information.
Select this command to open the Write Global-Talk Configuration dialog box, and save the current Talk settings (see Voice
Processor Setup: Talk on page 244).
See Write Global - Talk Configuration dialog box on page 258
for more information.
Write Global-Voice Processor Setup
Mid
Name
Name of the MIDI Setup to be saved. Press the
(Text Edit)
button next to the name to open the Text Edit window and modify the name.
Midi Setup
One of the 8 available MIDI Setup locations, where to save current MIDI settings.
Reference
258
Open this window by selecting the Write Global-Talk Configuration item from the page menu. Here, you can save Voice processors Talk settings (see Voice Processor Setup: Talk on
page 244).
Tlk
VPp
VPs
Name
Voice Preset
VPs
Name
Name of the VP Setup to be saved. Press the
(Text Edit) button next to the name to open the Text Edit window and modify
the name.
Voice Setup
One of the 16 available Voice Setup locations, where to save current VP Setup settings.
Save and use as default
Check this option when saving a VP Setup, you would like to be
automatically selected when turning the instrument on.
259
Floppy Disk
Two internal memory areas are available: the SSD and RAM.
File types
The following tables describe all the file and folder types the
Pa1X can manage. Here are the files you can read or write on the
Pa1X.
Extension
File/folder type
SET
BKP
GBL
Global
VOC
PRF
Performance
PCG
Sound
PCM
Sample
STY
Style
PAD
Pad
SBD
SongBook
SBL
JBX
Jukebox
MID
MP3(a)
MP3 file
(a). To read and write MP3 files, the optional EXBP-MP3 board is
required.
The Pa1X can also read (but not write) the following types of
data.
Extension
File type
KAR
Karaoke file
CDA
Audio CD Track
PCG
KSF
(a)
While a file list is shown in the display, you can select any item by
touching it. The selected item is highlighted.
You can deselect all items in any of the following ways:
KMP
Press the Device pop-up icon, and select the current device
again.
Akai Program
AIF
WAV
Reference
The Disk edit mode is the place where you can manage files. This
edit environment overlaps the current operating mode (Style
Play, Song Play, Sequencer, Sound Edit).
260
Disk structure
Page structure
Each disk (and the internal memory) can contain files and folders. The data in Pa1X is slightly more rigorously structured than
in a computer, due to the pre-configured kind of data inside the
instruments memory. The diagram below shows the global
structure of a Pa1X disk.
Page menu
icon
Disk path
List of files
Scrollbar
MYDIR.SET
GLOBAL
Commands
SETUP.GBL
VPPRESET.VOC
Tabs
SOUND
PERFORM
USER01.PCG
1 Piano 1
128 SynBrass22
BANK01.PRF
1-1 Grand Piano
USER02.PCG
1 SopranoSax
128 Noise
BANK02.PRF
2-1 Jazz Brass
USERDK.PCG
1 Standard Kit
64 Orchestral Kit
BANK.PRF
BANK20.PRF
20-1 Rock Brass
Edit mode
This indicates that the instrument is in Disk mode.
Page menu icon
Press this icon to open the page menu (see Page menu on
page 276).
STYLE
Disk path
BANK01.STY
1-1 8 Beat 1
1-32 8 Beat 16
SONGDB.SBD
BANK.STY
BANK16.STY
16-1 Traditional 1
16-32 Traditional 16
USER01.STY
U1-1 User 1
U1-32 User 16
USER02.STY
U2-1 User 1
U2-32 User 16
USER03.STY
U3-1 User 1
U3-32 User 16
Main page
There is no main page in the disk edit mode. When pressing
EXIT, you exit the Disk mode, and the underlying operating
mode in the background is recalled.
261
Commands
Commands may be different depending on the shown page.
They are detailed in each relevant section.
Tabs
Navigation tools
When in a Disk page, you can use any of the following commands to browse through the files and folders.
Use tabs to select one of the edit pages of the current edit section.
Scrollbar
See Scrollbar above.
TEMPO/VALUE controls
Use these controls scroll the list up or down.
Device pop-up menu
See Device pop-up menu above.
Load/Save/Copy/Erase button
Executes the disk operation.
Open button
Opens the selected folder or directory (whose name begins with
the
icon.
Close button
Reference
262
Load
In this page you can load User data files (Performances, User
Sounds, User Styles, the SongBook, User PCM, the Global) from
a disk to the internal memory (SSD and RAM).
If loading from floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk
drive.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Select the folder containing the type of data you are looking
for, and press Load to confirm your selection.
Note: While in this page, only data allowed for loading are shown.
All other files are hidden.
Warning: When loading a .SET folder containing Sounds associated with PCM data, all existing PCM data in memory are deleted.
Save them before loading the folder.
If loading from floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk
drive.
2.
3.
4.
7.
You can load a single bank of User data (User Sounds, User
Styles, Performances) with a single operation. A bank corresponds to a STYLE SELECT or PERFORMANCE/SOUND
SELECT button.
1.
If loading from floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk
drive.
2.
3.
4.
If loading from floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk
drive.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Select the folder containing the type of data you are looking
for, and press Open to open the selected folder. A list of
User banks appears.
6.
Select the bank you are looking for, and press Open to open
it. A list of User items appears.
Select the folder containing the type of data you are looking
for, and press Open to open the selected folder. A list of
User banks appears.
Reference
5.
263
6.
Select the bank you are looking for, and press Load to confirm the selection. A dialog box appears, asking you to
select one of the available User banks in memory.
264
7.
Select the item you are looking for, and press Load to confirm the load. A dialog box appears, asking you to select
one of the available User locations in memory.
Style Performance to write changes to the Style Performance. Press OK twice to confirm.
8.
9.
10. Save the Style Performance again. Select the Write Current
First load the .SET folder, then separately load the .PCG
file from the PROGRAM folder.
2.
3.
While in the Load page, select the floppy disk (FD) from
the Device pop-up menu.
4.
If you are reading an i30 disk, select the .SET folder and
press the Open button in the display.
5.
6.
At this point, you can load the whole .STY folder, or open
it and select a single Style.
Go to the Style Play mode, and select (one of) the loaded
Style. Adjust the Tempo, then select the Write Current
Save
You can save the full memory content with a single operation.
Note: While in this page, only data allowed for saving are shown.
All other files are hidden.
Here are the various types of files contained in the internal
memory:
contains
If saving to a floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk drive.
2.
3.
4.
Press the New SET button and create a new .SET folder
(see Creating a new .SET folder on page 268), or
Select an existing .SET folder.
All
A .SET folder
Style
Sound
A SOUNDS folder
inside a .SET folder
Perform (Performances)
The Performances
A PERFORM folder
inside a .SET folder
SongBook
A SONGBOOK folder
inside a .SET folder
PCM
Global
A GLOBAL folder
inside a .SET folder. A
.VOC file will be created inside the GLOBAL folder, containing
Voice Processor presets
1.
5.
In the above dialog box, check all data type you wish to save
to disk.
6.
Reference
In this page, you can save User data from the internal memory to
a disk. You can save single files, banks, or all the User files of the
internal memory (i.e., the SSD device).
The file/folder
type
265
266
1.
If saving to a floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk drive.
In addition to the above, you can save all data of a specified type
by selecting the corresponding folder.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
1.
If saving to a floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk drive.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Press the New SET button and create a new .SET folder
(see Creating a new .SET folder on page 268), or
Select an existing .SET folder.
7.
267
4.
5.
Once you have selected the file that you want to save, press
Save To to confirm the selection. The list of files of the target device is shown.
6.
7.
If saving on a floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk drive.
2.
Press the New SET button and create a new .SET folder
(see Creating a new .SET folder on page 268), or
8.
3.
Reference
268
When the directory of the target device is shown in the display, the New SET button appears among the buttons
below the file list.
2.
Copy
In this page you can copy files and folders. Folders can be generic
or .SET folders. In addition, you can copy the content of the
generic folder you are in. You can copy inside the same device, or
from a device to a different one.
To preserve the data structure integrity, during Copy operations
you cant open .SET folders and copy only one of the files it
contains. You can only open generic folders.
Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window. Enter the name, then press OK to confirm and close
the Text Edit window.
4.
Press OK to create the new folder and exit the dialog box.
Note: During the Copy procedure, you cant open a .SET folder.
You can, however, open any generic folder.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
If needed, select the target device, by using the Device popup menu.
7.
8.
269
You can copy a single file or folder, from a generic folder to a different one. The file or folder must be located in the root (the
main/highest level in the disk hierarchy) or into a generic folder.
You cant copy single files or folders from inside a .SET folder.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
While keeping the SHIFT button pressed, continue selecting the other files or folders to be selected.
6.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
If needed, select the target device, by using the Device popup menu.
7.
8.
Cancel
No
While in the Erase and Copy pages of the Disk mode, you can
select several files or folders at the same time before executing
the operation. Files or folders can be selected consecutively (i.e.,
in a row), or discontinuously (i.e., with other files or folders in
the middle).
Yes
2.
3.
4.
5.
Reference
270
Erase
Format
The Erase function lets you erase files and folders from the disks.
With the Erase function you will be able to select the internal
memory (SSD device), and erase files from there. You cannot,
however, delete folders from the internal memory, since they are
used by the operating system.
Erase procedure
1.
If erasing from a floppy disk, insert the disk into the disk
drive.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Volume Label
Use this parameter to assign a name to the device to be formatted.
Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window.
Enter the name, then press OK to confirm and close the Text
Edit window.
Quick Format
This is a very fast format command, that you can use on previously formatted disks. This command rewrites just the FAT (File
Allocation Table) of the disk, without actual reformatting of all
sectors.
If it cannot be executed, the Quick Format failed. Full Format?
message appears. Press Yes to proceed with the Full Format, or
No to cancel.
1.
2.
3.
4.
The If you confirm, all data in the HD/FD will be lost. Are
you sure? message appears in the display. Press Yes to confirm, or No to cancel.
Note: When formatting the hard disk, an additional warning
appears, to avoid accidental data loss.
Full Format
This is the complete format command, where each sector of the
disk is formatted. It is slower than the Quick Format command,
but sometimes more reliable.
See above for the procedure.
Execute button
Press this button, after setting all the options in this page, to execute the Format command.
271
1.
2.
3.
4.
Note: Should you not do a back-up and your internal data becomes
damaged, you can download the data from www.korgpa.com, or
ask your local Korg dealer.
5.
If you wish to save data inside another folder, select this latter and press the Open button to open it. Press the Close
button to go back to the parent folder.
1.
6.
Utility
3.
4.
Backup Resources
Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window. Enter the name, and confirm by pressing OK.
Note: Should you not do a back-up and your internal data becomes
damaged, you can download the original data from
www.korgpa.com. On the Pa1X Pro, a backup file has been provided on the hard disk, under the name PA1X_100.
7.
8.
9.
Restore Resources
This command restores the backup of the internal Factory and
User data, created with the Backup Resources command.
Note: Should you not do a back-up and your internal data becomes
damaged, you can download the original data from
Reference
272
www.korgpa.com. On the Pa1X Pro, a backup file has been provided on the hard disk, under the name PA1X_100.
Warning: Dont play the keyboard while restoring data, and stay in
the Disk mode. Wait until the Wait message disappears.
Preferences
This page includes various protect options, plus the PCM Autoload option and settings for the hard disk sleep time.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Global Protect
7.
When loading a .SET file (see Loading all the User data on
page 262), this parameter (if On) prevents Global parameters
from being reprogrammed when loading all data. All Global
parameters are therefore left unchanged.
8.
9.
Dsk
OS Version Number
When on, this parameter protects the Hard Disk from writing.
Dsk
273
USB/CD
PCM Autoload
Use this page to enable or disable the USB interface, and to write
a CD or a CD image file.
Dsk
On
When turning the instrument on, external samples used by some Sounds are automatically
loaded to RAM.
Off
When turning the instrument on, external samples used by some Sounds are not automatically
loaded. Therefore, these Sound will be muted,
until you use the Load PCM button to load them
to RAM.
USB/CD: USB
The USB interface allows you to access the internal hard disk
from a personal computer (Windows or Macintosh), by just
connecting the Pa1X to its USB interface. This way, you can
quickly backup data from the internal hard disk of the Pa1X to
your personal computer, or exchange data between the Pa1X and
a personal computer.
Note: Windows 2000 and XP, as well as Mac OSX, can be directly
connected to the Pa1X. To connect a Windows 98 computer you
need a dedicated driver, available on www.korgpa.com.
Hint: While USB communication is enabled, you cannot access
other functions on the Pa1X. We suggest you use the USB just after
turning the instrument on, and turn the instrument off and on
again after using and disconnecting it, to be sure USB activities will
not interfere with other disk operations.
Hard Disk USB Connection
Normally, USB is not activated on the Pa1X. Press the Enable
button to turn it on, or the Disable button (with all caveats) to
turn it off.
Enable
Reference
274
with the Write from IMG command on the Pa1X, or by common CD-writing software applications on a personal computer.
After pressing this button, the Select Files page appears. See
Select Files page below.
Write from IMG
Pa1X in Windows
Pa1X in Macintosh
Press this button to disconnect the USB connection. Be careful to press it only when you are
totally sure data transfer has been completed.
Note: USB connection is also automatically disconnected when disconnecting the USB communication on the personal computer side.
To disconnect USB communication on a PC, you
usually select the dedicated command by clicking
on the USB device icon with the right mouse button. On the Mac, select the USB device icon, then
select the Eject command or drag it to the eject
icon in the Dock.
Hint: We suggest to disconnect USB connection
from the personal computer, instead of pressing this
button on the Pa1X.
USB/CD: CD
You can use the (optional) Korg CDRW-1 CD Player/Writer to
write data on CD and CD-RW disks.
While in this page, you can select files or folders, and press the
Select button in the display to add them to the list of files to be
written on a CD.
After having selected all the desired files and/or folders, press the
Next> button to go to the Edit List page. When in the Edit
List page you will be able to return back to this page and continue adding files or folders.
Device pop-up menu
Use this menu to select one of the available storage devices. Note
you can also select removable devices, like a floppy disk or a CD,
but you cannot remove them until the Pa1X has finished creating the image file (see Save IMG below).
Open button
Opens the selected folder (whose name begins with the
icon.
275
CD Label
Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window,
and assign a name to the CD. Enter the name, then press OK to
confirm and close the Text Edit window.
Del All
Press this button to delete the whole list.
Delete
Close button
Closes the current folder, returning to the parent (upper) level.
Select
Selects the highlighted file or folder, and adds it to the list of files
to be written to CD. Greyed-out until a file or folder is selected.
Select an item in the list, then press this button to delete it.
Save IMG
Press this button to save an ISO image file to disk. The generated
image complies with the ISO9660 Mode 1/2048 format (common to most CD-burning applications, such as Ahead Software Nero, Roxio Easy CD Creator, or Roxio Toast).
After you press this button, listed data are collected, and the
Writing ISO image file message appears in the display.
Next>
Jumps to the Edit List page. Greyed-out until a file or folder has
been added to the list.
These (non-editable) indicators show the total number of folders and files included in the list, and their overall size.
1)
When the total size of added data exceeds about 650 MB, the
Total Size parameter turns to red, showing that there are too
many data to fit in a normal CD.
2)
3)
While in this page, you can delete files or folders by pressing the
Delete or Del All button, or press the <Back button to go back to
the Select Files page and add other files.
When the list is done, you can either save it to disk as an image
file by pressing the Save IMG button, or write a CD by pressing
the Write CD button.
When the total size of added data exceeds about 650 MB, the
Total Size parameter turns to red, showing that there are too
many data to fit in a normal CD.
Reference
Exit
276
Page menu
Press the page menu icon to open the menu. Press a command to
select it. Press anywhere in the display to close the menu without
selecting a command.
Speed
Use this pop-up menu to select the writing speed. Depending on
the blank CD quality, higher speeds may also mean less-reliable
data writing.
Simulation
When this parameter is checked, the CD will not be actually
written. Instead, a simulation procedure will start, to let you see
if the writing speed is too high, and should be lowered.
While in simulation mode, the Write CD dialog boxs title will
change to Write CD - Simulation Mode.
At the end of the simulation procedure, the CD is automatically
ejected.
Close CD
With operating system version 2.0, Pa1X can only write a single
session on a CD. However, the CD can be left open, to let you
add other sessions from a PC or Mac on the same CD.
By pressing the
(Text Edit) button you can open the Text
Edit window. Enter the name, then press OK to confirm and
close the Text Edit window.
Rename
Cancel
Exits from the dialog box, and returns to the previous page.
Use this function to change the name of a file or folder. To preserve consistency through the data structure, you cannot rename
single files inside a .SET folder. Also, you cannot change the 3-
CD Info
Select this command to see various info on the selected CD.
Write CD
Press this button to start writing the CD, or the Simulation procedure. You will be asked to insert a blank CD into the CD
Writer.
In case you insert a CD-RW (rewritable) containing data, you
are asked if you want to delete all its content. Warning: This will
delete all the data already contained on the CD-RW!
277
Ordered by Name
Select this display option to see the list of files and folders in
rough alphabetical order, with different file types mixed in the
list. The File label, above the file list, is shown in red.
Ordered by Type
Press the
(Text Edit) button to open the Text Edit window.
Enter the new name, then press OK to confirm and close the
Text Edit window.
Select this display option to see the list of files and folders
ordered by type. Inside any type group, files are still in alphabetical order. The Type label, above the file list, is shown in red.
Object info
Select this command to see the size of any selected file or folder
on disk. Also, the number of files and directories it contains are
shown.
Ascending/Descending
Use this command to switch between the ascending (Numbers,
AZ) and descending (ZA, Numbers) order.
Write Global-Disk Preference
Select this command to open the Write Global-Disk Preferences
dialog box, and save settings executed in the Preferences page
(see Preferences on page 272).
Note: The single file size is always shown on the right of the file
name in any file list:
Protect
Select this command to protect the selected file or folder from
writing/erasing. The lock icon will appear next to the file or
folder name.
Unprotect
Select this command to unprotect the selected file or folder if
protected.
Dsk
Reference
Device Info
278
Disk handling
The Pa1X can save most of the data contained in memory on the
internal hard disk (if fitted), or on a 3,5 DS-DD disk (720KB
capacity) or HD (1,44MB capacity), MS-DOS-formatted. Here
are some precautions when handling disks.
Eject button
Precautions
Hard disk write protection
You can protect your hard disk from writing, by using the software protection found in Disk mode (see Hard Disk Protect
on page 272).
Possible problems
279
Bonus software
With Pa1X Pro, three .SET folders have been saved in the internal hard disk, with the whole content of Korgs Real Drums
and Turkish/Arabic World collections, formerly available as
separate cards for the Pa80/Pa60 series.
These are high quality sound sets, based on additional RAM
PCM Samples. Go to www.korgpa.com for more information.
To load these sounds, select either the REALDRUM.SET or
TA_WORLD.SET folder from the hard disk. By loading the
BONUS_SW.SET folder, you can load both collections at the
same time.
Warning: When loading the above folders, all User data in memory is deleted. Save important data to disk, before loading the
bonus software.
Reference
Note: After turning the instrument off, all samples are deleted from
the RAM memory. You can either have them automatically
reloaded when turning the instrument on again (see PCM Autoload on page 273), or manually load them (see Load PCM button on page 273).
280
MIDI
What is MIDI?
MIDI
What is MIDI?
Here is a brief overview of MIDI, as related to the Pa1X. If interested, you may find more information on the general use of
MIDI in the various specialized magazines and dedicated books.
In general
MIDI stands for Musical Instruments Digital Interface. This
interface lets you connect two musical instruments, or a computer and various musical instruments.
Physically, MIDI is composed of three different connectors. The
MIDI IN receives data from another device; the MIDI OUT
sends data to another device; the MIDI THRU sends to another
device exactly what was received on the MIDI IN (this is useful
to daisy-chain more instruments).
On the Pa1X there are two separate sets of MIDI ports, labeled
IN A, OUT A, IN B, OUT B. Each OUT port may work as a
THRU port, depending on the status of the MIDI A Out/Thru
Mode and MIDI B Out/Thru Mode parameters in the Global
mode (see page 237).
Tempo
Lyrics
After Touch This message is generated by pressing on the keyboard, after the note has been struck. It usually activates vibrato,
or other sound parameters.
When in Song Play mode, the Pa1X can also display SMF lyrics
in Solton, M-Live (Midisoft), Tune1000, Edirol, GMX, HitBit,
and XF formats, and the chord abbreviations of SMF in Solton,
M-live (Midisoft), GMX, and XF format.
Pitch Bend (PB) You can generate this message acting on the
joystick (X direction). The pitch is translated up or down.
Control Change (CC) This is a wide array of messages, controlling most of the instrument parameters. Some examples:
MIDI
The General MIDI standard
Some years ago, the musical instruments world felt a need for
some further standardization. Then, the General MIDI Standard
(GM) was born. This extension of the basic MIDI sets new rules
for compatibility between instruments:
MIDI Setup
Any channels with the Global option assigned (see MIDI: MIDI
In Channels on page 238) can simulate the Pa1X integrated
keyboard. When the Pa1X is connected to a master keyboard,
transmission should take place over the Global channel of the
Pa1X.
You can play Pa1X with an external controller, and use it simply
as a powerful sound generator. To help you configure the MIDI
channels, we have provided a set of MIDI Setups (see Midi
Setup on page 96 for the Style Play mode, Midi Setup on
page 153 for the Song Play mode, and MIDI Setup on page 236
for the Global mode).
The MIDI messages received over a Global channel and not over
a standard channel are affected by the buttons of the KEYBOARD MODE section, as well from the split point. Therefore,
if the SPLIT button LED is lit up, the notes that arrive to the
Pa1X over this channel will be divided by the split point into the
Upper (above the split point) and Lower (below the split point)
parts.
The notes that arrive to a Global channel are used for the chord
recognition of the automatic accompaniment. If the KEYBOARD MODE is SPLIT, only the notes below the split point
will be used. These notes will be combined with the ones of the
special Chord 1 and Chord 2 channels.
You can set two special Chord channels (see page 238) to send to
the Pa1X notes for the chord recognition. The notes will be combined with the notes that go through the channel set as Global
(Global notes are recognized only under the split point, if the
SPLIT LED is lit up).
The Chord channels are not affected by the split point and the
KEYBOARD MODE section of the control panel. All the notes
both above and below the split point will be sent to the chord
recognition.
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
The buttons of the CHORD SCANNING section have a particular effect on the Chord channels:
Reference
281
282
MIDI
Connecting the Pa1X to a MIDI accordion
section in the control panel will affect the notes received from
the master keyboard.
2.
3.
6.
2.
5.
4.
5.
MIDI
Connecting the Pa1X to an external sequencer
MIDI OUT
MIDI IN
283
The Sounds
MIDI IN
MIDI OUT
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Reference
284
MIDI
Playing another instrument with the Pa1X
2.
3.
Set the master volume of the other instrument with its own
volume controls.
4.
5.
The Keyboard
Pa1Xs keyboard can drive up to four tracks via the MIDI OUT
(Upper 1-3 and Lower). MIDI output channels are set in Global
mode (see MIDI: MIDI Out Channels on page 238).
As a default situation (1-Default MIDI Setup), each of Pa1X
Keyboard tracks transmit on the following channels:
Track
Out Channel
Upper1
Upper2
Upper3
Lower
The Sequencer
Any Sequencers track can drive a channel on an external instrument. To set each tracks MIDI output channel, see MIDI:
MIDI Out Channels on page 238.
To hear only the expanders sounds, you can lower the MASTER
VOLUME control on the Pa1X, or set the Song tracks to the
External status (see Track Controls: Mode on page 181).
Select the Sequencer 1 or Sequencer 2 MIDI Setup (depending on the Sequencer you are using on the Pa1X) to set the channels as follows.
Track
Out Channel
Song 116
116
The Arranger
One of the most interesting aspect of MIDI, is that you can use
your Pa1X to play an external instrument with its onboard
arranger. Yes, its hard to beat the audio quality of Pa1X, but you
could wish to use that old faithful synth you are still accustomed
to
To assign some of Pa1X Style tracks to an external instrument,
set them to the External status (see Track Controls: Mode on
page 181).
Select the Default MIDI Setup to set the channels as follows
(this is the default status of Pa1X).
Track
Out Channel
Bass
Drums
10
Percussion
11
Acc15
1216
Appendix
286
Factory data
Styles
Factory data
Styles
Note: You can remotely select Styles on the Pa1X, by sending it Bank Select MSB (CC#0), Bank Select LSB (CC#32) and Program Change
messages on the Control channel (see MIDI: MIDI In Channels on page 238).
#
CC#0
CC#32
PC
Moonlight Ballad
CC#0
CC#32
PC
Kool Beat
CC#0
CC#32
PC
Funky Ballad
Easy Beat
Slow HipHop
Unplugged Gtr1
Ballad
Unplugged 16 Bt
Easy Ballad 3
Real 16 Beat
Analog Ballad
Guitar Beat
Groove Ballad
British Pop 1
Easy Pop
Unplugged Gtr 3
Pop Chart 1
Standard 16 Bt 1
Soft Ballad
Unplugged Rock
Meditando
Easy Ballad 1
Pop Hits
Unplugged Gtr 4
British Pop 2
Unplugged Gtr 5
10
Classic 8 Bt 1
Analog Beat 1
Serenade
11
10
Classic 8 Bt 2
10
Analog Beat 2
10
Unplugged Bld 1
12
11
Soft Beat 1
11
Guitar Ballad 1
11
Acoustic Ballad
13
12
Unplugged 8 Bt 1
12
Guitar Ballad 2
12
Unplugged Bld 2
14
13
Light Rock 1
13
8 Beat Analog 1
13
Pop Jazz
15
14
Light Rock 2
14
Analogyst
14
Diva
16
15
Easy Ballad 2
15
8 Beat Analog 2
15
Rock Ballad 1
17
16
Soft Beat 2
16
Trendy Beat
16
Folk Ballad
18
17
Pop Beat 2
17
Slow Ballad
17
Pop Ballad 2
19
18
Standard 8 Beat
18
6 Strings Beat
18
20
19
Unplugged 8 Bt 2
19
19
Country Ballad 1
21
20
Love 8 Beat
20
Standard 16 Bt 2
20
4/4 Ballad
22
21
Half Beat
21
Pop 16 Beat 1
21
Love Ballad
23
22
UK 8 Beat
22
Pop 16 Beat 2
22
Natural Beat
24
23
8 Beat Groove
23
Cinema Ballad
23
Celtic Ballad
25
24
UK R & B
24
Windy Beat
24
16 Beat Analog 1
26
25
Pop Ballad 1
25
Home Beat
25
Color Beat
27
26
HipHop Beat
26
26
Pop Ballad 3
28
27
Miami Beat
27
27
8 Beat Analog 3
29
28
Classic Beat 3
28
28
16 Beat Analog 2
30
29
Real 8 Beat
29
29
31
30
Easy Groove
30
30
32
31
31
31
Factory data
Styles
CC#0
CC#32
PC
Easy Listening
Bank: Ballroom
CC#0
CC#32
PC
Bank: Dance
Dance Fever
CC#0
CC#32
PC
Bank: Rock
Pop Shuffle
Groove It Up
English Rock
Slow Band
Club Latin
Open Rock 1
Foxtrot 1
Barry Dance
Open Rock 2
Organ Foxtrot
Pop Rock
Movie Ballad
Philly Disco
Fire Rock
Pop Chart 2
Oriental Dance 1
Hard Rock
Twist
Heavy Rock
South Strait
Organ Waltz
House Garage
10
Slow Waltz 1
House
South Shuffle
11
10
Slow Waltz 2
10
Dream
10
Rock Shuffle
12
11
Slow Waltz 3
11
Techno
11
Rock Ballad 2
13
12
Slow Waltz 4
12
Underground
12
Half Time
14
13
Slow Waltz 5
13
Progressive
13
Rock 6/8
15
14
Slow 6/8
14
Jungle
14
Abbey Road
16
15
Slow Pop
15
Rap
15
Soft Rock
17
16
Slow Rock 1
16
HipHop
16
Surf Rock
18
17
Slow Rock 2
17
Disco 70
17
Pop Shuffle 1
19
18
18
80's Dance
18
Blues Shuffle
20
19
19
Love Disco
19
60's Rock
21
20
20
Disco Party
20
22
21
21
Disco Funky
21
23
22
Operetta
22
Disco Gully
22
24
23
Quick Step 1
23
Dance 80
25
24
Quick Step 2
24
26
25
New Jive
25
25
27
26
Charleston
26
26
28
27
Foxtrot 2
27
27
29
28
Slow Fox
28
28
30
29
Foxtrot 3
29
29
31
30
30
30
32
31
31
CC#0
CC#32
PC
Kool Funk
3
4
23
24
31
CC#0
CC#32
PC
Bank: World 1
CC#0
CC#32
PC
Oberkr. Waltz 1
Bank: World 2
Hawaiian
Swing HipHop
Oberkr. Waltz 2
Country Beat
Funky Sisters
Oberkr. Waltz 3
Folk Beat
Steely Feel
Oberkr. Polka 1
Kountry Pop
Al Funk
Oberkr. Polka 2
Bluegrass
Elektrik Funk
German Polka 1
Country 8 Beat
Classic Funk
German Polka 2
Country 16 Beat
Talkin' Jazz
Oberkr. Polka
Country Beat
Pop Shuffle
Bavarian Pop 1
Modern Country
10
Easy Funk
Bavarian Pop 2
Country Boogie
11
10
Dance Funk
10
Polka Pop 1
10
Country Shuffle 1
12
11
Club Funk
11
Polka Pop 2
11
Country Shuffle 2
13
12
Blues Ballad
12
Party Polka
12
Country Ballad 2
14
13
Modern Gospel 1
13
Classic Flipper
13
Country 3/4
15
14
Modern Gospel 2
14
Flipper 6/8
14
Orleans
16
15
Gospel Shuffle
15
Flipper 4/4
15
Celtic Waltz
17
16
Rubber Funk
16
Dance Schlager
16
Mexican Waltz
18
17
Groove Funk
17
Fox Schlager
17
Norteno 1
19
18
Acid Jazz 1
18
Medium Schlager
18
Banda 2/4
20
19
Double Beat
19
Disco Schlager
19
Norteno 2
21
20
Groove
20
Schlager 1
20
Quebradita
22
21
Jazz Funk
21
Schlager 2
21
Tejano
23
22
Al Swing
22
Schlager 3
22
Cajun
24
23
HipHop Funk
23
Schlager 4
23
Zydeco
25
24
HipHop Soul
24
Pop Schlager
24
Celtic Dream
26
25
Motown Shuffle
25
Petry Rock 1
25
27
26
Pop Ballad 4
26
Petry Rock 2
26
28
27
27
Trucker
27
29
28
Soul 1
28
Schlager 5
28
30
29
Memphis
29
Volkst.Schlager
29
31
30
Motown 1
30
Sambamedley
30
32
31
Gospel
31
Partymix
31
Appendix
287
288
Factory data
Styles
CC#0
CC#32
PC
Flamenco
Bank: World 3
CC#0
CC#32
PC
10
Guitar Bossa
Bank: Latin 1
CC#0
CC#32
PC
11
Oriental Dance 2
Oriental Ballad
5
6
Bank: Latin 2
Salsa 1
Unplugged Bossa
Salsa 2
Cool Bossa
Mambo 1
Hora
Orchestral Bossa
Mambo Party
Sevillana 1
Meditation Bossa
English Tango
Sevillana 2
Basic Bossa
Orchestral Tango
Jota
L.A. Bossa
Tango.it
Copla
Groove Bossa
Italian Tango
Classic 3/4
New Bossa
Habanera 1
10
Bolero
Lite Bossa
Habanera 2
11
10
Minuetto
10
Lite Beguine
10
Mambo 2
12
11
Baroque
11
Latin Pop
11
Mambo 3
13
12
New Age
12
Latin Rock 1
12
Mambo 2000
14
13
Tarantella
13
Latin Rock 2
13
Salsa 3
15
14
Raspa
14
Latin Funk
14
Salsa 4
16
15
Vahde
15
Unplugged Latin
15
Mariachi
17
16
Oriental
16
Cha Cha 1
16
Reggae 1
18
17
Roman
17
17
Happy Reggae
19
18
Ciftetelli
18
18
Reggae 2
20
19
19
19
Reggae 3
21
20
20
Cha Cha 2
20
Pasodoble 1
22
21
21
21
Pasodoble Banda
23
22
22
Beguine 1
22
Pasodoble 2
24
23
23
Pop Beguine
23
Argentina Tango
25
24
24
Tradit. Bolero
24
26
25
25
Slow Bolero
25
27
26
26
Sabor
26
28
27
27
27
29
28
28
28
30
29
29
29
31
30
30
30
32
31
31
CC#0
CC#32
PC
12
Brazilian Samba
3
4
31
CC#0
CC#32
PC
Bank: Jazz 1
CC#0
CC#32
PC
13
Bigger Band
14
Bank: Jazz 2
Andean
Big Band 1
Dance Band
Gipsy Dance
Soft Jazz
Show Time
Latin Dance 1
BeBop 1
Movie Swing
Jazz Brush
Xmas Swing
Samba
Medium Swing
Django
Sambalegre
Slow Swing
Hollywood 1
Disco Samba
Swing Ballad 1
Hollywood 2
Samba Funk
50's Swing
Broadway
10
Rhumba 1
Swing Ballad 2
Dixieland
11
10
Merengue 1
10
Unplug. Swing 1
10
Big Band 4
12
11
Merengue 2
11
Swing Ballad 3
11
Swing Shuffle
13
12
Cumbia
12
BeBop 2
12
14
13
Latin Dance 2
13
13
15
14
Batucada
14
14
16
15
Rhumba 2
15
Big Band 2
15
Acid Jazz 2
17
16
Gipsy
16
Jazz Waltz 1
16
New Jazz
18
17
Pop Rhumba
17
Jazz Waltz 2
17
Latin Jazz
19
18
Calypso
18
Jazz Waltz 3
18
Fusion
20
19
Lambada
19
5/4 Swing
19
Ragtime Piano
21
20
Meneito
20
Vocal Swing
20
Shuffle Piano
22
21
Macarena
21
Big Band 3
21
Boogie Piano
23
22
22
Mood Swing
22
Bossa Piano
24
23
23
Unplug. Swing 2
23
25
24
24
26
25
25
25
27
26
26
26
28
27
27
27
29
28
28
28
30
29
29
29
31
30
30
30
32
31
31
31
24
Factory data
Styles
CC#0
CC#32
PC
15
Italian Waltz 1
German Waltz 1
Walzer Musette
Vienna Waltz
Viennese
Tradit. Polka
French March
March
Italian Waltz 2
10
Italian Waltz 3
11
10
Italian Waltz 4
10
10
12
11
Valzer
11
11
13
12
Italian Waltz 5
12
12
14
13
German Waltz 2
13
13
15
14
German Waltz 3
14
14
16
15
Laendler
15
15
17
16
Mazurka 1
16
16
18
17
Mazurka 2
17
17
19
18
Mazurka 3
18
18
20
19
Italian Polka
19
19
21
20
Polka 1
20
20
22
21
Polka 2
21
21
23
22
German Polka
22
22
24
23
Mazurka 4
23
23
25
24
Polka 3
24
24
26
25
25
25
27
26
26
26
28
27
27
27
29
28
28
28
30
29
29
29
31
30
30
30
32
31
31
31
CC#0
CC#32
PC
23-31
CC#0
CC#32
PC
17-19
CC#0
CC#32
PC
20-22
10
11
10
10
10
12
11
11
11
13
12
12
12
14
13
13
13
15
14
14
14
16
15
15
15
17
16
16
16
18
17
17
17
19
18
18
18
20
19
19
19
21
20
20
20
22
21
21
21
23
22
22
22
24
23
23
23
25
24
24
24
26
25
25
25
27
26
26
26
28
27
27
27
29
28
28
28
30
29
29
29
31
30
30
30
32
31
31
31
Appendix
Bank: Traditional
289
290
Factory data
Style Elements
Style Elements
Note: You can remotely select the various Style Elements on the Pa1X, by sending it Program Change messages on the Control channel (see
MIDI: MIDI In Channels on page 238).
PC
Style Element
PC
Style Element
PC
Style Element
PC
Style Element
PC
Style Element
80
Variation 1
81
Variation 2
82
Variation 3
83
Variation 4
84
Intro 1
85
Intro 2
86
Fill 1
87
Fill 2
88
Ending 1
89
Ending 2
90
Fill 3/Break
Note: The above Program Change numbers are given according to the 0-127 numbering system.
CC#32
PC
STS
PC
STS
PC
STS
PC
STS
64
STS 1
65
STS 2
66
STS 3
67
STS 4
Factory data
Sounds
Sounds
The following table lists all Pa1X Factory Sounds in order of
Bank Select-Program Change number.
Legend: The table also includes MIDI data used to remotely select
the Sounds. CC00: Control Change 0, or Bank Select MSB. CC32:
Control Change 32, or Bank Select LSB. PC: Program Change.
Bank: Sound/Performance Select button.
CC00
CC32
PC
121
121
121
CC00
CC32
PC
121
11
121
12
121
291
Name
Bank
GM2
DW8000 EP
E. Piano
Sweeping EP
E. Piano
13
White Pad EP
E. Piano
121
Harpsichord
Piano
121
Harpsi Octave
Piano
121
Harpsi Wide
Piano
121
Piano
121
Harpsi Korg
Piano
121
Clav
Piano
121
Pulse Clav
Piano
Name
Bank
GM2
121
Clav Wah
Piano
Acoustic Piano
Piano
121
Clav Snap
Piano
Piano
121
Sticky Clav
Piano
Piano
121
Celesta
121
Grand Piano
Piano
121
Glocken
121
Classic Piano
Piano
121
Sistro
121
L/R Piano
Piano
121
10
Music Box
121
Piano
121
10
Orgel
121
Piano
121
11
Vibraphone 1
Piano
121
11
Vibrap. Wide
11
Vibraphone 2
121
Grand Piano 2
121
Bright Piano
Piano
121
121
Bright PianoWide
Piano
121
12
Marimba
121
Piano Pad 1
Piano
121
12
Marimba Wide
121
Piano Pad 2
Piano
121
12
121
Piano StringPad
Piano
121
12
Monkey Skuls
121
E. Gran Piano
Piano
121
12
Log Drum
121
E. Grand Wide
Piano
121
12
Mallet Clock
12
Balaphon
121
M1 Piano
Piano
121
121
90's Piano
Piano
121
13
Xylophone
121
2000's Piano
Piano
121
14
Tubular Bell
121
Chorus Piano
Piano
121
14
Church Bell 1
121
Piano Layers
Piano
121
14
Carillon
121
Honky-Tonk
Piano
121
14
Church Bell 2
121
Honky Wide
Piano
121
15
Dulcimer
15
Santur
121
Electric Piano 1
E. Piano
121
121
Detuned EP 1
E. Piano
121
16
Drawbars Organ1
Organ
16
Det.DrawbarsOrg.
Organ
121
EP1 Veloc.sw
E. Piano
121
121
60's E. Piano
E. Piano
121
16
Organ
121
Vintage EP
E. Piano
121
16
Drawbars Organ2
Organ
121
Pro Dyno EP
E. Piano
121
16
Organ
121
Pro Stage EP
E. Piano
121
16
Organ
121
Studio EP
E. Piano
121
16
Full Drawbars
Organ
121
R&B E. Piano
E. Piano
121
16
DWGS Organ
Organ
E. Piano
121
16
Jazz Organ
Organ
16
Gospel Organ
Organ
121
Thin E. Piano
121
10
Dyno Tine EP
E. Piano
121
121
11
Club E. Piano
E. Piano
121
10
16
Good Old B
Organ
121
12
Classic Wurly
E. Piano
121
11
16
VOX Legend
Organ
121
13
Soft Wurly
E. Piano
121
12
16
Arabian Organ
Organ
121
14
Hard Wurly
E. Piano
121
13
16
Organ
121
15
Vel. Wurly
E. Piano
121
14
16
Drawbars Organ3
Organ
E. Piano
121
17
Perc. Organ 1
Organ
E. Piano
121
17
Det.Perc.Organ
Organ
17
Perc. Organ 2
Organ
Organ
121
121
16
0
4
5
Tremolo Wurly
Electric Piano 2
Detuned EP 2
E. Piano
121
EP2 Veloc.sw
E. Piano
121
17
Old Wheels
121
EP Legend
E. Piano
121
17
Percuss. BX3
Organ
121
EP Phase
E. Piano
121
17
M1 Organ
Organ
121
Syn Piano X
E. Piano
121
17
Techno Org.Bass
Organ
121
Stereo Dig. EP
E. Piano
121
17
Organ
121
Classic Dig. EP
E. Piano
121
17
Rotary Organ
Organ
E. Piano
121
17
Perc.StereoOrgan
Organ
10
17
Perc. Organ 3
Organ
18
Rock Organ
Organ
121
Hybrid EP
121
Classic Tines
E. Piano
121
121
10
Phantom Tine
E. Piano
121
Appendix
121
121
292
Factory data
Sounds
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
Bank
121
18
BX3 Vel. Sw
121
18
Killer B
121
18
121
121
121
GM2
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
Bank
Organ
121
23
Acc.Voice Change
Accordion
Organ
121
23
Accordion 16 4'
Accordion
Dirty B
Organ
121
23
Accordion
18
Classic Click
Organ
121
23
Accordion
18
Distortion Organ
Organ
121
10
23
Tango Accordion2
Accord
18
Super BX Perc.
Organ
121
24
Nylon Guitar 1
Guitar
121
18
Organ
121
24
Ukulele
Guitar
121
18
Perc.Short Decay
Organ
121
24
Guitar
121
18
Perc. Wheels
Organ
121
24
Nylon Guitar 3
Guitar
121
10
18
Jimmy Organ
Organ
121
24
Nylon Bossa
Guitar
121
11
18
Rock Organ 2
Organ
121
24
Ac.Guitar KeyOff
Guitar
121
19
Church Organ
Organ
121
24
Spanish Guitar
Guitar
121
19
Organ
121
24
Guitar Strings
Guitar
121
19
Detuned Church
Organ
121
24
Guitar
121
19
Pipe Mixture
Organ
121
24
Brazilian Guitar
Guitar
121
19
Church Pipes
Organ
121
10
24
Guitar
121
19
Full Pipes
Organ
121
11
24
Guitar
121
19
Pipe Tutti 1
Organ
121
12
24
Guitar
121
19
Positive Organ
Organ
121
13
24
Guitar
121
19
Pipe Tutti 2
Organ
121
14
24
Guitar
121
19
Pipe Tutti 3
Organ
121
15
24
Nylon Guitar 2
Guitar
121
20
Reed Organ
Organ
121
25
Steel Guitar 1
Guitar
121
20
Puff Organ
Organ
121
25
12 Strings Gtr
Guitar
121
20
Small Pipe
Organ
121
25
Mandolin
Guitar
121
20
Flauto Pipes
Organ
121
25
Guitar
121
20
Pipe Flute
Organ
121
25
Steel Guitar 2
Guitar
121
21
Accordion 1
Accordion
121
25
Steel 12 Strings
Guitar
121
21
Accordion 2
Accordion
121
25
Hackbrett
Guitar
121
21
Akordeon
Accordion
121
25
Guitar
121
21
Musette 1
Accordion
121
25
Finger Tips
Guitar
121
21
Musette 2
Accordion
121
25
Guitar
121
21
Musette Clar.
Accordion
121
10
25
Guitar
121
21
Fisa 16, 8
Accordion
121
11
25
Mandolin Trem.
Guitar
121
21
Fisa 16, 4
Accordion
121
12
25
Reso. Guitar
Guitar
121
21
Fisa Master
Accordion
121
13
25
Guitar
121
21
Cassotto
Accordion
121
14
25
Guitar
121
10
21
Arabic Accordion
Accordion
121
15
25
Guitar
121
11
21
Sweet Musette
Accordion
121
16
25
Guitar
121
12
21
Cassotto 16'
Accordion
121
17
25
12 Strings Pro
Guitar
121
13
21
Cassotto Or.Tune
Accordion
121
18
25
12 Strings RX
Guitar
121
14
21
Cassotto NorTune
Accordion
121
19
25
Guitar
121
15
21
Detune Accordion
Accordion
121
20
25
Steel Guitar 3
Guitar
121
16
21
2 Voices Musette
Accordion
121
21
25
Steel Guitar 4
Guitar
121
17
21
3 Voices Musette
Accordion
121
26
Jazz Guitar
Guitar
121
18
21
France Musette
Accordion
121
26
Guitar
121
19
21
Acc.Clarinet OT
Accordion
121
26
Guitar
121
20
21
Acc. Clarinet NT
Accordion
121
26
Guitar
121
21
21
Acc. Piccolo OT
Accordion
121
26
Guitar
121
22
21
Acc. Piccolo NT
Accordion
121
26
Guitar
121
23
21
Master Accordion
Accordion
121
26
JazzGtr SlidePro
Guitar
121
24
21
Accordion 3
Accord
121
27
Clean Guitar 2
Guitar
121
22
Harmonica 1
Accordion
121
27
Guitar
121
22
Sweet Harmonica
Accordion
121
27
Guitar
121
22
Harmonica 2
Accordion
121
27
Chorus Guitar
Guitar
121
22
Harmonica AT
Accordion
121
27
Vintage S.2
Guitar
121
22
Harmonica 3
Accord
121
27
Proces.E.Guitar
Guitar
121
23
Tango Accordion
Accordion
121
27
Single Coil
Guitar
121
23
Fisa Tango!
Accordion
121
27
New Stra.Guitar
Guitar
121
23
Accordion 16 8'
Accordion
121
27
Guitarish
Guitar
121
23
Accordion16 8 4'
Accordion
121
27
L&R E.Guitar 1
Guitar
121
23
Accordion
121
10
27
L&R E.Guitar 2
Guitar
121
23
Accordion Bass
Accordion
121
11
27
Country Nu
Guitar
GM2
Sounds
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
Bank
121
12
27
121
13
27
121
14
27
121
15
121
16
121
GM2
293
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
Bank
Guitar
121
33
Finger E.Bass2
Bass
Guitar
121
33
Finger E.Bass3
Bass
Guitar
121
33
Stick Bass
Bass
27
Guitar
121
33
Finger Bass 1
Bass
27
Guitar
121
33
Finger Bass 2
Bass
17
27
Guitar
121
33
Chorus Fing.Bass
Bass
121
18
27
Guitar
121
33
Bright Finger B.
Bass
121
19
27
Vintage S.1
Guitar
121
10
33
Bass
121
20
27
Clean Guitar 1
Guitar
121
11
33
Bass
121
21
27
Solid Guitar
Guitar
121
12
33
Finger Slap 1
Bass
121
22
27
Stein Guitar 1
Guitar
121
13
33
Finger Bass RX
Bass
121
23
27
Stein Guitar 2
Guitar
121
14
33
FingerB.& Guitar
Bass
121
24
27
Stein Guitar 3
Guitar
121
15
33
Finger Bass 4
Bass
121
25
27
Clean Guitar 3
Guitar
121
34
Picked E.Bass 3
Bass
121
28
Muted Guitar
Guitar
121
34
Picked E.Bass 1
Bass
121
28
Guitar
121
34
Picked E.Bass 2
Bass
121
28
Guitar
121
34
Stein Bass
Bass
121
28
Jazz Man
Guitar
121
34
Guitar Bass
Bass
121
28
R&R Guitar
Guitar
121
34
Bass Mute
Bass
121
28
Stra. Chime
Guitar
121
34
Bass&Gtr Double
Bass
121
28
Guitar
121
34
Bass
121
28
Rhythm E.Guitar
Guitar
121
34
Bass
121
28
Clean Funk
Guitar
121
34
Ticktacing Bass
Bass
121
28
Disto Mute
Guitar
121
10
34
Picked Bass RX
Bass
121
10
28
Guitar
121
11
34
Picked E. Bass 4
Bass
121
11
28
Guitar
121
35
Fretless Bass 1
Bass
121
12
28
Guitar
121
35
Fretless Bass2
Bass
121
13
28
Guitar
121
35
Fretless Sw.
Bass
121
14
28
Guitar
121
35
Sweet Fretless
Bass
121
15
28
Guitar
121
35
Bass
121
16
28
Guitar
121
35
Bass
121
17
28
Guitar
121
35
Woofer Pusher B.
Bass
121
18
28
Guitar
121
35
Fretless Bass3
Bass
121
19
28
Muted Guitar 2
Guitar
121
36
Slap Bass 2
Bass
121
29
Overdrive Guitar
Guitar
121
36
Super Sw.Bass1
Bass
121
29
Guitar Pinch
Guitar
121
36
Super Sw.Bass2
Bass
121
30
Distortion Gtr
Guitar
121
36
FunkSlap Bass RX
Bass
121
30
Feedback Guitar
Guitar
121
36
SlapFing Bass RX
Bass
121
30
Dist.Rhytmic Gtr
Guitar
121
36
SlapPick Bass RX
Bass
121
30
Joystick Gtr Y-
Guitar
121
36
Slap Bass 4
Bass
121
30
Power Chords
Guitar
121
37
Slap Bass 3
Bass
121
30
Mute Monster
Guitar
121
37
Thumb Bass
Bass
121
30
Guitar
121
37
Dyna Bass
Bass
121
30
Guitar
121
37
Bass
121
30
Guitar
121
37
Bass
121
30
Guitar
121
37
Bass
121
10
30
Guitar
121
37
Slap Bass 1
Bass
121
31
Guitar Harmonic
Guitar
121
37
Slap Bass 5
Bass
121
31
Guitar Feedback
Guitar
121
38
Synth Bass 1
Bass
121
31
E.Gtr Harmonics
Guitar
121
38
Bass
121
32
Acoustic Bass
Bass
121
38
Bass
121
32
Bass
121
38
Clav Bass
Bass
121
32
Bass
121
38
Hammer
Bass
121
32
Bass
121
38
30303 Bass
Bass
121
32
Bass
121
38
30303 Square
Bass
121
32
DarkWoody A.Bass
Bass
121
38
Bass Square
Bass
121
32
Bass
121
38
Bass
121
32
Acous. Bass RX
Bass
121
38
Digi Bass 1
Bass
121
32
Acoustic Bass 2
Bass
121
10
38
Digi Bass 2
Bass
121
33
Finger Bass 3
Bass
121
11
38
Digi Bass 3
Bass
121
33
Finger Slap 2
Bass
121
12
38
Blind as a Bat
Bass
121
33
Finger E.Bass1
Bass
121
13
38
Jungle Bass
Bass
GM2
Appendix
Factory data
294
Factory data
Sounds
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
Bank
121
14
38
Auto Pilot 1
121
15
38
Hybrid Bass
121
16
38
Dr. Octave
Bass
GM2
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
Bank
GM2
Synth 2
121
50
Synth Strings 1
Bass
121
50
Synth Strings 3
121
50
Analog Strings 2
121
17
38
Drive Bass
Bass
121
50
Analog Velve
121
18
38
Synth Bass 3
Bass
121
50
Odissey
121
39
Synth Bass 2
Bass
121
50
Analog Strings 1
121
39
Attack Bass
Bass
121
50
Synth Strings 4
121
39
Rubber Bass
Bass
121
51
Synth Strings 2
121
39
Attack Pulse
Bass
121
51
Synth Strings 5
121
39
Euro Bass
Bass
121
52
Choir Aahs 1
121
39
Jungle Rez
Bass
121
52
Choir Aahs 2
121
39
Nasty Bass
Bass
121
52
Oooh Voices
121
39
Phat Bass
Bass
121
52
121
39
Poinker Bass
Bass
121
52
Take Voices 1
121
39
Bass
121
52
Take Voices 2
121
10
39
Autofilter Bass
Bass
121
52
Oooh Choir
121
11
39
Monofilter Bass
Bass
121
52
Aaah Choir
121
12
39
Reso Bass
Bass
121
52
Mmmh Choir
121
13
39
Auto Pilot 2
Bass
121
52
Oh-Ah Voices
121
14
39
Bass4 Da Phunk
Bass
121
10
52
Slow Choir
121
15
39
Synth Bass 4
Bass
121
11
52
Grand Choir
121
40
Violin
121
12
52
Choir Light
121
40
Slow Att.Violin
121
13
52
Strings Choir
121
40
Solo Violin
121
53
Voice Ooohs
121
40
Slow Violin
121
53
Humming
121
41
Viola
121
53
Doolally
121
42
Cello
121
53
Airways
121
43
Contrabass
121
54
Synth Voice
121
44
Tremolo Strings
121
54
Analog Voice
121
45
Pizzicato Str.
121
54
Vocalesque
121
45
Pizz. Ensemble
121
54
Vocalscape
121
45
Pizz. Section
121
54
Classic Vox
121
45
Double Strings
121
54
Dream Voice
121
46
Orchestral Harp
121
55
Orchestra Hit
Brass
121
46
Yang Chin
121
55
Brass
121
47
Timpani
121
55
6th Hit
Brass
121
48
Strings Ens. 1
121
55
Euro Hit
Brass
121
48
121
55
Brass Impact
Brass
121
48
60s Strings
121
55
Hit in India
SFX
121
48
Stereo Strings
121
55
Wild Arp
Synth 2
121
48
Legato Strings
121
55
Flip Blip
Synth 2
121
48
i3 Strings
121
55
Netherland Hit
Brass
121
48
N Strings
121
56
Trumpet 1
121
48
Arco Strings
121
56
Dark Trumpet
121
48
Octave Strings
121
56
Trumpet 2
121
48
Strings Quartet
121
56
Mono Trumpet
121
10
48
Symphonic Bows
121
56
Trumpet Expr
121
11
48
121
56
Trumpet Pitch
121
12
48
Camera Strings
121
56
Dual Trumpets
121
13
48
Arabic Strings
121
56
Flugel Horn
121
14
48
Orchestra Tutti1
121
56
Warm Flugel
121
15
48
121
56
BeBop Cornet
121
16
48
121
10
56
Trumpet Pro 1
121
17
48
121
11
56
Trumpet Pro 2
121
18
48
121
12
56
Sweet FlugelHorn
121
19
48
Orchestra Tutti2
121
13
56
121
20
48
Orchestra&Flute
121
14
56
Trumpet 3
121
21
48
Strings Ens. 3
121
57
Trombone 1
121
49
Strings Ens. 2
121
57
Trombone 2
121
49
Sweeper Strings
121
57
Bright Trombone
121
49
Full Strings
121
57
Hard Trombone
121
49
Strings Ens. 4
121
57
Soft Trombone
Factory data
Sounds
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
Bank
121
57
Pitch Trombone
121
57
Trombone Expr. 1
121
57
121
57
121
121
10
GM2
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
121
63
121
63
Trombone Expr. 2
121
Trombone Vel. 1
121
57
Trombone Vel. 2
121
57
Trombone Vel. 3
121
295
Bank
GM2
Analog Brass 2
Brass
Brass Pad
Brass
63
Big Panner
Synth 1
63
Synth Brass 6
Brass
64
Soprano Sax
Sax
64
Sweet Soprano 3
Sax
121
11
57
121
64
Soprano Pro
Sax
121
12
57
Trombone 3
121
64
Sweet Soprano 1
Sax
121
58
Tuba
121
64
Sweet Soprano 2
Sax
121
58
Oberkr. Tuba
121
65
Alto Sax
Sax
121
58
Tuba Gold
121
65
Alto Breath
Sax
121
58
Dynabone
121
65
Sax Ensemble
Sax
121
59
Mute Trumpet 1
121
65
Sax
121
59
Mute Trumpet 2
121
65
Sax
121
59
Wah Trumpet
121
65
Sax
121
59
Mute Ensemble 1
Brass
121
65
Sax
121
59
Mute Ensemble 2
Brass
121
65
Sax
121
60
French Horn 1
Brass
121
65
Sax
121
60
French Horn 2
Brass
121
66
Tenor Sax
Sax
121
60
French Section
Brass
121
66
Sax
121
60
Classic Horns
Brass
121
66
Soft Tenor
Sax
121
60
Brass
121
66
Tenor Breath
Sax
121
61
Brass Section 1
Brass
121
66
Tenor Growl
Sax
121
61
Brass Section 2
Brass
121
66
Folk Sax
Sax
121
61
Tight Brass 3
Brass
121
66
Sax
121
61
Brass
121
66
Sax
121
61
Brass
121
66
Sax
121
61
Brass
121
66
Sax
121
61
Brass
121
10
66
Sax
121
61
Brass
121
11
66
Reed of Power
Sax
121
61
Attack Brass
Brass
121
67
Baritone Sax
Sax
121
61
Trumpet Ens.
Brass
121
67
Baritone Growl
Sax
121
10
61
Trombone Ens.
Brass
121
67
Breathy Baritone
Sax
121
11
61
Trombones
Brass
121
67
Sax
121
12
61
Tight Brass 4
Brass
121
67
Baritone Sax 2
Sax
121
13
61
Fat Brass
Brass
121
68
Oboe
Woodwind
121
14
61
Dyna Brass 1
Brass
121
68
Double Reed
Woodwind
121
15
61
Brass Expr.
Brass
121
69
English Horn 1
Woodwind
121
16
61
Brass Band
Brass
121
69
English Horn 2
Woodwind
121
17
61
Film Brass
Brass
121
70
Bassoon
Woodwind
121
18
61
Brass Slow
Brass
121
71
Clarinet
Woodwind
121
19
61
Fanfare
Brass
121
71
Jazz Clarinet
Woodwind
121
20
61
Movie Brass
Brass
121
71
Clarinet G
Woodwind
121
21
61
Power Brass
Brass
121
71
Section Winds 1
Woodwind
121
22
61
Dyna Brass 2
Brass
121
71
Section Winds 2
Woodwind
121
23
61
Sforzato Brass
Brass
121
71
Clarinet Ens.
Woodwind
121
24
61
Double Brass
Brass
121
71
Woodwinds
Woodwind
121
25
61
Brass Hit
Brass
121
71
Folk Clarinet
Woodwind
121
26
61
Brass Fall
Brass
121
72
Piccolo
Woodwind
121
27
61
Tight Brass 1
Brass
121
72
Small Orchestra
Woodwind
121
28
61
Brass
121
72
Nay
Woodwind
121
29
61
Tight Brass 2
Brass
121
73
Flute 1
Woodwind
121
30
61
Brass of Power
Brass
121
73
Jazz Flute
Woodwind
121
31
61
Brass Section 3
Brass
121
73
Flute Switch
Woodwind
121
62
Synth Brass 1
Brass
121
73
Woodwind
121
62
Synth Brass 3
Brass
121
73
Flute Frullato
Woodwind
121
62
Analog Brass 1
Brass
121
73
Orchestra Flute
Woodwind
121
62
Jump Brass
Brass
121
73
Flute Muted
Brass
121
62
Electrik Brass
Brass
121
73
Wooden Flute
Woodwind
121
62
Synth Brass 5
Brass
121
73
Bambu Flute
Woodwind
121
63
Synth Brass 2
Brass
121
73
Flute 2
Woodwind
121
63
Synth Brass 4
Brass
121
74
Recorder 1
Woodwind
Appendix
296
Factory data
Sounds
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
Bank
GM2
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
Bank
121
74
Recorder 2
Woodwind
121
75
Pan Flute
Woodwind
121
10
87
OB Lead
Synth 2
121
11
87
A Leadload
121
75
Kawala
Woodwind
Synth 2
121
88
Synth 2
121
76
Blown Bottle
Woodwind
121
88
Virtual Traveler
Synth 1
121
77
Shakuhachi 1
Woodwind
121
77
Old Shakuhachi
Woodwind
121
88
Arp Angeles
Synth 2
121
89
Warm Pad
121
77
Shakuhachi 2
Woodwind
Synth 1
121
89
Sine Pad
Synth 1
121
78
Whistle 1
Woodwind
121
89
Master Pad
121
78
Whistle 2
Woodwind
121
79
Ocarina
Woodwind
121
89
Power Synth
Synth 2
121
89
The Pad
121
80
Lead Square 1
Synth 2
Synth 1
121
89
Money Pad
121
80
Lead Square 2
Synth 1
Synth 2
121
89
Dark Pad
121
80
Synth 1
Lead Sine
Synth 2
121
89
Freedom Pad
121
Synth 1
80
Old Portamento
Synth 2
121
89
Analog Pad 1
121
Synth 1
80
Dance Lead
Synth 2
121
89
Analog Pad 2
Synth 1
121
80
Wave Lead
Synth 2
121
10
89
Analog Pad 3
Synth 1
121
80
Sine Wave
Synth 2
121
11
89
Vintage Pad
Synth 1
121
80
Analog Lead
Synth 2
121
12
89
OB Pad
Synth 1
121
80
Synth 2
121
13
89
Dark Anna
Synth 1
121
80
Gliding Square
Synth 2
121
14
89
Symphonic Ens.
Synth 1
121
10
80
Sine Switch
Synth 2
121
90
Polysynth
Synth 2
121
11
80
Square Rez
Synth 2
121
90
Reso Sweep
Synth 2
121
12
80
Port Whine
Synth 2
121
90
Sky Watcher
Synth 1
121
13
80
Synth 2
121
90
Synth Sweeper
Synth 2
121
81
Lead Saw 1
Synth 2
121
90
Super Sweep
Synth 1
121
81
Lead Saw 2
Synth 2
121
90
Wave Sweep
Synth 1
121
81
Synth 2
121
90
Cross Sweep
Synth 1
121
81
Synth 2
121
90
Digital PolySix
Synth 2
121
81
Seq. Analog
Synth 2
121
90
Noisy Stabb
Synth 2
121
81
Power Saw
Synth 2
121
90
Mega Synth
Synth 2
121
81
Octo Lead
Synth 2
121
10
90
Tecno Phonic
Synth 2
121
81
Seq Lead
Synth 2
121
11
90
Farluce
Synth 1
121
81
Synth 2
121
12
90
Synth 1
121
81
Glide Lead
Synth 2
121
13
90
Korgmatose
Synth 1
121
10
81
Fire Wave
Synth 2
121
91
Choir Pad
121
11
81
Rezbo
Synth 2
121
91
Itopia Pad
Synth 1
121
12
81
Synth Pianoid
Synth 2
121
91
Fresh Air
121
82
Calliope
Synth 2
121
91
Heaven
121
83
Chiff
Synth 2
121
91
Synth 2
121
84
Charang
Synth 2
121
91
Future Pad
Synth 1
121
84
Wire Lead
Synth 2
121
91
Tsunami Wave
Synth 1
121
84
Synchro City
Synth 2
121
91
Fresh Breath
121
84
Sync Kron
Synth 2
121
91
Ravelian Pad
Synth 1
121
84
Metallic Rez
Synth 2
121
91
121
84
Brian Sync
Synth 2
121
10
91
Dance ReMix
Synth 1
121
84
Arp Twins
Synth 2
121
92
Bowed Glass
Synth 2
121
84
LoFi Ethnic
Synth 2
121
93
Metallic Pad
Synth 2
121
85
Voice Lead
121
93
Cosmic
Synth 2
121
85
Ether Voices
121
94
Halo Pad
121
85
Cyber Choir
121
95
Sweep Pad
Synth 1
121
86
Fifths Lead
Synth 2
121
95
Astral Dream
Synth 1
121
86
Crimson 5ths
Synth 1
121
95
Meditate
Synth 1
121
87
Synth 2
121
95
Dark Element
Synth 2
121
87
Soft Wrl
Synth 2
121
95
Mellow Pad
Synth 1
121
87
Electro Lead
Synth 2
121
95
Cinema Pad
Synth 1
121
87
Rich Lead
Synth 2
121
95
Reoccuring Astra
Synth 1
121
87
Synth 2
121
95
Vintage Sweep
Synth 1
121
87
Express. Lead
Synth 2
121
95
You Decide
Synth 1
121
87
HipHop Lead
Synth 2
121
96
Ice Rain
SFX
121
87
Square Bass
Synth 2
121
96
Motion Ocean
Synth 1
121
87
Synth 2
121
96
Caribbean
Synth 2
121
87
Cat Lead
Synth 2
121
97
Soundtrack
Synth 1
GM2
Sounds
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
Bank
121
97
Air Clouds
121
97
Reso Down
121
97
121
121
121
GM2
297
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
Bank
Synth 1
121
113
Agogo
Synth 1
121
114
Steel Drums
Tinklin Pad
Synth 1
121
114
Warm Steel
97
Pods In Pad
Synth 1
121
115
Woodblock
97
Noble Pad
Synth 1
121
115
Castanets
97
Rave
Synth 1
121
116
Taiko Drum
121
97
Elastick Pad
Synth 1
121
116
Concert BassDrum
121
98
Crystal
Synth 2
121
117
Melodic Tom 1
121
98
Synth Mallet
SFX
121
117
Melodic Tom 2
121
98
Vs Bell Boy
121
117
Reverse Tom
121
98
Krystal Bell
121
118
Synth Drum
121
98
Digi Bell
121
118
121
98
Moving Bell
Synth 1
121
118
Electric Drum
121
98
Bell Pad
Synth 1
121
118
Reverse Snare
121
98
Bell Choir
Synth 1
121
119
Reverse Cymbal
121
99
Atmosphere
Synth 2
121
119
Dragon Gong
121
100
Brightness
Synth 2
121
119
Reverse Cymbal 2
121
100
Lonely Spin
Synth 1
121
120
Guitar FretNoise
SFX
121
100
Synth Ghostly
Synth 1
121
120
SFX
121
101
Goblins
SFX
121
120
SFX
121
101
Motion Raver
Synth 2
121
120
Guitar
121
101
Synth 1
121
121
Breath Noise
SFX
121
101
VCF Modulation
Synth 2
121
121
Flute Click
Woodwind
121
102
Echo Drops
SFX
121
122
Seashore
SFX
121
102
Echo Bell
SFX
121
122
Rain
SFX
121
102
Echo Pan
SFX
121
122
Thunder
SFX
121
102
Band Passed
Synth 2
121
122
Wind
SFX
121
102
Pan Reso
Synth 2
121
122
Stream
SFX
121
102
Moon Cycles
Synth 1
121
122
Bubble
SFX
121
103
Star Theme
SFX
121
123
Bird Tweet 1
SFX
121
104
Sitar 1
Guitar
121
123
Dog
SFX
121
104
Sitar 2
Guitar
121
123
Horse Gallop
SFX
121
104
Sitar Tambou
Guitar
121
123
Bird Tweet 2
SFX
121
104
Indian Stars
Guitar
121
124
Telephone 1
SFX
121
104
Indian Frets
Guitar
121
124
Telephone 2
SFX
121
104
Bouzouki
Guitar
121
124
Door Creak
SFX
121
104
Tambra
Guitar
121
124
Door
SFX
121
104
Sitar Sitar
Guitar
121
124
Scratch
SFX
121
105
Banjo
Guitar
121
124
Wind Chime
SFX
121
105
Guitar
121
125
Helicopter
SFX
121
105
Oud
Guitar
121
125
Car Engine
SFX
121
105
Jaw Harp
SFX
121
125
Car Stop
SFX
121
106
Shamisen
Guitar
121
125
Car Pass
SFX
121
107
Koto
Guitar
121
125
Car Crash
SFX
121
107
Taisho Koto
Guitar
121
125
Siren
SFX
121
107
Kanun
Guitar
121
125
Train
SFX
121
107
Kanun Trem.
Guitar
121
125
Jet Plane
SFX
121
107
Kanun Mix
Guitar
121
125
Starship
SFX
121
108
Kalimba
121
125
Burst Noise
SFX
121
108
Kalimba Vel.
121
126
Applause
SFX
121
109
Bag Pipes
Woodwind
121
126
Laughing
SFX
121
109
War Pipes
Woodwind
121
126
Screaming
SFX
121
109
Uillean BagPipes
Woodwind
121
126
Punch
SFX
121
109
HighlandBagPipes
Woodwind
121
126
Heart Beat
SFX
121
110
Fiddle
121
126
Footsteps
SFX
121
111
Shanai
Woodwind
121
126
Stadium
SFX
121
111
Zurna
Woodwind
121
127
Gun Shot
SFX
121
111
Hichiriki
Woodwind
121
127
Machine Gun
SFX
121
112
Tinkle Bell
121
127
Laser Gun
SFX
121
112
Gamelan
121
127
Explosion
SFX
121
112
Bali Gamelan
121
127
16
Digital Drawbars
Digi Organ
121
112
Garbage Mall
121
64
0-127
User 1
GM2
Appendix
Factory data
298
Factory data
Sounds
CC00
CC32
PC
Name
Bank
121
65
0-127
User 2
121
68
0-127
EXB1 Bank 1
121
69
0-127
EXB1 Bank 2
121
70
0-127
EXB2 Bank 1
121
71
0-127
EXB2 Bank 2
GM2
Factory data
Drum Kits
299
Drum Kits
The following table lists all Pa1X Factory Drum Kits in order of
Bank Select-Program Change number.
PC
Name
PC
Name
42
Brush Kit RX
120
120
120
120
120
50
120
51
Arabian Kit 1
120
GM2
120
120
Legend: The table also includes MIDI data used to remotely select
the Drum Kits. CC00: Control Change 0, or Bank Select MSB.
CC32: Control Change 32, or Bank Select LSB. PC: Program
Change.
GM2
Orchestra Kit
49 (remap to 48)
SFX Kit
120
120
120
64
Percussion Kit
120
120
65
120
Acoustic Kit
120
66
Trinity Perc.Kit
120
120
67
120
Standard Kit 1
120
120
Standard Kit 2
120
72
120
Standard Kit 3
120
73
Techno Kit RX
120
Room Kit 1
120
74
Dance Kit RX
120
HipHop Kit 1
120
120
10
Jungle Kit
120
88
Standard Kit 4
120
11
Techno Kit 1
120
89
120
12
Room Kit 2
120
90
120
13
HipHop Kit 2
120
120
14
Techno Kit 2
120
96
Elektro Kit 1
120
15
Techno Kit 3
120
97
Elektro Kit 2
120
16
Power Kit 1
120
98-115 (remap to 5)
120
17
Power Kit 2
120
120
18
120
120
19
120
120
120
119
Standard Kit 5
120
24
Electro Kit
120
120
Room Kit 3
120
25
Analog Kit
120
121
Power Kit 3
120
26
House Kit 1
120
122
Elektro Kit 2
120
27
House Kit 2
120
123
Analog Kit 2
120
28
House Kit 3
120
124
Jazz Kit 2
120
29
House Kit 4
120
125
Brush Kit 3
120
30
120
126
Orchestra Kit 2
120
31
120
120
32
127
SFX Kit 2
120
33
Jazz Kit
120
64
0-63
120
34
120
68
0-63
120
35
120
70
0-63
120
120
40
Brush Kit 1
120
41
Brush Kit 2 VS
75-87 (remap to 5)
91-95 (remap to 5)
117
Arabian Kit 2
118 (remap to 5)
Appendix
CC00 CC32
CC00 CC32
300
Factory data
Drum Kit maps
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
Note
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
25
228
226
227
91
99
11
38
90
171
5
130
83
100
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
17
15
131
89
230
89
145
170
145
172
144
173
144
143
196
143
213
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
301
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
Excl.
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
25
228
226
227
89
99
11
38
93
171
10
130
125
83
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
5
15
131
90
230
91
145
176
145
178
144
173
144
143
196
143
213
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Appendix
Factory data
302
Factory data
Drum Kit maps
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174
11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
Note
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
F6
F#6
G6
G#6
A6
A#6
B6
C7
C#7
D7
D#7
E7
F7
F#7
G7
G#7
A7
A#7
B7
C8
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174
11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
295
286
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174
11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
489
489
489
489
489
489
489
489
489
489
489
353
332
334
333
285
286
288
291
292
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
32
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174
11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
272
132
269
376
340
15
38
130
100
230
88
145
170
145
178
144
180
144
143
196
143
213
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
Excl.
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Note
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
272
132
269
376
340
39
32
229
116
230
123
141
181
141
184
141
182
141
141
196
141
213
202
214
339
201
239
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
185
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174
Excl.
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
272
132
269
376
340
30
40
221
122
230
117
141
232
141
188
141
182
141
141
235
141
213
202
214
339
201
239
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
185
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174
Excl.
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
303
272
132
269
376
340
18
25
369
228
230
228
266
183
266
189
266
185
266
266
196
266
213
202
214
339
198
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
114
36
16
91
174
Appendix
Factory data
304
Factory data
Drum Kit maps
Note
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
11
130
97
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
17
38
130
99
230
98
142
177
142
178
141
175
141
141
196
141
213
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
36
35
221
107
464
111
141
181
141
188
141
182
141
141
196
141
213
202
214
339
201
239
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
185
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
34
25
229
108
230
270
236
183
236
189
236
185
236
236
196
236
213
202
214
339
201
239
196
325
213
237
237
237
237
237
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
342
360
360
347
355
358
305
330
469
370
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
11
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
34
25
267
126
230
227
386
233
402
184
425
234
266
266
196
266
213
202
214
339
407
239
196
339
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
366
364
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
Note
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
5
35
228
226
227
121
120
38
30
89
177
18
131
118
125
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
34
16
130
99
225
116
148
177
148
178
148
180
148
148
196
148
213
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
305
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Appendix
Factory data
306
Factory data
Drum Kit maps
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
30
228
226
227
89
120
34
36
115
231
25
270
99
121
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
20
265
268
266
230
114
266
174
266
178
266
173
266
266
196
266
213
202
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
400
115
8
98
90
127
34
35
125
170
30
269
115
117
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
40
40
229
227
230
227
236
231
236
232
236
232
236
236
235
236
213
198
214
411
201
239
196
325
213
237
237
237
236
236
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
238
327
327
342
342
357
357
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
34
123
40
227
101
91
36
14
121
270
33
269
122
429
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
32
36
268
117
230
228
386
233
148
180
226
234
266
266
196
266
213
202
214
339
198
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
188
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
366
364
341
340
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
5
5
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
34
228
40
227
101
91
36
14
121
270
33
269
122
429
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
32
18
446
121
230
107
145
183
145
189
144
181
144
143
196
143
213
202
214
339
198
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
336
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
34
228
40
227
101
91
36
14
121
270
33
269
122
429
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
39
35
268
98
230
115
266
231
266
231
266
232
266
266
196
266
213
202
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
188
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Note
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
34
228
40
227
101
91
36
14
121
270
33
269
122
429
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
32
16
131
82
230
108
266
231
266
232
266
232
266
266
235
266
205
202
214
338
201
239
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
336
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
185
355
358
305
330
329
370
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
39
111
264
227
105
104
24
29
106
176
20
131
111
92
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
23
22
268
103
230
87
145
233
141
181
141
186
141
141
196
141
210
202
214
336
201
352
196
386
263
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
307
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
40
112
264
228
122
104
24
29
106
180
20
131
116
90
267
220
219
221
270
108
272
272
132
269
376
340
39
24
229
102
223
105
145
183
141
187
141
168
141
141
196
141
210
202
214
339
201
352
196
386
263
296
295
290
297
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Appendix
Factory data
308
Factory data
Drum Kit maps
Note
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
342
360
360
185
355
358
305
330
329
370
Excl.
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
342
360
360
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
Excl.
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
25
228
40
227
90
91
38
11
88
171
5
131
83
93
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
10
9
131
82
230
90
150
176
150
178
149
175
149
149
196
149
213
198
215
339
197
352
196
325
212
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
261
262
341
340
211
355
358
255
330
329
370
Excl.
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
261
262
341
340
349
355
358
255
330
329
370
Excl.
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Factory data
Drum Kit maps
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
298
295
292
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
298
295
292
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
298
295
292
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
Appendix
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
Note
309
310
Factory data
Drum Kit maps
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
196
151
212
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
Note
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
193
151
210
198
214
339
197
352
191
325
211
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
5
5
5
425
362
280
275
281
272
415
416
421
423
419
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
BD Dry 1
Amp Noise
Chinese Gong
DJ BD Rub
DJ Scratch5
DJ SD Rub
DJ Scratch2
Gtr Cut Noise1
Gtr Cut Noise2
E.Gtr Pick1
Gtr Scratch1
Dist. Slide1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Note
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
F6
F#6
G6
G#6
A6
A#6
B6
C7
C#7
D7
D#7
E7
F7
F#7
G7
G#7
A7
A#7
B7
C8
C#8
D8
D#8
E8
F8
F#8
G8
G#8
A8
A#8
B8
C9
311
Appendix
Factory data
312
Factory data
Drum Kit maps
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
367
365
364
368
341
340
360
357
239
306
305
221
221
183
363
324
324
324
216
216
351
351
285
286
291
292
240
288
341
340
286
289
292
338
288
297
297
300
329
301
329
338
335
332
335
332
334
333
445
445
445
446
354
327
328
352
309
354
346
344
352
347
347
347
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
1
Off
Off
Off
2
2
2
Off
Off
Off
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
3
Off
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
18
115
226
227
112
246
36
245
246
174
244
130
248
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
242
241
250
247
230
249
141
251
141
184
141
252
141
141
196
141
210
202
214
339
201
259
196
325
211
253
254
290
288
285
334
329
258
259
346
256
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
261
262
341
340
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
461
460
459
459
460
463
302
310
310
342
307
308
308
343
326
361
361
450
450
451
430
358
358
355
467
267
267
25
228
40
227
90
99
5
38
91
170
11
131
5
5
5
5
Excl.
Off
5
5
6
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
3
3
3
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
5
Off
Off
Off
2
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
39
228
265
227
105
104
24
27
106
181
20
131
111
227
268
220
219
270
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Note
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117
118
119
120
121
122
123
124
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
F6
F#6
G6
G#6
A6
A#6
B6
C7
C#7
D7
D#7
E7
F7
F#7
G7
G#7
A7
A#7
B7
C8
C#8
D8
D#8
E8
F8
F#8
G8
G#8
A8
A#8
B8
C9
C#9
D9
D#9
E9
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
32
115
226
227
112
114
36
22
91
174
23
130
98
115
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
4
4
Off
4
5
4
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
270
219
220
217
217
463
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
282
419
341
340
360
431
350
306
306
221
221
363
363
Excl.
Off
5
5
6
6
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
3
3
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
25
228
226
227
89
99
38
17
90
171
7
130
83
82
132
220
219
221
270
410
272
272
132
269
376
340
BD House 4
99 SD
88 BD
88 SD
SD Off Center
SD Processed
BD Amb.Rocker
BD Tight
SD Jazz Ring
HH3 Closed2
BD Dry 3
Side Stick Dry
SD Dry 2
SD Dry 1
Drum Stick Hit
SD Orchestra
SD Orch. Roll
Finger Snaps
Zap2
Noise White
DJ Scratch2
DJ Scratch2
Drum Stick Hit
Zap1
Click
Triangle Open
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
313
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
211
355
358
255
330
329
370
Appendix
Factory data
314
Factory data
Drum Kit maps
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Note
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
Note
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
C-1
C#-1
D-1
D#-1
E-1
F-1
F#-1
G-1
G#-1
A-1
A#-1
B-1
C0
C#0
D0
D#0
E0
F0
F#0
G0
G#0
A0
A#0
B0
26
28
229
103
230
228
148
233
148
232
148
186
148
148
196
148
205
202
214
338
201
352
196
386
263
237
237
237
236
236
410
400
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
261
262
341
340
345
338
358
255
266
264
370
22
23
369
228
230
228
266
183
266
189
266
185
266
266
196
266
213
202
214
339
198
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
489
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
30
228
226
227
89
120
34
36
115
231
25
270
99
121
132
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
7
17
131
91
230
88
145
174
145
178
144
173
144
143
196
143
213
198
214
339
201
352
196
325
213
298
295
290
288
285
334
329
351
351
346
309
361
361
308
307
326
327
327
342
343
341
340
347
355
358
305
330
329
370
489
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
30
228
226
227
89
120
34
36
115
231
25
270
99
121
132
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
45
60
79
75
69
63
57
53
5
25
228
226
227
88
99
5
17
82
171
7
131
132
412
352
Note
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81
82
83
84
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
C1
C#1
D1
D#1
E1
F1
F#1
G1
G#1
A1
A#1
B1
C2
C#2
D2
D#2
E2
F2
F#2
G2
G#2
A2
A#2
B2
C3
C#3
D3
D#3
E3
F3
F#3
G3
G#3
A3
A#3
B3
C4
C#4
D4
D#4
E4
F4
F#4
G4
G#4
A4
A#4
B4
C5
C#5
D5
D#5
E5
F5
F#5
G5
G#5
A5
A#5
B5
C6
C#6
D6
D#6
E6
F6
F#6
G6
G#6
A6
A#6
B6
C7
Excl.
7
7
Off
Off
Off
7
7
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
3
3
Off
Off
Off
4
4
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Off
6
6
Off
352
219
221
270
171
272
272
132
292
376
376
7
17
130
84
225
84
145
174
145
178
144
173
144
143
196
143
213
433
432
338
434
352
434
346
436
439
295
438
298
437
455
475
458
456
457
316
318
445
448
447
449
449
446
487
445
486
448
449
446
431
450
451
478
302
302
433
431
450
451
478
10
488
315
Excl.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
1
Off
1
Off
1
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
4
4
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
2
2
2
Off
3
3
3
5
5
5
Off
Off
Off
Appendix
Factory data
316
Factory data
Multisamples
Multisamples
The following table lists all Pa1X Factory Multisamples available in ROM.
0
AcousticPiano_L
41
Pipe Flute_L
82
Bariton Sax mf
AcousticPiano_R
42
Pipe Flute_R
83
Bariton Sax f
M1 Piano
43
Pipe Positive
84
Bariton Sax T1
125 Tuba
El.GrandPiano
44
Pipe Mixture
85
Tenor SaxVibrato
E.P. FM 1
45
86
Tenor Sax
127 Trombone1 mf
E.P. FM 1LP
46
87
Tenor Sax M1
128 Trombone1 ff
E.P. FM 2
47
Pipe Full 2
88
48
Kalimba
89
49
MusicBox
90
Alto Sax p
E.P. StageHard
50
MusicBoxLP
91
Alto Sax mf
10
E.P. StageHardLP
51
Marimba
92
11
52
MarimbaLP
93
12
53
Xylophone
94
Soprano SaxVibr.
13
54
Vibraphone
95
Soprano Sax
14
E.P. Pad 2
55
VibraphoneLP
96
French Musette
15
Clav.
56
Celesta
97
Musette 1
16
Harpsichord
57
CelestaLP
98
Musette 1LP
17
GospelOrg.Slow_L
58
Glockenspiel
99
Musette 2
18
GospelOrg.Slow_R
59
GlockenspielLP
19
GospelOrg.Fast_L
60
Tubular Bell
20
GospelOrg.Fast_R
61
Log Drum
21
E.Organ Perc 1
62
SteelDr Hard
22
E.Organ Perc 2
63
SteelDr HardLP
23
E.Organ Perc 3
64
Gamelan
24
E.Organ 2'Perc
65
FM Bell
106 Accordion 1
25
M1 Organ 1
66
Flute
107 Accordion 2
26
M1 Organ 2
67
Flute Frull
27
Organ 1
68
Voice Flute
28
Organ 2
69
Jazz Flute
110 Bandoneon
29
Organ 2LP
70
Piccolo
30
E.Organ Jazz
71
Pan Flute
31
Bx3&Perc 3rd
72
Shakuhachi
154 Violin
32
E.Organ Vox
73
Shakuhachi Atk
155 Viola
33
E.Organ Soft
74
Bottle
115 Harmonica
156 Cello&Contrabass
34
E.Organ Full
75
Recorder
35
E.Organ Dist
76
Ocarina
158 Pizzicato
36
Rotary Org1
77
Clarinet
37
Rotary Org1LP
78
M1 DoubleReed
38
Rotary Org2
79
Oboe
39
SuperBX3
80
English Horn
40
SuperBX3LP
81
Bassoon
Multisamples
317
299 An.Strings 1
255 SlapBassThumb
256 SlapBassThumbLP
301 An.Strings 2
261 Sitar
262 Santur
263 SanturLP
264 Tambura
265 TamburaLP
310 Lore
266 Bouzouki
311 Lore NT
267 BouzoukiLP
268 Ukulele
269 Oud
270 ClarinetLP
226 A.Bass1
271 Kanun
227 A.Bass2 mf
228 A.Bass2 f
273 Nay
274 Mandolin
275 MandolinLP
276 Banjo
277 BanjoLP
278 Shamisen
279 Koto
235 E.Bass3 p
280 Harp
236 E.Bass3 mf
327 Noise 1
328 Noise 2
331 Saw 1
332 Saw 2
333 Saw 3
295 DetunedSuper
340 Square
296 DetunedSuperREV
341 Square MG
342 Square JP
343 Triangle MG
Appendix
Factory data
318
Factory data
Multisamples
344 Ramp
370 Zap 2
422 88 Tom
345 Ramp MG
371 Stadium
423 88 Conga
346 Sine
372 Applause
424 88 Crash
373 Birds 1
425 Tom
375 Birds 2
376 Crickets
402 Train
429 Flexatone
404 Helicopter
430 Tambourine
380 Thunder
381 Stream
382 Bubble
434 Cowbell
435 Click
384 Dog
410 Explosion
385 Gallop
411 Wind
437 Orchestra BD
412 Timpani
438 Castanet
387 Laughing
413 Crash
439 Taiko
390 Scream
391 Punch
444 RainStick
393 Footstep 1
445 Empty
394 Footstep 2
369 Zap 1
421 88 Cowbell
Factory data
Drum Samples
319
Drum Samples
0
BD Acoustic 1 p
41
BD Klanger
82
SD Dry 1
123 SD Vintage6
BD Acoustic 1 mf
42
SD Wood 1 p
83
SD Dry 2
124 SD AmbiHop
BD Acoustic 1 f
43
SD Wood 1 mf
84
SD Dry 3
125 SD Brasser
BD Acoustic 2 mf
44
SD Wood 1 f
85
SD Ghost Roll
126 SD Chili
BD Acoustic 2 f
45
SD Wood 2 pp
86
SD Ghost p
127 SD Whopper
BD Dry 1
46
SD Wood 2 p
87
SD Ghost f
BD Dry 2
47
SD Wood 2 mf
88
SD Full Room
BD Dry 3
48
SD Wood 2 f
89
SD Off Center
BD Normal
49
SD Piccolo 1 pp
90
SD Jazz Ring
BD SoftRoom
50
SD Piccolo 1 p
91
SD Amb.Piccolo
10
BD Jazz
51
SD Piccolo 1 mf
92
SD Paper
133 Tom 1 Hi p
11
BD Pillow
52
SD Piccolo 1 f
93
SD Brush Hit
134 Tom 1 Hi f
12
BD Woofer
53
SD Piccolo 2 pp
94
SD Brush Tap 1
13
BD MondoKill
54
SD Piccolo 2 p
95
SD Brush Tap 2
14
BD Terminator
55
SD Piccolo 2 mf
96
SD Brush Swirl
15
BD Tubby
56
SD Piccolo 2 f
97
SD Big Rock
16
BD Gated
57
SD Solid 1 p
98
SD Yowie
17
BD Tight
58
SD Solid 1 mf
99
SD Processed
18
BD Squash
59
SD Solid 1 f
141 Tom 2 Hi
19
BD Dance 1
60
SD Solid 2 p
101 SD Dance
20
BD Dance 2
61
SD Solid 2 mf
102 SD House 1
143 Tom 3 Hi
21
BD Dance 3
62
SD Solid 2 f
103 SD House 2
144 Tom 3 Lo
22
BD House 1
63
SD Maple 1 pp
104 SD House 3
23
BD House 2
64
SD Maple 1 p
105 SD House 4
146 Tom 4 Hi
24
BD House 3
65
SD Maple 1 mp
106 SD Small
147 Tom 4 Lo
25
BD House 4
66
SD Maple 1 mf
107 SD Rap
26
BD House 5
67
SD Maple 1 f
108 SD Noise
27
BD Liquid
68
SD Maple 1 ff
109 SD Reverse
28
BD Techno 1
69
SD Maple 2 pp
110 SD Hip 1
29
BD Techno 2
70
SD Maple 2 p
111 SD Hip 2
30
BD Hip 1
71
SD Maple 2 mp
112 SD Hip 3
31
BD Hip 2
72
SD Maple 2 mf
113 SD Hip 4
32
BD Hip 3
73
SD Maple 2 f
114 SD Hip 5
33
BD Hip 4
74
SD Maple 2 ff
115 SD Hip 6
34
BD Pop Kick
75
SD Brass 1 p
116 SD Ringy
35
BD Dance 99
76
SD Brass 1 mf
117 SD Tiny
36
BD Ambient
77
SD Brass 1 f
118 SD Vintage1
37
BD Amb.Crackle
78
SD Brass 2 p
119 SD Vintage2
38
BD Amb.Rocker
79
SD Brass 2 mf
120 SD Vintage3
39
BD Pop 99
80
SD Brass 2 f
121 SD Vintage4
40
BD Deep 88
81
SD Roll
122 SD Vintage5
Appendix
The following table lists all Pa1X Factory Drum Samples available in ROM.
320
Factory data
Drum Samples
258 Syn. FX 1
259 Syn. FX 2
260 Syn. FX 3
216 BD Orchestra
261 Syn. FX 4
262 Syn. FX 5
218 Timpani
264 Boom
220 SD Orchestra
265 E.Tom FM
222 Claps 1
223 Claps 2
224 Claps 3
269 Zap 1
225 Claps 4
270 Zap 2
226 88 BD
271 DJ Scratch 1
316 Tabla Na
227 88 SD
272 DJ Scratch 2
228 99 SD
273 DJ Scratch 3
229 88 Rimshot
274 DJ Scratch 4
230 88 Claps
275 DJ Scratch 5
231 88 HH Close
276 DJ Scratch 6
232 88 HH Open
188 HH Hip
233 99 HH Close
234 99 HH Open
324 Tsuzumi
235 88 Crash
280 DJ BD Rub
325 Vibraslap
236 88 Tom
281 DJ SD Rub
326 Claves
237 88 Conga
327 Woodblock 1
238 88 Claves
328 Woodblock 2
239 88 Cowbell
240 88 Maracas
196 Crash 1
241 Syn. BD 1
197 Crash 2
242 Syn. BD 2
198 China
243 Syn. BD 3
244 Syn. BD 4
201 Splash
246 Syn. SD 1
247 Syn. SD 2
248 Syn. SD 3
249 Syn. SD 4
342 Cuica Hi
343 Cuica Lo
Drum Samples
321
344 Shaker 1
382 Cat
345 Shaker 2
383 Growl
346 Cabasa Up
385 Punch
386 Tribe
462 Timbales
387 Rainstick
464 Alkis
465 Bandir
352 Cowbell
394 Train
395 Helicopter
472 Darbuka 2
473 Darbuka 3
360 Flexatone
474 Darbuka 4
475 Darbuka D 1
400 Explosion
476 Darbuka D 2
401 Thunder
477 Darbuka D 3
364 Yeah!
402 Wind
478 Davul
403 Stream
479 Hollo 1
366 Uhh
404 Bubble
480 Hollo 2
367 Hit It
481 Kup 1
482 Kup 2
370 Stadium
371 Applause
447 Rik 1
372 Scream
448 Rik 2
486 Tef 1
373 Laughing
449 Rik 3
487 Tef 2
374 Footsteps 1
412 Tubular
488 Tef 3
375 Footsteps 2
413 Gamelan
489 Empty
376 Click
414 Tambura
490 SD Rock
377 Bird 1
491 SD Normal
378 Bird 2
379 Dog
380 Gallop
381 Crickets
Appendix
Factory data
322
Factory data
Performances
Performances
All Performances are user-editable. Use the following table as a model for your own Perfomance lists.
Note: You can remotely select Performances on the Pa1X, by sending it Bank Select MSB (CC#0), Bank Select LSB (CC#32) and Program
Change messages on the Control channel (see MIDI: MIDI In Channels on page 238).
#
1
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
Bank: 1
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
Bank: 2
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
Bank: 3
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
10
11
10
10
10
10
12
11
11
11
11
13
12
12
12
12
14
13
13
13
13
15
14
14
14
14
16
15
15
15
15
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
0
Bank: 5
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
0
Bank: 6
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
0
Bank: 7
CC#0 CC#32
1
Bank: 4
PC
0
10
11
10
10
10
10
12
11
11
11
11
13
12
12
12
12
14
13
13
13
13
15
14
14
14
14
16
15
15
15
15
Bank: 8
Factory data
Performances
PC
Bank: 9
CC#0 CC#32
1
PC
Bank: 10
CC#0 CC#32
1
10
PC
Bank: 11
CC#0 CC#32
1
11
PC
10
11
10
10
10
10
12
11
11
11
11
13
12
12
12
12
14
13
13
13
13
15
14
14
14
14
16
15
15
15
15
CC#0 CC#32
1
12
PC
Bank: 13
CC#0 CC#32
1
13
PC
Bank: 14
CC#0 CC#32
1
14
PC
Bank: 15
CC#0 CC#32
1
15
PC
10
11
10
10
10
10
12
11
11
11
11
13
12
12
12
12
14
13
13
13
13
15
14
14
14
14
16
15
15
15
15
CC#0 CC#32
1
16
PC
0
Bank: 17
CC#0 CC#32
1
17
PC
0
Bank: 18
CC#0 CC#32
1
18
PC
0
Bank: 19
CC#0 CC#32
1
19
Bank: 16
Bank: 12
PC
Bank: 20
10
11
10
10
10
10
12
11
11
11
11
13
12
12
12
12
14
13
13
13
13
15
14
14
14
14
16
15
15
15
15
Appendix
CC#0 CC#32
1
323
324
Factory data
Pads
Pads
You can assign the following Hits or Sequences to the four Pads. Older sounds might be still assigned to the Pads when loading musical
resources generated with an older operating system (see the following section).
#
HIT - Drum
HIT - Percussion
HIT - World 1
Hit - World 2
HIT - Orchestral
HIT - Synth&Pad
88 Cowbell
Agogo 1
Baja 1
Kup 1
Brass Fall
Cosmic
88 Crash
Agogo 2
Baja 2
Kup 2
Orch.Cymbal 1
VCF Modulation
China
Castanet 1
China Gong
Kup 3
Orch.Cymbal 2
Planet Lead
Crash 1
Castanet 2
Darbuka 1
Kup 4
Orch. Hit
Brightness
Crash 2
Conga Hi
Darbuka 2
Ramazan 1
Orch. Snare
Crystal
Rev. Cymbal
Conga Low
Darbuka 3
Ramazan 2
Ride 1
Conga Mute
Darbuka 4
Ramazan 3
Timpani 1
Fifths Lead
Ride 2
Conga Slap
Darbuka 5
Rek Dom Ak
Timpani 2
Calliope
Ride Bell
Cowbell
Darbuka 6
Rik 1
Timpani 3
Caribbean
10 Splash
10 Cuica 1
10 Darbuka 7
10 Rik 2
10 Timpani 4
10 Rezbo
11 Sticks
11 Cuica 2
11 Darbuka 8
11 Rik 3
11 Orchestra Tutti
11 Digital Polisix
12 Rim-Shot
12 Jingle Bell
12 Davul
12 Sagat 1
12
12 Motion Raver
13 Hi Tom Flam
13 Long Guiro
13 Douf Rim Ak
13 Sagat 2
13
13 Moving Bell
14 Short Guiro
14 Dragon Gong
14 Tef 1
14
14 Elastick Pad
15 Open Bells
15 Hollo 1
15 Tef 2
15
15 Rave
16 Rain Stick
16 Hollo 2
16 Tef 3
16
16 Dance Remix
17 Drum Single A
17 Tamb. Acc. 1
17
17 Tef 4
17
17 Vintage Sweep
18 Drum Single B
18 Tamb. Acc. 2
18
18 Tef 5
18
18 You Decide
19 Drum Single C
19 Tamb. Open
19
19 Tef 6
19
19
20 Drum Single D
20 Tamb. Push
20
20
20
20
21 Drum Sing.HouseA
21 Timbale Hi
21
21
21
21
22 Drum Sing.HouseB
22 Timbale Low
22
22
22
22
23 Drum Sing.HouseC
23 Timbale Rim 1
23
23
23
23
24 Drum Sing.HouseD
24 Timbale Rim 2
24
24
24
24
25 Drum Kit A
25 Triangle 1
25
25
25
25
26 Drum Kit B
26 Triangle 2
26
26
26
26
27 Drum Kit C
27 Vibra Slap
27
27
27
27
28 Drum Kit D
28 Whistle 1
28
28
28
28
29 Drum Kit E
29 Whistle 2
29
29
29
29
30 Drum Kit F
30 Windchimes 1
30
30
30
30
31
31 Windchimes 2
31
31
31
31
32
32 Windchimes 3
32
32
32
32
HIT - Voice
HIT - Blocks
HIT - Misc&SFX 1
HIT - Misc&SFX 2
SEQ - Drum
SEQ - Percussion
Aah !
Blk Funk 1 A
Applause
Bubble
Drum DrumBasSolo
Perc FingerSnap
Hit it !
Blk Funk 1 B
Bird 1
Car Crash
Perc Triang.+HH
Laughing
Blk Funk 1 C
Bird 2
Car Engine
Drum 8 Bt Easy
Perc Latin 1
Scream
Blk Funk 1 D
Cat
Car Pass
Drum 8 Bt Medium
Perc Latin 2
Uuh !
Blk Funk 2 A
Church Bell
Car Stop
Drum Rock 1
Perc Latin 3
Yeah ! 1
Blk Funk 2 B
Crickets
Explosion
Drum Rock 2
Perc Mix
Yeah ! 2
Perc Soft
Blk Funk 2 C
Dist. Slide 1
Gun Shot
Drum Brush 1
Blk Funk 2 D
Dist. Slide 2
Helicopter
Drum Brush 2
Perc Conga
Blk Organ A
Dog
Jet Plane
Drum Disco 1
Perc Conga+Ride
10
10 Blk Organ B
10 Door Creak
10 Laser Gun
10 Drum Disco 2
10 Perc Conga+Mix
11
11 Blk Organ C
11 Door Slam
11 Machine Gun
11 Drum Disco 3
11 Perc Conga+Bongo
12
12 Blk Organ D
12 Foosteps 1
12 Phone Ring
12 Drum Disco 4
12 Perc Conga+Tamb.
13
13 Blk Choir A
13 Foosteps 2
13 Punch
13 Drum Funk 1
13 Perc Shaker
14 Perc Shak+Tamb 1
14
14 Blk Choir B
14 Heart Beat
14 River
14 Drum Funk 2
15
15 Blk Choir C
15 Horse Gallop
15 Seashore
15 Perc Shak+Tamb 2
16
16 Blk Choir D
16 Lion
16 Siren
16 Drum Latin
16 Perc Shak+Cong 1
17
17
17 Scratch 1
17 Starship
17 Drum Progressiv1
17 Perc Shak+Cong 2
18
18
18 Scratch 2
18 Thunder
18 Drum Progressiv2
18 Perc Tambourine1
19
19
19 Scratch 3
19 Train
19 Drum Fill 1
19 Perc Tambourine2
Factory data
Pads
325
20
20 Scratch 4
20 Wind
20 Drum Fill 2
21
21
21 Scratch 5
21
21 Drum Break
20 Perc Tamb+Conga1
21 Perc Tamb+Conga2
22
22
22 Scratch 6
22
22 Drum End
22 Perc Guiro+Bongo
23
23
23 Stadium
23
23
23 Perc Cowbel+Tamb
24
24
24
24
24
24 Perc
25
25
25
25
25
25 Perc 6/8
26
26
26
26
26
26
27
27
27
27
27
27
28
28
28
28
28
28
29
29
29
29
29
29
30
30
30
30
30
30
31
31
31
31
31
31
32
32
32
32
32
32
SEQ - Groove
SEQ - Bass
SEQ - Piano
SEQ - Guitar
SEQ - Orchestral
SEQ - Solo
Grv Drum 1
Piano Accomp 1
Timpani Roll 1
Solo Marimba
Grv Drum 2
Piano Accomp 2
Timpani Roll 2
Solo Kalimba 1
Grv Brush
Piano Accomp 3
Orch. Tutti 1
Solo Kalimba 2
Grv Jazzy
Piano Accomp 4
Orch. Tutti 2
Grv Latin
Piano Accomp 5
Orch. Tutti 3
Solo Vibes
Grv HipHop 1
Piano Accomp 6
Orch. Tutti 4
Grv HipHop 2
Bass Latin
Piano Accomp 7
GtSteelStrum
Orch. Harp 1
Grv HipHop 3
Bass Slap
Piano Accomp 8
Orch. Harp 2
Solo Banjo
Grv HipHop 4
Bass Digital
Piano Accomp 9
Orch. Harp 3
Solo Violin
10 Grv HipHop 5
10 Bass Synth
10 Piano Arpeg. 1
10 Orch. Harp 4
10 Solo Harpsi
11 Grv HipHop 6
11 Bass DigiFilter1
11 Piano Arpeg. 2
12 Grv Funk 1
12 Bass DigiFilter2
12 Piano Arp 1
11 Orch. Harp 5
12 French Horns 1
13 Grv Funk 2
13 Bass DigiFilter3
13 Piano Arp 2
13 French Horns 2
14 Grv Funk 3
14
14 Guitar Country
14 Strings 1
14 Solo Piano 2
15 Grv House 1
15
15 Piano Arp Up
15 Strings 2
15 Solo Piano 3
16 Grv House 2
16
16 Strings 3
16 Solo Piano 4
17 Grv Analog
17
17 Piano Rhythm1/8T
17 Strings 4
17 Solo Synth 1
18 Grv Garage 1
18
18 Strings 5
18 Solo Synth 2
19 Grv Garage 2
19
19 Piano Salsa 1
19 Strings 6
19 Solo Synth 3
20 Grv Dance 1
20
20 Piano Salsa 2
20 Strings 7
20 Solo Synth 4
21 Grv Dance 2
21
21 Pno GlissDwnWhit
21
21 Solo Synth 5
22 Grv Techno 1
22
22 Pno GlissUpWhite
22
22 Solo Synth 6
23 Grv Techno 2
23
23 Pno GlissDwnBlak
23
23 Solo Guitar 1
24
24
24 Pno GlissUpBlack
24 GtrNylon Arp
24
24 Solo Guitar 2
25
25
25 Honky End
25
25
25 Solo Guitar 3
26
26
26
26
26
26
27
27
27
27
27
27
28
28
28
28
28
28
29
29
29
29
29
29
30
30
30
30
30
30
31
31
31
31
31
31
32
32
32
32
32
32
SEQ - Synth&Pad
SEQ - Misc&SFX
Synth Seq 1
Military 1
Synth Seq 2
Military 2
Synth Seq 3
Military 3
Synth Seq 4
Military 4
Synth Seq 5
Horror 1
Synth Seq 6
Horror 2
Synth Seq 7
Horror 3
Synth Seq 8
Horror 4
Synth Seq 9
Lullaby 1
10 Lullaby 2
10
10
10
10
10 Synth Seq 10
Appendix
20
326
Factory data
Pads
11 Synth Seq 11
11 Nature - River
11
11
11
11
12 Synth Portam. 1
12 Nature - Storm
12
12
12
12
13 Synth Portam. 2
13 Metronome
13
13
13
13
14 Synth Portam. 3
14 PreCount
14
14
14
14
15 Synth Portam. 4
15 Metronome 4/4
15
15
15
15
16 Synth Filter 1
16 PreCount 4/4
16
16
16
16
17 Synth Filter 2
17
17
17
17
18 Toccata
18
18
18
18
19 5th Intro
19
19
19
19
20 Primavera
20
20
20
20
21
21 Circus 1
21
21
21
21
22
22 Circus 2
22
22
22
22
23
23
23
23
23
23
24
24
24
24
24
24
25
25
25
25
25
25
26
26
26
26
26
26
27
27
27
27
27
27
28
28
28
28
28
28
29
29
29
29
29
29
30
30
30
30
30
30
31
31
31
31
31
31
32
32
32
32
32
32
Factory data
List of sounds assignable to the Pads in OS versions previous to 2.0
327
ChinaGong
36
DistSlid2
Crash 1
37
Crash 2
38
88 Crash
Ride 1
SOUND NAME
SOUND NAME
71
Darbuka1
106
HeartBeat
Sticks
72
Darbuka2
107
Footstep1
Cowbell
73
Darbuka3
108
Footstep2
39
Agogo 1
74
Darbuka4
109
Stadium
40
Agogo 2
75
Darbuka5
110
DoorCreak
Ride 2
41
Whistle 1
76
Darbuka6
111
DoorSlam
China
42
Whistle 2
77
Darbuka7
112
CarEngine
Ride Bell
43
Sh. Guiro
78
Darbuka8
113
Car Stop
Splash
44
LongGuiro
79
DoufRimAk
114
Car Pass
10
RevCymbal
45
Cuica 1
80
Tef 1
115
Car Crash
11
DragonGng
46
Cuica 2
81
Tef 2
116
Crickets
12
OrchCymb1
47
Triangle1
82
Tef 3
117
Train
13
OrchCymb2
48
Triangle2
83
Tef 4
118
Helicopt
14
OrcSdRoll
49
88Cowbell
84
Tef 5
119
Gun Shot
15
OrchSnare
50
TimbLow
85
Tef 6
120
MachinGun
16
Timpani 1
51
TimbHi
86
Rik 1
121
Laser Gun
17
Timpani 2
52
TimbRim1
87
Rik 2
122
Explosion
18
Timpani 3
53
TimbRim2
88
Rik 3
123
Dog
19
Timpani 4
54
CongaLow
89
RekDomAk
124
H. Gallop
20
Orch. Hit
55
CongaHi
90
OpenBells
125
Birds 1
21
BrassFall
56
CongaSlap
91
Sagat 1
126
Birds 2
22
Ch. Bell
57
CongaMute
92
Sagat 2
127
Thunder
23
JingleBel
58
Tamb.Acc1
93
Davul
128
Sea Shore
24
WindChim1
59
Tamb.Acc2
94
Ramazan 1
129
River
25
WindChim2
60
Tamb.Push
95
Ramazan 2
130
Bubble
26
WindChim3
61
TambOpen
96
Ramazan 3
131
Cat
27
VibraSlap
62
Castanet1
97
Kup 1
132
Lion
28
RainStick
63
Castanet2
98
Kup 2
133
PhoneRing
29
Scratch 1
64
Aah !
99
Kup 3
134
Applause
30
Scratch 2
65
Uuh !
100
Kup 4
135
Wind
31
Scratch 3
66
Yeah ! 1
101
Baya 1
136
Starship
32
Scratch 4
67
Yeah ! 2
102
Baya 2
137
Jetplane
33
Scratch 5
68
Hit It !
103
Laughing
138
Siren
34
Scratch 6
69
Hollo 1
104
Scream
139
Cosmic
35
DistSlid1
70
Hollo 2
105
Punch
Appendix
SOUND NAME
1
328
Factory data
MIDI Setup
MIDI Setup
Default
Master Kbd
Sequencer1
Sequencer 2
Accordion 1
Accordion 2
Accordion 3
Ext. Seq
S1_Tr 1
S1_Tr 1
Global
S1_Tr 1
S2_Tr 1
Global
Upp1
Upp1
S1_Tr 2
Control
S1_Tr 2
S2_Tr 2
Lower
Lower
Lower
S1_Tr 2
S1_Tr 3
S1_Tr 3
S2_Tr 3
Bass
Bass
S1_Tr 3
S1_Tr 4
S1_Tr 4
S2_Tr 4
Upp2
Upp2
S1_Tr 4
S1_Tr 5
S1_Tr 5
S2_Tr 5
Upp3
Upp3
S1_Tr 5
S1_Tr 6
S1_Tr 6
S2_Tr 6
S1_Tr 6
S1_Tr 7
S1_Tr 7
S2_Tr 7
S1_Tr 7
S1_Tr 8
S1_Tr 8
S2_Tr 8
S1_Tr 8
S1_Tr 9
S1_Tr 9
S2_Tr 9
Bass
S1_Tr 9
10
S1_Tr 10
S1_Tr 10
S2_Tr 10
Drum
Drum
Drum
S1_Tr 10
11
S1_Tr 11
S1_Tr 11
S2_Tr 11
Perc
Perc
Perc
S1_Tr 11
12
S1_Tr 12
S1_Tr 12
S2_Tr 12
Acc1
Acc1
Acc1
S1_Tr 12
13
S1_Tr 13
S1_Tr 13
S2_Tr 13
Acc2
Acc2
Acc2
S1_Tr 13
14
S1_Tr 14
S1_Tr 14
S2_Tr 14
Acc3
Acc3
Acc3
S1_Tr 14
15
S1_Tr 15
S1_Tr 15
S2_Tr 15
Acc4
Acc4
Acc4
S1_Tr 15
16
S1_Tr 16
S1_Tr 16
S2_Tr 16
Acc5
Acc5
Acc5
S1_Tr 16
1 Upp1
Upp1
S1_Tr 1
S2_Tr 1
Upp1
S1_Tr 1
S2_Tr 1
Upp. 1
Upp2
Upp2
S1_Tr 2
S2_Tr 2
Upp2
S1_Tr 2
S2_Tr 2
Upp3
Upp3
S1_Tr 3
S2_Tr 3
Upp3
S1_Tr 3
S2_Tr 3
Lower
Lower
S1_Tr 4
S2_Tr 4
Lower
S1_Tr 4
S2_Tr 4
S1_Tr 5
S2_Tr 5
S1_Tr 5
S2_Tr 5
S1_Tr 6
S2_Tr 6
S1_Tr 6
S2_Tr 6
S1_Tr 7
S2_Tr 7
S1_Tr 7
S2_Tr 7
S1_Tr 8
S2_Tr 8
S1_Tr 8
S2_Tr 8
Bass
Bass
S1_Tr 9
S2_Tr 9
Bass
S1_Tr 9
S2_Tr 9
10
Drum
Drum
S1_Tr 10
S2_Tr 10
Drum
S1_Tr 10
S2_Tr 10
11
Perc
Perc
S1_Tr 11
S2_Tr 11
Perc
S1_Tr 11
S2_Tr 11
12
Acc1
Acc1
S1_Tr 12
S2_Tr 12
Acc1
S1_Tr 12
S2_Tr 12
13
Acc2
Acc2
S1_Tr 13
S2_Tr 13
Acc2
S1_Tr 13
S2_Tr 13
14
Acc3
Acc3
S1_Tr 14
S2_Tr 14
Acc3
S1_Tr 14
S2_Tr 14
15
Acc4
Acc4
S1_Tr 15
S2_Tr 15
Acc4
S1_Tr 15
S2_Tr 15
16
Acc5
Acc5
S1_Tr 16
S2_Tr 16
Acc5
S1_Tr 16
S2_Tr 16
Chord 1 Chann.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Chord 2 Chann.
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Off
Harm. Chann.
Off
Harm. Octave
-1
-1
-1
Harm. Range HI
G9
G9
G9
G9
G9
G9
G9
G9
Harm. Range LO
C -1
C -1
C -1
C -1
C -1
C -1
C -1
C -1
MIDI IN Velocity
Normal
Normal
Normal
Normal
110
110
Normal
Normal
MIDI IN Mute/Un.
MIDI IN
Channel
MIDI OUT
Channel
Effects
Diagrams
329
Effects
Pa1X is equipped with four powerful Effect Processors. You can
send them the internal tracks, or any signal entering the Audio
Inputs.
Modulation source
Note
Sostenu: #66
Sostenuto Pedal
MIDI(CC#80)
MIDI(CC#81)
Diagrams
MIDI(CC#82)
MIDI(CC#83)
Diagram
Left
Tempo
Right
1
Note
Dmpr
Damper Pedal
On
Off
Gate1
Note
Off
No modulation
Gate1+Dmpr
Time
Gate1
Gate2,Gate2+Dmpr
1
Note
Gate1+Dmpr
Dmpr
Damper Pedal
Gate2
Gate2
Gate2+Dmpr
Note Nr
On
Off
Gate2+Dmpr
Note Number
Velocity
Note Velocity
AfterTouch
After Touch
JS X
Joystick Left/Right
JS+Y: CC#01
Joystick Forward
JS-Y: CC#02
Joystick Backward
Time
MIDI(CC#04)
MIDI(CC#12)
MIDI(CC#13)
MIDI(CC#16)
Appendix
MIDI(CC#18)
MIDI(CC#17)
MIDI(CC#19)
MIDI(CC#20)
MIDI(CC#21)
Damper: #64
Prta.SW: #65
Portamento Switch
330
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
002: Compressor
Filter/Dynamic
This effect compresses the input signal to regulate the level and
give a punchy effect. It is useful for guitar, piano, and drum
sounds. This is a stereo compressor. You can link left and right
channels, or use each channel separately.
000: No Effect
Select this option when you do not use any effects. When this
option is selected, the effect is muted.
Wet / Dry
EQ Trim
LEQ
HEQ
Compressor
Output Level
Envelope - Control
Envelope Select
Envelope - Control
Output Level
Compressor
EQ Trim
LEQ
HEQ
Right
Wet / Dry
Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
1...100
Attack
Sets the attack level
1...100
EQ Trim
Sets the EQ input level
0...100
Wet / Dry
Amplier Type
Selects the type of guitar amplier
Src
Selects the modulation source of the effect balance
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance
15.0...+15.0dB
15.0...+15.0dB
Output Level
Sets the output level of the compressor
Off...Tempo
100...+100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds
b
b
Amp Simulation Filter
Right
Envelope Select
L/R Mix, L/R Individually
Determines whether the left and right channels are linked or used separately
0...100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the compressor output level
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the compressor output level
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
a: Envelope Select
This parameter selects whether the left and right channels are
linked to control both signals simultaneously, or whether each
channel is controlled independently.
Louder
Dry
Sensitivity=40
Time
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
c: Attack
331
a: Envelope Select
When L/R Mix is selected for this parameter, the left and right
channels are linked to control the Limiter using the mixed signal.
If L Only (or R Only) is selected, the left and right channels are
linked, and the Limiter is controlled via only the left (or right)
channel.
With L/R individually, the left and right channels control the Limiter individually.
Compressor - Attack
Level
Attack=80
Attack=20
Wet
Dry
Time
003: Limiter
Ratio=4.0 : 1
Ration=Inf : 1
Louder
Wet / Dry
Louder
Gain Adjust
Input Level
Limiter
Side PEQ
Envelope - Control
Trigger Monitor
Level
Dry
Envelope - Control
Envelope Select
Ratio=1.0 : 1
Ratio=2.0 : 1
Ratio=4.0 : 1
Limiter
Threshold
Gain Adjust
Right
Ratio=Inf : 1
Wet / Dry
Time
Envelope Select
L/R Mix, L Only, R Only, L/R Individually
Selects from linking both channels, controlling only from left channel, only
from the right channel, or controlling each channel individually
Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio
Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied
d: Attack, d: Release
These parameters set the attack time and release time. A higher
attack time will cause the compression to be applied more slowly.
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
40...0dB
Threshold
Dry
Attack
Sets the attack time
1...100
Release
Sets the release time
1...100
Src
Selects the modulation source for the output gain
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the output gain
Side PEQ Insert
Toggles between on/off of the trigger signals EQ
Wet
Ratio=Inf : 1
Attack=100
Release=100
63...+63
Release
Off, On
Attack
Trigger Monitor
Off, On
Switches between effect output monitor and trigger signal monitor
Q
Sets the EQ bandwidth for the trigger signal
Gain [dB]
Sets the EQ gain for the trigger signal
20...12.00kHz
0.5...10.0
18.0...+18.0dB
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Ratio=Inf : 1
Attack=1
Release=1
Off...Tempo
Wet
Inf, 38...+24dB
,
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
f: Trigger Monitor
Setting this parameter On will cause the trigger signal to be output, instead of the effect sound. Use this parameter to check the
trigger signal with EQ applied.
Usually, set this to Off.
Appendix
332
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
005: Gate
This effect applies the Limiter to the low range, mid range, and
high range of the input signal. You can control dynamics for
each range to adjust the sound pressure of the low range, mid
range, and high range in a different way from the EQ.
This effect mutes the input signal if its level is lower than the
specified level. It also reverses the on and off operation of the
gate, and uses Note On and Off messages to turn the gate on and
off.
Left
Band-Pass Filters
Low
Mid
Left
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Delay
Limiter
Envelope - Control
Low Offset
Envelope - Control
Gain Adjust
Envelope Select
Limiter
Right
Envelope - Control
Limiter
Envelope - Control
High Mid Offset
Envelope - Control
High Offset
Gate
Delay
Gate
Right
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Gate+Sus
Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003
Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied
Attack
Sets the attack time
1...100
Fx:003
Release
Sets the release time
Fx:003
40...0dB
Fx:003
Envelope Select
D-mod, L/R Mix, L Only, R Only
Selects from Control via the modulation source, mixing the left and right signals, Only left, and Only right
,
Src
Off...Gate2+Dmpr
Selects the modulation source that controls the gate when Envelope Select =
D-mod
1...100
Polarity
Switches between non-reversed and reversed Gate on/off
40...0dB
Threshold
Sets the level to which the Gate is applied
0...100
40...0dB
Attack
Sets the attack time
1...100
40...0dB
Release
Sets the release time
1...100
Inf, 38...+24dB
Src
Selects the modulation source for the output gain
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the output gain
100...+100
0...100msec
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
63...+63
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
Off...Tempo
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:003,
+,
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
b: Polarity
This parameter reverses the Gate on/off operation. With a negative value, the gate is closed when the input signal level exceeds
the Threshold. The gate operation controlled by the modulation
source is also reversed.
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
The Attack and Release parameters set the Gate attack time and
release time.
333
20...1.0kHz
Gate - Threshold
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330
Output Level
18...+18dB
Louder
Threshold
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1
g
Louder
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1
Input Level
Gate - Attack / Release
18...+18dB
Threshold
Dry
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2
Wet
0.5...10.0
Attack=1
Release=1
0.5...10.0
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2
18...+18dB
Direct Mix
Sets the amount of the dry sound mixed to the distortion
0...50
i
Wet
Speaker Simulation
Switches the speaker simulation on/off
Attack=100
Release=100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Release
Attack
Off, On
e: Delay Time
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
This parameter sets the delay time of the Gate input. If the sound
has a very fast attack, increase the delay time so that the signal
will be input after the Gate is opened. This will preserve the
attack part of the sound.
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
a: Wah
(Overdrive/Hi.Gain Wah)
a: Sw
This parameter sets how the wah effect is switched on and off via
the modulation source.
When Sw = Moment, the wah effect is usually turned off. It is
turned on only when you press the pedal or operate the joystick.
When a value for the modulation source is less than 64, off
speed is selected, and when the value is 64 or higher, on is
selected.
Wet / Dry
Direct Mix
Right
Wet / Dry
D-mod
Wah
Switches Wah on/off
a
Off, On
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that switches the Wah on and off
Sw
Toggle, Moment
Selects the switching mode for the modulation source that switches the Wah
on and off
b
Wah Sweep Src
Selects the modulation source that controls the Wah
c
10...+10
Off...Tempo
Drive Mode
Overdrive, Hi-Gain
Switches between overdrive and hi-gain distortion
Drive
Sets the degree of distortion
Output Level
Sets the output level
e
Src
Selects the modulation source for the output level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the output level
d: Pre Low-cut
1...100
d
Pre Low-cut
Sets the low range cut amount of the distortion input
This parameter sets the sweep range of the wah center frequency. A negative value will reverse the direction of sweep. The
wah center frequency can be controlled by the modulation
source specified in the Wah Sweep Src parameter.
0...10
0...50
Off...Tempo
50...+50
Cutting the signal in the low range before it is input to the Distortion will create a sharp distortion.
g: Q, h: Q
These parameters set the bandwidth of each equalizer. The
higher the value, the narrower the band becomes.
Appendix
Pre Low-cut
Wah
334
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
You can control the gain of Band 2 using the modulation source.
Parametric 4EQ - Band2 Dynamic Gain Control
This is a stereo 4-band parametric equalizer. You can select peaking type or shelving type for Band 1 and 4. The gain of Band 2
can be controlled by dynamic modulation.
D-mod
+15dB
Band2 Cutoff
+6dB
+6dB
0dB
0dB
Band2 Cutoff
9dB
Left
PEQ
PEQ
LEQ
PEQ
HEQ
PEQ
PEQ
PEQ
Right
Wet / Dry
-mod
Trim
Sets the input level
Band1 Type
Selects the type of Band 1
Peaking, Shelving-Low
Band4 Type
Selects the type of Band 4
Peaking, Shelving-High
0...100
Wet / Dry
Trim
Off...Tempo
Amt [dB]
Sets the modulation amount of Band 2 gain
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
0.5...10.0
a
50...10.00kHz
Trim
Sets the input level
0.5...10.0
Band1 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
18.0...+18.0dB
18.0...+18.0dB
,
Band2 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
18.0...+18.0dB
300...10.00kHz
Band3 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
18.0...+18.0dB
0.5...10.0
Band4 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
18.0...+18.0dB
18.0...+18.0dB
Band5 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 5
18.0...+18.0dB
500...20.00kHz
Band6 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 6
18.0...+18.0dB
0.5...10.0
Band7 [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 7
18.0...+18.0dB
18.0...+18.0dB
Fx:006
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
Band4 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 4
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
0dB
Band1 Type=Shelving Low
Band1 Type=Peaking
3dB
Band1 Cutoff
Band4 Cutoff
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
100...+100
3dB
Band4 Type=Shelving High
Band4 Type=Peaking
0...100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
18.0...+18.0dB
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Gain
Wet / Dry
Fx:006
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
+Gain
20...1.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
Trim
Left
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
D-mod
HEQ
LEQ
Trim
Wet / Dry
PEQ
a: Type
This parameter selects a combination of center frequencies for
each band. Each center frequency is shown on the right edge of
the LCD.
You can configure a 21-Band Graphic EQ ranging from 80Hz to
18kHz if you route three Graphic 7Band EQ effects in series, with
a setting of 7:Low, 9:Mid, and 11:High for each EQ.
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
335
009: Wah/AutoWah
This stereo wah effect allows you to create sounds from vintage
wah pedal simulation to auto-wah simulation, and much
broader range settings.
The sweep width and direction of the wah filter are determined
by the Frequency Top and Frequency Bottom settings.
Sweep Mode=D-mod
Frequency
Wet / Dry
Wah
Envelope Sens
Envelope Shape
Response
D-mod
Wah
Bottom=60
Higher
Left
Wah
Woo
Top=30
Woo
Bottom=25
Sweep Mode
Auto
D-mod
D-mod
Higher
Zero
LFO
Higher
Top=75
Frequency
D-mod
Higher
Zero
Max
Max
LFO
Wah
Sweep Mode=Auto
Frequency
Frequency
Right
Wet / Dry
Wah
Bottom=75
Frequency Bottom
Sets the lower limit of the wah center frequency
0...100
Frequency Top
Sets the upper limit of the wah center frequency
0...100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the wah when Sweep Mode=D-mod
0...100
c
Envelope Shape
Sets the sweep curve of auto-wah
100...+100
0.02...20.00Hz
,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
Woo
Bottom=25
Top=25
Woo
Envelope
Envelope
Time
Time
MIDI, 40...240
Envelope Shape
Level
Base Note
,
, ,
, ,
, ,
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
Envelope
c: Envelope Shape
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
,
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Wah
b: Sweep Mode
Response
0...100
Sets the response speed when Sweep Mode = Auto or D-mod
Woo
Sweep Mode
Auto, D-mod, LFO
Selects the control from auto-wah, modulation source, and LFO
,
Wah
Higher
Higher
Top=75
Envelope
value = 0...+100
x1...x16
value = 0...100
Time
0...100
Off, On
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Appendix
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
336
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
This stereo band pass filter uses a step-shape waveform and random LFO for modulation. You can create a special effect from
filter oscillation.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
When LFO Waveform is set to Step-Tri, LFO is a step-shape, triangle waveform. The LFO Frequency parameter sets the original triangle waveform speed. Changing the LFO Step Freq
parameter enables you to adjust the width of the steps.
When LFO Waveform is set to Random, the LFO Step Freq
parameter uses a random LFO cycle.
Filter
Filter
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Step Freq
LFO Phase
LFO: Step-Tri/Random
Step-Tri
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Step-Tri, Random
Random
20.00...+20.00Hz
180
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009,
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
0...100
0...100
Src
Selects the modulation source of lter modulation
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of lter modulation
100...+100
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
0...100
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
,
j
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
The effect sounds phase will be reversed when you set this
parameter in the range of values from Wet to 1:99.
x1...x32
Manual
Sets the lter center frequency
Depth
Sets the modulation depth of lter center frequency
0 [degree]
j: Wet/Dry
x1...x16
Fx:009
90
50.00...+50.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source used for both LFO speed and step speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
0.02...20.00Hz
,
100...+100
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
337
011: Exciter/Enhancer
Wet / Dry
LEQ
HEQ
Exciter
EQ Trim
Delay
EQ Trim
Delay
Depth
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Exciter
Left
Enhancer
Wet / Dry
Envelope Shape
Wet / Dry
D-mod
D-mod
Note No.
Exciter Blend
Sets the intensity (depth) of the Exciter effect
a
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the Exciter intensity
100...+100
Emphatic Point
Sets the frequency to be emphasized
b
Envelope Shape
0...70
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the frequency to be emphasized
Sine Oscillator
Right
Fixed
100...+100
,
Src
Selects the modulation source of the Exciter intensity
Fixed Frequency
Note Interval, Fine
Wet / Dry
OSC Mode
Note (Key Follow), Fixed
Determines whether the oscillator frequency follows the note number or
whether it is xed
Note Interval
48...0
Sets the pitch difference from the note number when OSC Mode=Note (Key
Follow)
Amt
70...+70
Sets the amount of modulation of the frequency to be emphasized
Note Fine
Fine adjustment of the oscillator frequency
0.0...50.0msec
0.0...50.0msec
Enhancer Depth
0...100
Sets the determines to what degree the Enhancer effect is applied
e
Src
Selects the modulation source of the Enhancer width
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the Enhancer width
100...+100
0...100
15.0...+15.0dB
15.0...+15.0dB
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the oscillator frequency when OSC
Mode=Fixed
100...+100
e
Envelope Shape
Sets the oscillators volume envelope curve
100...+100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Amt
80...+80Hz
Sets the oscillator frequency modulation amount when OSC Mode=Fixed
d
EQ Trim
Sets the 2-band EQ input level
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
b: Emphatic Point
This parameter sets the frequency to be emphasized. Higher values will emphasize lower frequencies.
a: Exciter Blend
Appendix
Right
338
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
Left
Wet / Dry
Voice Bottom
Voice Center
A
+
Talking Modulator
Voice Top
A
I
A-I-U-E-O
U
E
Right
D-mod
LFO
Wet / Dry
D-mod
Voice Top: A
Voice Center: I
Voice Bottom: U
Sweep Mode
D-mod
LFO
JS +Y
JS Y
etc
b
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that controls the voice pattern
Voice Top
Selects a vowel sound at the top end of control
A, I, U, E, O
Voice Center
Selects a vowel sound in the center of control
A, I, U, E, O
Voice Bottom
Selects a vowel sound at the bottom end of control
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
A, I, U, E, O
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
Fx:009,
tempo and notes
g
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
Formant Shift
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
h
Resonance
Sets the Level of resonance of the voice pattern
x1...x16
Fx:009
100...+100
0...100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
+ Max
+ Max
Zero
h: Resonance
Zero
Max
h: Formant Shift
Sweep Mode
D-mod, LFO
Switches between modulation source control and LFO control
Manual Voice Control
Voice pattern control
JS X
Ribbon
100...+100
This parameter sets the intensity of resonance for the voice pattern. A larger value will add more character to the sound.
Effects
Filter/Dynamic
339
014: Decimator
This effect creates a rough sound like a cheap sampler by lowering the sampling frequency and data bit length. You can also
simulate noise unique to a sampler (aliasing).
Left
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
EQ Trim
Pre EQ
EQ Trim
Pre EQ
Decimator
D-mod
Analog Record
Simulation
Sampling Frequency
LFO
Decimator
Resolution
Wet / Dry
Pre LPF
Off, On
Selects whether the harmonic noise caused by a decrease in sampling frequency is generated or not
0...100%
Right
Wet / Dry
Speed [RPM]
Sets the r.p.m. of a record
33 1/3, 45, 78
Flutter
Sets the modulation depth
0...100
Noise Density
Sets the noise density
0...100
Noise Tone
Sets the noise tone
0...100
Noise Level
Sets the noise level
0...100
1.00k...48.00kHz
c
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the sampling frequency
Amt
48.00k...+48.00kHz
Sets the modulation amount of the sampling frequency
LFO Frequency [Hz]
Sets the LFO speed
0.02...20.00Hz
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
0...100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the LFO modulation source of the sampling frequency
Resolution
Sets the data bit length
Output Level
Sets the output level
0...100
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the noise level
100...+100
Src
Selects the modulation source for the click noise level
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the click noise level
100...+100
EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
Q
Sets the EQ band width
0...100
0...100
300...10.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Src
Selects the modulation source for the output level
Off...Tempo
Gain [dB]
Sets the EQ gain
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the output level
100...+100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Off...Tempo
4...24
Src
Selects the modulation source for the noise level
Click Level
Sets the click noise level
20.00...+20.00Hz
Amt
100...+100
Sets the LFO modulation amount of the sampling frequency
e
Off...Tempo
Depth
Sets the depth of the sampling frequency LFO modulation
d
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
18.0...+18.0dB
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
100...+100
a: Pre LPF
If a sampler with a very low sampling frequency receives very
high-pitched sound that could not be heard during playback, it
could generate pitch noise that is unrelated to the original
sound. Set Pre LPF to ON to prevent this noise from being generated.
If you set the Sampling Freq to about 3kHz and set Pre LPF to
OFF, you can create a sound like a ring modulator.
b: Flutter
This parameter enables you to set the depth of the modulation
caused by a warped turntable.
e: Click Level
This parameter enables you to set the level of the click noise that
occurs once every rotation of the turntable. This simulation
reproduces record noise, and the noise generated after the music
on a vinyl record finishes.
Appendix
Pre LPF
Right
340
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
Pitch/Phase Mod.
016: Chorus
This effect adds thickness and warmth to the sound by modulating the delay time of the input signal. You can add spread to the
sound by offsetting the phase of the left and right LFOs from
each other.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Low Level
Chorus/Flanger
High Damp
Feedback
High Damp
Wet / Dry
High Level
High Level
Chorus/Flanger
Low Level
Right
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
LEQ
HEQ
LFO Phase
Chorus
EQ Trim
LEQ
HEQ
Chorus
EQ Trim
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sine
Off...Tempo
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
Triangle, Sine
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Off...Tempo
d
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
x1...x16
0.0...50.0msec
0.0...50.0msec
0.0...50.0msec
0...100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the LFO modulation depth
Feedback
Sets the feed back amount of the chorus block
0...100
100...+100
h
High Damp [%]
Sets the high range damping amount of the chorus block
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the LFO modulation depth
EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
x1...x16
Fx:009
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth
h
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
Fx:009
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
d
20.00...+20.00Hz
0...100%
Low Level
Sets the low range output level
0...100
High Level
Sets the high range (chorus) output level
0...100
i
0...100
15.0...+15.0dB
15.0...+15.0dB
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
i
j
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010,
j
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
h: Feedback
Setting the left and right delay time individually allows you to
control the stereo image.
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
341
019: Ensemble
This effect has four chorus blocks with a different LFO phase.
You can create a complex stereo image by setting each blocks
delay time, depth, output level, and pan individually. You can
also fix some of the chorus blocks to combine the chorus and
delay effects.
This Ensemble effect has three chorus blocks that use LFO to
create subtle shimmering, and gives three dimensional depth
and spread to the sound, because the signal is output from the
left, right, and center.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Feedback
Tap1 Delay
Tap2 Delay
Tap3 Delay
Tap4 Delay
Right
Level
Pan
Level
Pan
Level
Pan
Level
Pan
0 [degree]
180 [degree]
90 [degree]
270 [degree]
Ensemble
Right
Wet / Dry
Shimmer
Wet / Dry
LFO
LFO: Triangle
Speed
Sets the LFO speed
0.02...13.00Hz
a
Tap1(000) [msec]
Sets the Tap1 (LFO phase=0 degrees) delay time
0...570msec
Depth
Sets the Tap1 chorus depth
0...30
Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
0...30
b
L6...L1, C, R1...R6
Tap2(180) [msec]
Sets the Tap2 (LFO phase=180 degrees) delay time
c
0...30
Level
Sets the Tap2 output level
0...30
d
L6...L1, C, R1...R6
Depth
Sets the Tap3 chorus depth
0...30
Level
Sets the Tap3 output level
0...30
0...100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the LFO modulation depth
Shimmer
Sets the amount of shimmering of the LFO waveform
0...100
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
c: Shimmer
This parameter sets the amount of shimmering of the LFO waveform. Increasing this value adds more shimmering, making the
chorus effect more complex and richer.
L6...L1, C, R1...R6
Tap4(270) [msec]
Sets the Tap4 (LFO phase=270 degrees) delay time
100...+100
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
0...570msec
Pan
Sets the Tap3 stereo image
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Tap3(090) [msec]
Sets the Tap3 (LFO phase=90 degrees) delay time
Off...Tempo
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth
0...570msec
Depth
Sets the Tap2 chorus depth
Pan
Sets the Tap2 stereo image
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
Pan
Sets the Tap1 stereo image
1...100
0...570msec
Ensemble LFO
Level
Depth
Sets the Tap4 chorus depth
0...30
Level
Sets the Tap4 output level
0...30
Shimmer
Pan
Sets the Tap4 stereo image
L6...L1, C, R1...R6
Tap1 Feedback
Sets the Tap1 feedback amount
f
Time
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of Tap1 feedback amount and effect balance
Amt
100...+100
Sets the Tap1 feedback amount and modulation amount
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
g
100...+100
Appendix
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
342
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
020: Flanger
b: LFO Shape
LFO Waveform=Sine
Wet / Dry
g: Feedback, h: Wet/Dry
Flanger
Feedback
High Damp
Flanger
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sine
LFO Shape
0.0...50.0msec
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
b
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
c
100...+100
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Off...Tempo
Left
Wet / Dry
Flanger
20.00...+20.00Hz
Feedback
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
e
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
High Damp
Flanger
Right
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Step-Tri/Random
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
f
x1...x16
Fx:009
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
100...+100
0...100%
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010,
h
0...100
g
High Damp [%]
Sets the feedback damping amount in the high range
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
e
Step-Tri, Random
Fx:010
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:010,
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source used for both LFO speed and step speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
0.0...50.0msec
20.00...+20.00Hz
50.00...+50.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
f
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009, 010
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
Step Base Note
Selects the type of notes to specify the LFO step speed
Fx:010,
Times
Sets the number of notes to specify the LFO step speed
x1...x16
Fx:009
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
x1...x32
Fx:010
0...100
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
100...+100
Fx:020
i
High Damp [%]
Sets the feedback damping amount in the high range
0...100%
When Sweep Mode = D-mod, the modulation source can control the flanger directly. Select the modulation source using the
Src parameter.
Fx:020
The effect is off when a value for the modulation source specified for the Src parameter is smaller than 64, and the effect is
on when the value is 64 or higher. The Envelope Generator is
triggered when the value changes from 63 or smaller to 64 or
higher.
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010, 020,
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
d: EG Attack, d: EG Decay
Attack and Decay speed are the only adjustable parameters on
this EG.
023: Phaser
This effect creates a swell by shifting the phase. It is very effective
on electric piano sounds. You can add spread to the sound by
offsetting the phase of the left and right LFOs from each other.
Left
Left
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Flanger
Phaser
Feedback
Resonance
High Damp
High Damp
Flanger
Phaser
Right
D-mod
EG Attack/Decay
EG
Right
Wet / Dry
D-mod
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
EG Attack
Sets the EG attack speed
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
1...100
1...100
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
100...+100
Fx:020
Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
e
SrcOff...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on
page 330
x1...x16
Fx:009
Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
0...100
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the LFO modulation depth
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth
100...+100
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
100...+100
g
High Damp [%]
Sets the resonance damping amount in the high range
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the
effect balance, on page 330
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
EG Decay
Sets the EG decay speed
100...+100
Fx:020
SrcOff...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that triggers the EG (when EG is
selected for Sweep Mode), or modulation source that causes the
anger to sweep (when D-mod is selected for Sweep Mode)
Triangle, Sine
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
LFO Shape
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
Sweep Mode
0...100%
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010,
h
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Appendix
343
344
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
g: Resonance, h: Wet/Dry
The peak shape of the positive and negative Feedback value is
different. The harmonics will be emphasized when the effect
sound is mixed with the dry sound, if you set a positive value for
both Resonance and Wet/Dry, and if you set a negative value
for both Resonance and Wet/Dry.
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010, 023,
j
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Wet / Dry
Phaser
Resonance
Left
Wet / Dry
High Damp
Phaser
Phaser
Right
Resonance
D-mod
D-mod
EG Attack/Decay
High Damp
Phaser
Wet / Dry
Sweep Mode
EG
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Step-Tri/Random
a
a
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Fx:009
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:010,
20.00...+20.00Hz
0.05...50.00Hz
Fx:010,
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO step speed
50.00...+50.00Hz
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
009, 010
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
x1...x32
Fx:010
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
100...+100
Fx:023
0...100%
Fx:023
EG Decay
Sets the EG decay speed
Fx:022
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
0...100
Fx:022
1...100
1...100
100...+100
Fx:023
0...100%
Fx:023
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010, 023,
Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
EG Attack
Sets the EG attack speed
x1...x16
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that triggers the EG (when EG is selected for
Sweep Mode), or modulation source that causes the anger to sweep
(when D-mod is selected for Sweep Mode)
Fx:009
Sweep Mode
EG, D-mod
Determines whether the anger is controlled by the envelope generator or
by the modulation source
Fx:022,
c
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source commonly used for LFO speed and step
speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Fx:009
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
345
027: Vibrato
(Biphase Modulation)
This stereo chorus effect adds two different LFOs together. You
can set the Frequency and Depth parameters for each LFO individually. Depending on the setting of these LFOs, very complex
waveforms will create an analog-type, unstable modulated
sound.
This effect causes the pitch of the input signal to shimmer. Using
the AutoFade allows you to increase or decrease the shimmering
speed.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Vibrato
Wet / Dry
Vibrato
Chorus/Flanger
High Damp
Right
Feedback
Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine
High Damp
Chorus/Flanger
AutoFade
LFO Shape
Fade-In Delay
LFO Frequency
Right
Wet / Dry
180 [degree]
LFO1: Tri / Sine
AUTOFADE Src
Selects the modulation source that starts AutoFade
Off...Tempo
,
Fade-In Rate
Sets the rate of fade-in
LFO1 Waveform
Selects LFO1 waveform
Triangle, Sine
LFO2 Waveform
Selects LFO2 waveform
Triangle, Sine
Off...Tempo
30.00...+30.00
Depth1
Sets the depth of LFO1 modulation
e
0.0...50.0msec
Fx:016
0.0...50.0msec
Fx:016
LFO1
Depth1
LFO2
Depth2
0...100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the LFO modulation depth
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the LFO modulation depth
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
x1...x16
Fx:009
0...100%
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010,
j
100...+100
Fx:017
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of LFO2 modulation depth
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
0...100
20.00...+20.00Hz
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of LFO1 modulation depth
Depth2
Sets the depth of LFO2 modulation
Off...Tempo
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
0...100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of LFO1&2 modulation depth
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
100...+100
Fx:020
30.00...+30.00
0.02...30.00Hz
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO2 speed
Triangle, Sine
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
d
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO1 speed
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
0.02...30.00Hz
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO1&2 speed
00...2000msec
LFO Phase Sw
0 degree, 180 degree
Switches the LFO phase difference between left and right
LFO1 Frequency [Hz]
Sets the LFO1 speed
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Appendix
1...100
346
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Note On
AUTOFADE
AutoFade
AUTOFADE Src=Gate1
LFO Frequency[Hz]=1.0
LFO Freq. Mod=AUTOFADE
Amt=+3.0
Gate1 Signal
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010, 020,
This effect resonates the input signal at a specified pitch. You can
set the pitch, output level, and pan settings for two resonators
individually. You can control the resonance intensity via an LFO.
LFO Frequency
=1.0+3.0=4.0Hz
Fade-In Rate
Fade-In Dealy
LFO Frequency
=1.0Hz
Wet / Dry
High Damp
Resonator
Trim
Level
Pan
Level
Pan
Resonance
Resonator
Trim
High Damp
Right
Wet / Dry
D-mod
Invert: On/Off
Pitch, Fine [cent]
LFO
Control Mode
Left
Manual
Wet / Dry
Delay
Control Mode
Switches the controls of resonance intensity
Feedback
High Damp
Delay
Right
LFO/D-mod Invert
Off, On
Reverses the Voice 1 and 2 control when LFO/D-mod is selected
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sine
LFO Shape
AutoFade
LFO Frequency
Wet / Dry
D-mod Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that controls resonance intensity
AUTOFADE Src
Selects the modulation source that starts AutoFade
a
Rate
Sets the rate of fade-in
Mod. Depth
100...+100
Sets the amount of resonance intensity control via LFO/D-mod
Off...Tempo
c
Fx:027,
1...100
Fx:027
00...2000msec
Fx:027
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
Voice1: Resonance
100...+100
Sets the intensity of resonance when Control Mode = Manual
Voice1: Level
Sets the Voice1 output level
0...100
Pan
Sets the Voice1 stereo image
L6...R6
Voice2: Pitch
Sets the Voice2 Pitch for resonance
C0...B8
Fine [cent]
Fine-adjusts the voice 2 pitch for resonance
Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
h
0.0...500.0msec
0.0...500.0msec
h
High Damp [%]
Sets the feedback damping amount in the high range
50...+50
Voice2: Resonance
100...+100
Sets the intensity of resonance when Control Mode = Manual
0...100
Pan
Sets the Voice2 stereo image
L6...R6
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
50...+50
C0...B8
0.02...20.00Hz
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Voice1: Pitch
Sets the voice1 Pitch for resonance
0...100
Fine [cent]
Fine-adjusts the voice 1 pitch for resonance
100...+100
Fx:020
Trim
Sets the input level at the resonator
Triangle, Sine
0.02...20.00Hz
0...200
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
100...+100
Fx:020
0...100%
Fx:020
Wet/Dry Mod
D-mod, AUTOFADE
Switches between D-mod and AUTOFADE for the effect balance modulation
Fx:027
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
030: Doppler
This effect simulates the Doppler effect of a moving sound
with a changing pitch, similar to the siren of an passing ambulance. Mixing the effect sound with the dry sound will create a
unique chorus effect.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Pan Depth
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO
D-mod
a: LFO/D-mod Invert
When Control Mode = LFO or D-mod, the controlled phase of
either Voice 1 or 2 will be reversed. When the resonance pitch is
set for Voice 1 (Resonance has a positive value), Voice 2 will resonate at a pitch an octave below (Resonance has a negative value).
Doppler
Wet / Dry
Trigger
LFO Mode
Switches LFO operation mode
a
Loop, 1-Shot
,
Src
Off...Tempo
When LFO Mode is set to 1-Shot, this modulation source triggers the LFO
LFO Sync
Off, On
Switches between LFO reset on and off when LFO Mode is set to Loop
LFO Frequency [Hz]
Sets the LFO speed
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
d
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
Pitch Depth
Sets the pitch variation of the moving sound
e
x1...x16
Fx:009
,
0...100
Src
Selects the modulation source of pitch variation
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of pitch variation
100...+100
Pan Depth
Sets the panning of the moving sound
100...+100
,
Src
Selects the modulation source of panning
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of panning
100...+100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Appendix
347
348
Effects
Pitch/Phase Mod.
The effect is off when a value for the modulation source specified for the Src parameter is smaller than 64, and the effect is
on when the value is 64 or higher. The Doppler effect is triggered when the value changes from 63 or smaller to 64 or
higher.
e: Pitch Depth
With the Doppler effect, the pitch is raised when the sound
approaches, and the pitch is lowered when the sound goes away.
This parameter sets this pitch variation.
Playback Position
End
Recorded Sound
f: Pan Depth
This parameter sets the width of the stereo image of the effect
sound. With larger values, the sound seems to come and go from
much further away. With positive values, the sound moves from
left to right; with negative values, the sound moves from right to
left.
Doppler - Pitch / Pan Depth
Higher
Pitch
Pan Depth
= (+) value
Pitch Depth
Lower
Center
Left
Right
Pan Depth
<
<
<
Louder
Volume
>
>
Wet / Dry
Scratch
Direct
Mix
Scratch
Right
D-mod
Envelope Control
Input
Envelope Select
Wet / Dry
D-mod
D-mod
Scratch Source
Selects the modulation source for simulation control
Response
Sets the speed of the response to the Scratch Source
Off...Tempo
,
0...100
Envelope Select
D-mod, Input
Selects whether the start and end of recording is controlled via the modula,
tion source or the input signal level
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that controls recording when Envelope Select
is set to D-mod
Threshold
0...100
Sets the recording start level when Envelope Select is set to Input
Response
Sets the speed of the response to the end of recording
Direct Mix
Always On, Always Off, Cross Fade
Selects how a dry sound is mixed
0...100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Zero
Zero
+ Max
+ Max
e: Response
Rec Control
JS+Y
JSY
etc
Scratch!
Max
>
Louder
031: Scratch
JS X
Ribbon
Pan Depth
= () value
Original Pitch
Scratch Source
D-mod
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
f: Direct Mix
With Always On, a dry sound is usually output. With Always Off,
dry sounds are not output. With Cross Fade, a dry sound is usually
output, and it is muted only when scratching.
Set Wet/Dry to Wet to use this parameter effectively.
349
Effects
Mod./P.Shift
a:LFO Waveform
Mod./P.Shift
This parameter selects the LFO waveform. Vintage wave simulates the characteristics of the tremolo created on a guitar amplifier. Combining this effect with the Amp Simulation will make a
realistic, vintage tremolo amplifier sound.
032: Tremolo
Triangle
This effect modulates the volume level of the input signal. The
effect is stereo, and offsetting the LFO of the left and right phases
from each other produces a tremolo effect between left and
right.
Wet / Dry
LFO Shape
This effect uses the input signal level to modulate a stereo tremolo. You can simulate a tremolo effect that becomes deeper as it
fades out while the level gets lower.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
Tremolo
100...+100
Fx:020
Tremolo
Right
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri/Sin/Vintage
Wet / Dry
LFO Shape
Off...Tempo
+
Envelope
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
0...100
a
Envelope Shape
Sets the envelope curve shape of the input signal
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
100...+100
b
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
x1...x16
Fx:009
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
Envelope Shape
Envelope Sens
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
0...100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the depth of modulation
100...+100
Fx:020
0.02...20.00Hz
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the depth of modulation
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
e
Wet / Dry
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
0...100
Envelope Amount
100...+100
Sets the changes of the modulation depth according to the input signal level
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Appendix
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
LFO Phase
Down
Tremolo
Wet / Dry
Right
Up
Tremolo
Left
Vintage
LFO: Tri/Sin/Vintage/Up/Down
Sine
350
Effects
Mod./P.Shift
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
These parameters set the modulation via an envelope (input signal level).
The LFO speed is obtained by adding the LFO Frequency
value to the Envelope Amount value multiplied by the input
signal. The LFO modulation depth is obtained by adding the
Depth value to the Envelope Amount value multiplied by the
input signal level.
Louder
Dry Envelope
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
LFO Frequency[Hz]=8.0
Envelope Amount[Hz]= 7.0Hz
Depth=100
Envelope Amount= 100
a: LFO Shape
You can change the panning curve by modifying the LFO waveform.
b: LFO Phase
Time
L-In
L-In
L-In
L-In
R-In
R-In
R-In
R-In
Pan
Depth
Pan
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sin
LFO Shape
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
a
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
b
100...+100
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Off...Tempo
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
d
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
x1...x16
Fx:009
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
e
0...100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the depth of modulation
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the depth of modulation
100...+100
L-In
L-In
L-In
Left
R-In
R-In
R-In
L-In
L-In
Wet / Dry
R-In
R-In
R-In
L-In
R-In
L-In
L-In
L-In
This Auto Pan effect pans sound between left and right. It is stereo, and shifting the left and right LFO phases from each other
will simulate the sound of the left and right channels crossing
over each other by turns, or chasing each other.
R-In
R-In
Left
100...+100
Shimmer
Level
Right
Center
Output Stereo Image
R-In
L-In
R-In
Effects
Mod./P.Shift
351
This effect has a stereo phaser and tremolo LFOs linked together.
Swelling phaser modulation and tremolo effects synchronize
with each other, creating a soothing modulation effect. It is suitable for electric piano type sounds.
Wet / Dry
Phaser
Tremolo
Phaser Wet / Dry
Resonance
Phaser Wet / Dry
Tremolo
Phaser
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Type
LFO
LFO Shape
LFO Phase
Wet / Dry
Pre LPF
Ring Modulator
Type:
Phs - Trml...Phs LR - Trml LR
Selects the type of the tremolo and phaser LFOs
Pre LPF
Note No.
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Pre LPF
0...100
Sets the damping amount of the high range input to the ring modulator
OSC Mode
Fixed, Note (Key Follow)
Switching between specifying the oscillator frequency and using a note
number
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
x1...x16
Fx:009
Phaser Manual
Sets the phaser frequency range
0...100
Resonance
Sets the phaser resonance amount
100...+100
Phaser Depth
Sets the phaser modulation depth
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the oscillator frequency when OSC Mode
is set to Fixed
Amt
12.00...+12.00kHz
Sets the modulation amount of the oscillator frequency when OSC Mode is
set to Fixed
0...100
d
Note Offset
48...+48
Sets the pitch difference from the original note when OSC Mode is set to
Note (Key Follow)
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the phaser modulation depth
Note Fine
Fine-adjusts the oscillator frequency
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount for the phaser modulation depth
Phaser Wet/Dry
Wet...2:99, Dry, 2:99...Wet
Sets the balance between the phaser effect and dry sounds
Tremolo Shape
Sets the degree of the tremolo LFO shaping
100...+100
Fx:020
Tremolo Depth
Sets the tremolo modulation depth
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
x1...x16
Fx:009
LFO Depth
0...100
Sets the depth of LFO modulation for the oscillator frequency
100...+100
Select the type of phaser LFO and tremolo LFO for the Type
parameter. How the effect sound moves or rotates depends on
the type of LFO. Selecting LFO Phase enables you to offset the
timing of the phaser peak and control a subtle movement and
rotation of the sound.
Off...Tempo
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
,
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the tremolo modulation depth
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
0...100
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the tremolo modulation depth
Sine Oscillator
OSC Mode Pitch
20.00...+20.00Hz
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fixed
LFO
Off...Tempo
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Wet / Dry
Fixed Frequency
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
c
Right
0.02...20.00Hz
Fx:009,
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
Ring Modulator
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the depth of modulation
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the depth of modulation
Appendix
352
Effects
Mod./P.Shift
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Input Level
Input Level
x1.0
x1.0
Amt= +50
Amt= 50
Amt= +100
Amt= 100
Louder
100...+100
Louder
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
x0.5
D-mod
Higher
a: Pre LPF
Zero
b: OSC Mode
This parameter determines whether or not the oscillator frequency follows the note number.
x0.5
D-mod
Higher
Zero
Max
Max
Wet / Dry
Input Level
High Damp
Pitch Shifter
Delay
Pre
These parameters for the oscillator are used when OSC Mode is
set to Note (Key Follow). The Note Offset sets the pitch difference from the original note in semitone steps. The Note Fine
parameter fine-adjusts the pitch in cent steps. Matching the oscillator frequency with the note number produces a ring modulation effect in the correct key.
Input Level
Post
Feedback Position
Feedback
Right
037: Detune
b
Using this effect, you can obtain a detune effect that offsets the
pitch of the effect sound slightly from the pitch of the input signal. Compared to the chorus effect, a more natural sound thickness will be created.
Mode
Switches Pitch Shifter mode
Wet / Dry
24...+24
,
Src
Selects the modulation source of pitch shift amount
Off...Tempo
24...+24
Fine [cent]
Sets the pitch shift amount by steps of a cent
100...+100cent
,
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of pitch shift amount
100...+100cent
c
Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Feedback Position
Switches the feedback connection.
Input Level
High Damp
Detune
Delay
Feedback
Input Level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the pitch shift
b
0...1000msec
100...+100
0...100%
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
Off...Tempo
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
100...+100
Fx:037,
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
100...+100cent
100...+100
,
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
0...100%
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
Off...Tempo
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
100...+100cent
100...+100
c
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range
Pre, Post
Wet / Dry
Src
Selects the modulation source of the pitch shift
0...1000msec
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
Right
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of pitch shift amount
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
a: Mode
This parameter switches the pitch shifter operating mode. With
Slow, tonal quality will not be changed too much. With Fast, the
effect becomes a Pitch Shifter that has a quick response, but may
change the tone. Medium is in between these two. If you do not
need to set too much pitch shift amount, set this parameter to
Slow. If you wish to change the pitch significantly, use Fast.
Effects
Mod./P.Shift
353
The amount of pitch shift will use the value of the Pitch Shift
plus the Fine value. The amount of modulation will use the c:
Amt value plus d: Amt.
Modulation Source is used both for Pitch Shift and Fine.
Higher
Original Pitch
Lower
LFO Waveform=Square
Depth (value)
f: Pan, g: Wet/Dry
The Pan parameter pans the effect sound and dry sound to the
left and right. With L, the effect sound is panned left, and the dry
sound is panned right. With a Wet/Dry = Wet setting, the effect
and dry sound will be output in a proportion of 1:1.
This effect simulates a rotary speaker, and obtains a more realistic sound by simulating the rotor in the low range and the horn
in the high range separately. The effect also simulates the stereo
microphone settings.
Wet: Mono In - Stereo Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Horn
Wet / Dry
+
+
Rotary Speaker
Pitch Shifter
Horn/Rotor
Balance
Mic Distance
Mic Spread
Rotor
Speaker Simulation
Right
Pan
Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sqr
100...+100cent
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Square
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of LFO speed
a
0.02...20.00Hz
Off...Tempo
Times
Sets the number of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Depth
Sets the LFO modulation depth for pitch shift amount
100...+100
,
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
,
g
100...+100
Horn Ratio
Stop, 0.50...2.00
Adjusts the (high-range side) horn rotation speed. Standard value is 1.00.
Selecting Stop will stop the rotation
Rotor Acceleration
0...100
Determines how quickly the rotor rotation speed in the low range is switched
e
Rotor Ratio
Stop, 0.50...2.00
Adjusts the (low-range side) rotor rotation speed. Standard value is 1.00.
Selecting Stop will stop the rotation
f
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the depth of modulation
Pan
L, 1:99...99:1, R
Sets the panning effect sound and dry sound separately
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that toggles between slow and fast
Horn Acceleration
0...100
How quickly the horn rotation speed in the high range is switched
x1...x16
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the depth of modulation
f
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that toggles between rotation and stop
Sw
Toggle, Moment
Selects switching mode of the modulation source that toggles between slow
and fast
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:009
Base Note
Selects the type of notes that specify the LFO speed
Fx:009
Rotate, Stop
Speed Switch
Slow, Fast
Switches the speaker rotation speed between slow and fast
20.00...+20.00Hz
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Sw
Toggle, Moment
Selects switching mode of the modulation source that toggles between rotation and stop
Fx:009,
BPM/MIDI Sync
Off, On
Switches between using the frequency of the LFO speed and using the
tempo and notes
Fx:009,
Mode Switch
Switches between speaker rotation and stop
Src
Selects the modulation source of LFO speed
Appendix
Wet / Dry
D
D-mod
D-mod
-mod
Right
Horn/Rotor Balance
Rotor, 1...99, Horn
Sets the level balance between the high-range horn and low-range rotor
Mic Distance
0...100
Sets the distance between the microphone and rotary speaker
Mic Spread
Sets the angle of left and right microphones
0...100
354
Effects
ER/Delay
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
a: Sw
This parameter sets how the modulation source switches
between rotation and stop.
When Sw = Toggle, the speaker rotates or stops alternately
each time you press the pedal or operate the joystick.
ER/Delay
Early reflection and delay effects
Wet / Dry
Each time the value for the modulation source exceeds 64, the
speaker rotates or stops alternately.
EQ Trim
LEQ
Wet / Dry
Type
Sharp, Loose, Modulated, Reverse
Selects the decay curve for the early reection
ER Time [msec]
Sets the time length of early reection
EQ Trim
Sets the input level of EQ applied to the effect sound
10...800msec
0...100
15.0...+15.0dB
15.0...+15.0dB
When a value for the modulation source is less than 64, slow
speed is selected, and when the value is 64 or higher, fast is
selected.
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Early Reflections
EQ Trim
b: Sw
Pre Delay
Right
This parameter sets how the rotation speed (slow and fast) is
switched via the modulation source.
When Sw = Toggle, the speed is switched between slow and
fast each time you press the pedal or operate the joystick.
HEQ
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
a: Type
This parameter selects the decay curve for the early reflection.
Early Reflections - Type
Sharp
Loose
Microphone
Microphone
Modulated
Mic Distance
Mic Distance
Reverse
Dry
Pre Delay
ER Time
Effects
ER/Delay
Wet / Dry
Direct
Mix
Auto Reverse
This multitap delay outputs three Tap signals to the left, right,
and center respectively. You can also adjust the left and right
spread of the delay sound.
Right
Wet / Dry
D-mod
Envelope Control
Input
Rec/Reverse Play
Control
-mod
355
Envelope Select
a
b
Rec Mode
Sets the recording mode
20...1320msec
Envelope Select
D-mod, Input
Selects whether the start and end of recording is controlled via the modulation source or the input signal level
,
Threshold
0...100
Sets the recording start level when Envelope Select is set to Input
Response
Sets the speed of the response to the end of recording
Direct Mix
Always On, Always Off, Cross Fade
Selects how a dry sound is mixed
Fx:031
L Delay
Level
C Delay
Spread
Level
Feedback
Input Level D-mod
R Delay
Level
Right
Wet / Dry
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source that controls recording when Envelope Select
is set to D-mod
Wet / Dry
Single, Multi
0...1360msec
a
Level
Sets the output level of TapL
0...100
Fx:031
0...50
0...1360msec
b
Level
Sets the output level of TapC
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
0...50
0...1360msec
c
g
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Level
Sets the output level of TapR
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
Feedback (C Delay)
Sets the feedback amountof TapC
100...+100
d
0...50
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the TapC feedback amount
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the TapC feedback amount
When Rec Mode is set to Single, you can set up to 1320msec for
Reverse Time. If recording starts during the reverse playback,
the playback will be interrupted.
When Rec Mode is set to Multi, you can make another recording during the reverse playback. However, the maximum Reverse
Time is limited to 660msec.
If you wish to record a phrase or rhythm pattern, set Rec Mode
to Single. If you record only one note, set Rec Mode to Multi.
The Reverse Time parameter specifies the maximum duration
of the reverse playback. The part in excess of this limit will not be
played in reverse. If you wish to add short pieces of the reverse
playback of single notes, make the Reverse Time shorter.
0...100%
0...100%
100...+100
Fx:037,
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
g
Spread
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
0...50
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Reverse Rec
Input
Time
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Reverse Time
Reverse Time
g: Spread
This parameter sets the pan width of the effect sound. The stereo
image is widest with a value of 50, and the effect sound of both
channels is output from the center with a value of 0.
Appendix
356
Effects
ER/Delay
The left and right Multitap Delays have two taps respectively.
Changing the routing of feedback and tap output allows you to
create various patterns of complex effect sounds.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Left
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
High Damp Low Damp
Input Level D-mod
Feedback
Delay
Delay
Input Level D-mod
Stereo/Cross
Feedback
Spread
Input Level D-mod
Delay
(2)
Mode
(1)
Delay
Tap1=(1)
Tap2=(2)
Spread
(2)
Stereo/Cross
Feedback
Right
Right
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Mode: Normal
Stereo/Cross
Stereo, Cross
Switches between stereo delay and cross-feedback delay
0.0...680.0msec
0.0...680.0msec
L Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the left channel
d
100...+100
Src
Selects the modulation source of feedback amount
Off...Tempo
Amt L
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the left channel feedback
R Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the right channel
Amt R
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the right channel feedback
f
0...100%
Fx:043
0...100%
Fx:043
100...+100
Fx:037,
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
i
Spread
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
0.0...680.0msec
0.0...680.0msec
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
0...100
Feedback (Tap2)
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
e
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the Tap2 feedback amount
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the Tap2 feedback amount
Fx:043
Fx:043
0...100%
0...100%
100...+100
Fx:037,
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
50...+50
Fx:043
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
Spread
100...+100
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound
Fx:043,
i
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
Mode
Normal, Cross Feedback, Cross Pan1, Cross Pan2
Switches the left and right delay routing
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
100...+100
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source of the effect sounds stereo image width
Amt
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the effect sounds stereo image width
100...+100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
a: Mode
You can change how the left and right delay signals are panned
by modifying the routing of the left and right delay as shown in
the figure above. You need to input different sounds to each
channel in order for this parameter to be effective.
d: Tap1 Level
This parameter sets the output level of Tap1. Setting a different
level from Tap2 will add a unique touch to a monotonous delay
and feedback.
Effects
ER/Delay
This stereo delay uses an LFO to sweep the delay time. The pitch
also varies. You will obtain a delay sound with swell and shimmering. You can also control the delay time using a modulation
source.
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Delay
Feedback
The effect is off when a value of the modulation source specified in the Src parameter is 63 or smaller, and the effect is on
when the value is 64 or higher. The LFO is triggered and reset to
the L LFO Phase and R LFO Phase settings when the value
changes from 63 or smaller to 64 or higher.
Delay
Right
LFO Sync
Wet / Dry
Response
LFO: Tri / Sine
D-mod
L/R: +/+ +/
LFO Shape
LFO
Modulation Mode
LFO, D-mod
Switches between LFO modulation control and modulation source control
D-mod Modulation
Reversed L/R control by modulation source
Src
Selects the modulation source that controls delay time
Response
Sets the rate of response to the modulation source
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
L/R:+/+, L/R:+/
,
Off...Tempo
Wet / Dry
High Damp Low Damp
0...30
Delay
Triangle, Sine
Feedback
c
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
Delay
100...+100
Fx:020
Right
FB
0.02...20.00Hz
Wet / Dry
Out
Attack, Release
Envelope
Control Target
Threshold
Off, On
Control Target
Selects from no control, output, and feedback
None, Out, FB
Src
Selects the modulation source that resets the LFO
Off...Tempo
180...+180
Polarity
Reverses level control
180...+180
Threshold
Sets the level to which the effect is applied
0...100
+,
L Depth
Sets the depth of the left LFO modulation
0...200
Offset
Sets the offset of level control
0...100
R Depth
Sets the depth of the right LFO modulation
0...200
Attack
Sets the attack time of level control
1...100
Release
Sets the release time of level control
1...100
0.0...680.0msec
0.0...680.0msec
0.0...500.0
0.0...500.0
L Feedback
Sets the feedback amount of left delay
100...+100
R Feedback
Sets the feedback amount of right delay
100...+100
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
Wet/Dry
Wet...1:99, Dry, 1:99...Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Fx:010,
j
Spread
i
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
b: D-mod Modulation
When the modulation source is used for control, this parameter
reverses the left and right modulation direction.
100...+100
Fx:043
Fx:043
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Spread
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound
0...100%
0...100%
100...+100
Fx:043
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
a: Control Target
This parameter selects no level control, delay output control
(effect balance), or feedback amount control.
Appendix
D-mod
357
358
Effects
ER/Delay
Level
Dry
Threshold
0.0...680.0msec
100...+100
Fx:043
Fx:043
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
0...100%
0...100%
Triangle, Sine
d
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
100...+100
Fx:020
0.02...20.00Hz
Panning Depth
Sets the panning width
Attack
g
(Ducking Delay)
Wet
100...+100
Release
Envelope
0.0...680.0msec
Src
Selects the modulation source for the panning width
Amt
Set the modulation amount of the panning width
Control Target=Out
Polarity= ()
Delay Time
Wet
0...100
Off...Tempo
100...+100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Control Target=Out
Polarity= (+)
Time
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
Wet / Dry
High Damp Low Damp
Pan
Delay
Depth
Feedback
Pan
Delay
High Damp Low Damp
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO Phase
LFO: Tri / Sin
LFO Shape
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Effects
ER/Delay
359
Wet / Dry
Input Level D-mod
This stereo delay enables you to set the delay time to match the
song tempo.
L Delay
Level
C Delay
Spread
Level
Feedback
R Delay
Stereo In - Stereo Out
Level
Left
Right
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Tempo
BPM
BPM
Delay
Input Level D-mod
Feedback
Delay
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Right
MIDI, 40...240
,
BPM
L Delay Base Note
Selects the type of notes to specify the delay time for TapL
,
b
BPM
Times
x1...x16
Sets the number of notes to specify the delay time for TapL
Level
Sets the output level of TapL
0...50
0...50
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the TapC feedback
100...+100
0...100%
Fx:043
0...100%
Fx:043
100...+100
Fx:037,
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
h
Spread
Sets the width of the stereo image of the effect sound
R>
----, OVER!!
Display the error message if the right channel delay time exceeds the upper
limit
Times
x1...x16
Sets the number of notes to specify the left channel delay time
Fx:049
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
0...50
Fx:043
Times
x1...x16
Sets the number of notes to specify the right channel delay time
Fx:049
2.50...+2.50%
L Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the left channel
100...+100
Src
Selects the modulation source of feedback amount
Off...Tempo
Amt L
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the left channel feedback
R Feedback
Sets the feedback amount for the right channel
100...+100
e
Amt R
100...+100
Sets the modulation amount of the right channel feedback
f
Fx:043
Fx:043
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
2.50...+2.50%
Adjust [%]
Fine-adjust the right channel delay time
100...+100
Src
Selects the modulation source for the TapC feedback
MIDI, 40...240
Fx:049,
R Delay Base Note
Selects the type of notes to specify the right channel delay time
Fx:049,
0...50
Feedback (C Delay)
Sets the feedback amount of TapC
Adjust [%]
Adjust [%]
Fine-adjust the left channel delay time
Times
x1...x16
Sets the number of notes to specify the delay time for TapR
Level
Sets the output level of TapR
Adjust [%]
Times
x1...x16
Sets the number of notes to specify the delay time for TapC
Level
Sets the output level of TapC
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
Wet / Dry
Tempo
0...100%
0...100%
100...+100
Fx:037,
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
100...+100
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Appendix
360
Effects
Reverb
Reverb effects
Wet / Dry
Pan
Input Level D-mod
Reverb
These effects simulate the ambience of reverberation in concert
halls.
Delay
High Damp Low Damp
Feedback
Input Level D-mod
Right
Wet / Dry
Tempo
BPM
BPM
Rythm Pattern
BPM
Selects MIDI Clock and assigns tempo
MIDI, 44...240
,
Rhythm Pattern
Selects a rhythm pattern
... 3
Tap1 Pan
Sets the panning of Tap1
L, 1...99, R
Tap2 Pan
Sets the panning of Tap2
L, 1...99, R
Tap3 Pan
Sets the panning of Tap3
L, 1...99, R
Tap4 Pan
Sets the panning of Tap4
L, 1...99, R
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
100...+100
Left
HEQ
Pre Delay
Reverb
EQ Trim
100...+100
Right
Wet / Dry
0...100%
Fx:043
Fx:043
0...100%
100...+100
Off...Tempo
Fx:037
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
0...100%
0...200msec
0...100%
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
0.1...10.0sec
Fx:037,
Src
Selects the modulation source for the input level
Off...Tempo
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the feedback
Wet / Dry
Pre Delay Thru
EQ Trim
LEQ
Src
Selects the modulation source of feedback amount
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
361
Effects
Reverb
The Pre Delay sets the delay time to the reverb input, allowing
you to control spaciousness.
Using the Pre Delay Thru parameter, you can mix the dry sound
without delay, emphasizing the attack of the sound.
Wet / Dry
ER Level
Dry
ERs
EQ Trim
Louder
LEQ
HEQ
Reverb
Pre Delay
Reverb Level
Reverb
Pre Delay Thru
ERs
Time
EQ Trim
ER Level
Right
Wet / Dry
Reverb Time
0.1...3.0sec
a
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range
0...100%
0...200msec
Fx:052
b
Pre Delay Thru [%]
Sets the mix ratio of non-delay sound
0...100%
Fx:052
ER Level
Sets the level of early reections
0...100
Reverb Level
Sets the reverberation level
0...100
EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Dry
ER
(Early Reflections)
Reverb
Time
Reverb Time
Appendix
Louder
Pre Delay
362
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
059: Par4Eq-Wah
This effect combines a mono-type four-band parametric equalizer and a wah. You can change the order of the connection.
Wet: Mono In - Mono Out / Dry: Stereo In - Stereo Out
Left
Wet / Dry
Routing
Parametric 4Band EQ
Wah/Auto Wah
Wah
Trim
Right
Sweep Mode
Envelope
Left
Wet / Dry
Parametric 4Band EQ
-mod
Exciter
Wet / Dry
Auto
D-mod
LFO
LFO
Exciter
Trim
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
0...100
Right
Wet / Dry
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 1
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
50...5.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
20...1.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
0...100
50...5.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
500...20.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
300...10.00kHz
18...+18dB
18...+18dB
0.5...10.0
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
Fx:006
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
20...1.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
300...10.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
500...20.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
Fx:009
Fx:009
0...100
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
18...+18dB
Frequency Top
Sets the upper limit of the wah center frequency
100...+100
Fx:011
0...70
Fx:011
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the wah when Sweep Mode=D-mod
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
0...100
100...+100
i
0.02...20.00Hz
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
0...100
LPF
Switches the wah low pass lter on and off
Off, On
Routing
PEQ WAH, WAH PEQ
Changes the order of the parametric equalizer and wah connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
363
Parametric 4Band EQ
Parametric 4Band EQ
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry
Right
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
a
20...1.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
18...+18dB
50...5.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
18...+18dB
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
18...+18dB
0.0...50.0msec
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
g
0...100
h
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
100...+100
Fx:020
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
i: Output Mode
When Wet Invert is selected, the right channel phase of the chorus/flanger effect sound is inverted. This creates pseudo-stereo
effects and adds spread.
However, if a mono-input type effect is connected after this
effect, the left and right sounds may cancel each other, eliminating the chorus/flanger effects.
50...5.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
300...10.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
500...20.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
18...+18dB
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
0...100
[P] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
18...+18dB
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
[F] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
20...1.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
500...20.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
0...100
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
300...10.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Wet / Dry
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
0...100
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
Resonance
Right
Wet / Dry
Phaser
Trim
Feedback
Phaser
Chorus/Flanger
Trim
Wet / Dry
Chorus/Flanger
Left
Wet / Dry
100...+100
Fx:023
Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Fx:010, 023
Normal, Wet Invert
Fx:060
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Appendix
Left
364
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
This effect combines a mono-type four-band parametric equalizer and a multitap delay.
Left
Left
Wet / Dry
Parametric 4Band EQ
Compressor
Delay
Trim
Wah/Auto Wah
Feedback
Wet / Dry
Routing
Multitap Delay
Comp
(2)
Wah
Output Level
Right
Right
Wet / Dry
Envelope - Control
Sweep Mode
Envelope
Auto
D-mod
-mod
Wet / Dry
LFO
LFO
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 1
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
0.5...10.0
50...5.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
[E] Band4 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency for Band 4
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
Fx:006
18...+18dB
20...1.00kHz
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
0...100
0.5...10.0
18...+18dB
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
18...+18dB
0...680msec
0...100
Fx:045
0...680msec
Feedback
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
100...+100
0...100%
Fx:043
SrcOff...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on
page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the
effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Fx:002
0...100
[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
Fx:009
0...100
Frequency Top
Sets the upper limit of the wah center frequency
Fx:009
0...100
0.02...20.00Hz
[W] Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
0...100
Off, On
Routing
CMP WAH, WAH CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and wah connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
1...100
Fx:002
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the wah when Sweep Mode=D-mod
f
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330
Fx:006
500...20.00kHz
1...100
300...10.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Fx:002
Fx:006
18...+18dB
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
365
(Compressor Overdrive/Hi.Gain)
This effect combines a mono-type compressor and an amp simulation. You can change the order of the effect connection.
Compressor
Wet / Dry
Amp Simulation
Left
Wet / Dry
Routing
EQ Trim LEQ
Compressor
HEQ
Comp
Overdrive / Hi-Gain
Output Level
Comp
Driver
Output Level
Output Level
Right
Envelope - Control
Wet / Dry
Right
Wet / Dry
Envelope - Control
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
Fx:002
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330
1...100
Fx:002
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
0...100
Fx:002
[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
1...100
a
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
1...100
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330
Fx:002
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
Fx:002
1...100
0...100
Fx:002
0...100
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
Routing
CMP AMP, AMP CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and amp simulation connection
1...100
Fx:006
Fx:006,
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
0...50
50...+50
20...1.00kHz
e
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
f
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1
18...+18dB
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
Routing
CMP OD, OD CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and overdrive connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Appendix
366
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
(Compressor Chorus/Flanger)
Compressor
Parametric 4Band EQ
Comp
Chorus/Flanger
+
Output Level
Comp
Output Level
Chorus/Flanger
+
+
Wet / Dry
Routing
Compressor
Wet / Dry
Feedback
Trim
Right
Envelope - Control
Right
Envelope - Control
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
1...100
Fx:002
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330
1...100
Fx:002
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
0...100
Fx:002
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 1
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
50...5.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
20...1.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Fx:002
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
Fx:002
1...100
0...100
[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
0.0...50.0msec
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
0...100
g
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
100...+100
Fx:020
Routing
CMP FLNG, FLNG CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and chorus/anger connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
18...+18dB
j
100...+100
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330
[F] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0.5...10.0
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
1...100
Fx:006
Routing
CMP PEQ, PEQ CMP
Switches the order of the compressor and parametric EQ connection
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
18...+18dB
500...20.00kHz
Fx:002
300...10.00kHz
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
0...100
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine
Wet / Dry
a
a
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
367
(Compressor Phaser)
Compressor
EQ Trim LEQ
Phaser
Envelope - Control
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330
Fx:002
1...100
Right
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
Fx:002
1...100
0...100
[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
0...100
[P] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
100...+100
Fx:023
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
Fx:002
1...100
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330
Fx:002
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
Fx:002
1...100
0...100
[C] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
0...680msec
e
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
0...100
Fx:045
0...680msec
Feedback
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
100...+100
Routing
CMPDLY, DLYCMP
Switches the order of the compressor and multitap delay connection
Routing
CMPPHS, PHSCMP
Switches the order of the compressor and phaser connection
Fx:067
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Wet / Dry
Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode
(2)
Mt.Dly Wet / Dry
Envelope - Control
Fx:002
Delay
Wet / Dry
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
Feedback
Comp
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Resonance
Phaser Wet / Dry
+
Right
Multitap Delay
Comp
Output Level
Wet / Dry
Routing
Compressor
Phaser
HEQ
Left
Wet / Dry
Routing
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
0...100%
Fx:043
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
100...+100
Appendix
Left
368
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
(Limiter Chorus/Flanger)
This effect combines a mono-type limiter and a four-band parametric equalizer. You can change the order of the effect connection.
Chorus/Flanger
Limiter
Wet / Dry
Routing
Limiter
Wet / Dry
Routing
Left
Parametric 4Band EQ
Chorus/Flanger
Limiter
EQ Trim LEQ HEQ
Limiter
Gain Adjust
Feedback
Trim
Gain Adjust
Right
Envelope - Control
Right
Release
Sets the release time
1...100
Fx:003
[E] Trim
Sets the parametric EQ input level
[E] Band1 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency of Band 1
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 1
50...5.00kHz
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 3
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 3
[E] Band4 Cutoff [Hz]
Sets the center frequency for Band 4
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 4
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 4
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
j
100...+100
1...100
Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
0.0...50.0msec
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
100...+100
Fx:020
[F] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
Routing
LMTFLNG, FLNGLMT
Switches the order of the limiter and chorus/anger connection
Fx:067
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
0.5...10.0
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Fx:003
Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/anger
Fx:006
Routing
LMTPEQ, PEQLMT
Switches the order of the limiter and parametric EQ connection
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
18...+18dB
500...20.00kHz
Release
Sets the release time
300...10.00kHz
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
1...100
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
f
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
Fx:003
20...1.00kHz
0...100
18...+18dB
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 2
40...0dB
Fx:003
[L] Attack
Sets the attack time
b
Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Band 1
Q
Sets the bandwidth of Band 2
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003
Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied
40...0dB
Fx:003
1...100
Fx:003
[L] Attack
Sets the attack time
b
[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003
Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Envelope - Control
[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
c
Left
Fx:003
1...100
Release
Sets the release time
Fx:003
1...100
Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003
Wet / Dry
Routing
Limiter
[L] Attack
Sets the attack time
b
Phaser
369
0...680msec
d
+
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
Phaser
Limiter
Gain Adjust
Resonance
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
0...100
Fx:045
0...680msec
Feedback (Tap2)
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
100...+100
Right
Wet / Dry
Envelope - Control
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003
Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied
40...0dB
Fx:003
[L] Attack
Sets the attack time
Fx:003
1...100
Release
Sets the release time
Fx:003
f
0...100%
Fx:043
Routing
LMTDLY, DLYLMT
Switches the order of the limiter and multitap delay connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
1...100
Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
0...100
(Exciter Compressor)
[P] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
f
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
100...+100
Fx:023
g
Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode
Compressor
Comp
Exciter
Routing
LMTPHS, PHSLMT
Switches the order of the limiter and phaser connection Fx:067
Output Level
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Wet / Dry
Routing
Exciter
Right
Envelope - Control
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
e
Left
Wet / Dry
Routing
Multitap Delay
Limiter
Feedback
Limiter
Delay
(2)
Mt.Dly Wet / Dry
Right
h
[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003
Threshold [dB]
Sets the level above which the compressor is applied
40...0dB
Fx:003
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
Fx:002
1...100
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330
Fx:002
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
Fx:002
1...100
0...100
Routing
XCTCMP, CMPXCT
Switches the order of the exciter and compressor connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Wet / Dry
Envelope - Control
0...70
Fx:011
f
+
100...+100
Fx:011
Wet / Dry
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Appendix
Left
370
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
(Exciter Limiter)
(Exciter Chorus/Flanger)
Wet / Dry
Limiter
Exciter
Chorus/Flanger
Exciter
Wet / Dry
Routing
EQ Trim LEQ
HEQ
Chorus/Flanger
Exciter
Limiter
Exciter
Feedback
Gain Adjust
Right
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Envelope - Control
[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
100...+100
Fx:011
0...70
Fx:011
[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
e
[L] Ratio
Sets the signal compression ratio
1.0:1...50.0:1, Inf:1
Fx:003
40...0dB
Fx:003
[L] Attack
Sets the attack time
1...100
Fx:003
Release
Sets the release time
1...100
Fx:003
Routin
XCTLMT, LMTXCT
Switches the order of the exciter and limiter connection
100...+100
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
0.0...50.0msec
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
[F] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
g
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
100...+100
Fx:020
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
0...70
Fx:011
Inf, 38...+24dB
Fx:003
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Fx:011
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
371
(Exciter Phaser)
Left
Left
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Exciter
EQ Trim LEQ
HEQ
Multitap Delay
Exciter
Phaser
Phaser
Exciter
Resonance
Feedback
Delay
Exciter
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
(2)
Mt.Dly Wet / Dry
Right
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine
[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
100...+100
Fx:011
0...70
Fx:011
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
[X] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
0...100
[P] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
g
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
[P] Phaser Wet/Dry
Sets the phaser effect balance
h
Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode
100...+100
Fx:023
Wet...2:98, Dry, 2:98...Wet
Fx:010, 023
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
0...680msec
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
0...100
Fx:045
0...680msec
Feedback (Tap2)
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
100...+100
0...100%
Fx:043
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
0...100
0...70
Fx:011
100...+100
Fx:011
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
100...+100
Appendix
372
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
(Overdrive/Hi.Gain Chorus/Flanger)
This effect combines a mono-type overdrive/high-gain distortion and an amp simulation. You can change the order of the
effect connection.
This effect combines a mono-type overdrive/high-gain distortion and a chorus/flanger. You can change the order of the effect
connection.
Left
Overdrive / Hi-Gain
Left
Wet / Dry
Routing
Overdrive / Hi-Gain
3 Band PEQ
Chorus/Flanger
3 Band PEQ
Driver
Wet / Dry
Routing
Amp Simulation
Output Level
Driver
Chorus/Flanger
Output Level
Right
Normal
Output Mode
Feedback
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng Wet / Dry
Right
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine
a
Drive
Sets the degree of distortion
[O] Output Level
Sets the overdrive output level
b
1...100
Fx:006
Fx:006,
Drive
Sets the degree of distortion
0...50
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level
50...+50
18...+18dB
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2
f
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1
18...+18dB
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
0.0...50.0msec
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
18...+18dB
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1
18...+18dB
Routing
ODAMP, AMPOD
Switches the order of the overdrive and amp simulation connection
20...1.00kHz
18...+18dB
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
50...+50
0...50
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level
Fx:006,
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level
20...1.00kHz
c
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330
1...100
Fx:006
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
100...+100
100...+100
Fx:020
Routing
OD FLNG, FLNG OD
Switches the order of the overdrive and chorus/anger connection
Fx:067
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
373
(Overdrive/Hi.Gain Phaser)
This effect combines a mono-type overdrive/high-gain distortion and a phaser. You can change the order of the effect connection.
Wet / Dry
Routing
Overdrive / Hi-Gain
3 Band PEQ
Phaser
+
3 Band PEQ
Multitap Delay
Overdrive / Hi-Gain
Left
Feedback
Delay
Driver
Output Level
Output Level
Resonance
(2)
Mt.Dly Wet / Dry
Phaser
Driver
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Right
Wet / Dry
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri / Sine
Drive
Sets the degree of distortion
a
1...100
Fx:006
Fx:006,
0...50
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the overdrive output level
50...+50
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330
18...+18dB
0.5...10.0
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2
0.5...10.0
18...+18dB
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
0...100
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
[P] Phaser Wet/Dry
Sets the phaser effect balance
h
Output Mode
Selects the phaser output mode
i
100...+100
Fx:023
Routing
OD PHS, PHS OD
Switches the order of the overdrive and phaser connection
Fx:067
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
18...+18dB
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 2
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2
18...+18dB
0...680msec
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
0...100
Fx:045
0...680msec
Feedback
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
100...+100
h
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range
0.5...10.0
Fx:006
[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
Q
Sets the band width of Mid/High EQ 1
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 2
18...+18dB
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1
18...+18dB
20...1.00kHz
Fx:006
Gain [dB]
Sets the gain of Mid/High EQ 1
50...+50
20...1.00kHz
c
Gain [dB]
Table , Sets the gain of Low EQ, on page 330
0...50
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level
Src
Off...Tempo
Selects the modulation source for the overdrive output level
Fx:006,
0...100%
Fx:043
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Appendix
Drive
Sets the degree of distortion
1...100
Fx:006
374
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
This effect combines a mono-type decimator and an amp simulation. You can change the order of the effect connection.
Wet / Dry
Routing
Wah/Auto Wah
Amp Simulation
a
+
Wah
0...100%
Sweep Mode
Envelope
Auto
-mod D-mod
Wet / Dry
0...100
Fx:009
Frequency Top
Sets the upper limit of the wah center frequency
Fx:009
0...100
Resolution
Sets the data bit length
Fx:014
4...24
Fx:014
0...100
RoutingDECIAMP, AMPDECI
Switches the order of the wah and amp simulation connection
Wet/DryDry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on
page 330
LFO
LFO
1.00k...48.00kH
z
0.02...20.00Hz
[W] Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
0...100
Off, On
SrcOff...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on
page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the
effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Routing
WAH AMP, AMP WAH
Switches the order of the wah and amp simulation connection
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Wet / Dry
Routing
Compressor
Decimator
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
Output Level
Resolution
100...+100
Comp
Decimator
Pre LPF
High Damp
Output Level
Right
Wet / Dry
Envelope - Control
Fx:014
a
High Damp [%]
Sets the ratio of high-range damping
[D] Sampling Freq [Hz] (Sampling Frequency)
Sets the sampling frequency
0...100%
1.00k...48.00kHz
b
Resolution
Sets the data bit length
Fx:014
Fx:014
[C] Sensitivity
Sets the sensitivity
Fx:002
[C] Attack
Table , Sets the attack level, on page 330
Fx:002
Output Level
Sets the compressor output level
Fx:002
4...24
0...100
1...100
1...100
Routing
DECICMP, CMPDECI
Switches the order of the decimator and compressor connection
0...100
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
375
Wet / Dry
Multitap Delay
Chorus/Flanger
Feedback
Chorus/Flanger
EQ LEQ HEQ
Trim
Delay (2)
(1)
Cho/Flng
Wet / Dry High Damp
Mt.Dly
Wet / Dry
Feedback
Right
Wet / Dry
Wet / Dry
Amp Simulation
Tremolo
Tremolo
0.0...50.0msec
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
b
Right
Wet / Dry
LFO: Tri/Sin/Vintage/Up/Down
LFO Shape
[F] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
[T] Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0.02...20.00Hz
f
0...100
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Fx:020
[F] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
100...+100
Fx:020
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
LFO Shape
Determines how much the LFO waveform is changed
c
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
0...680msec
g
Tap1 Level
Sets the Tap1 output level
0...100
Fx:045
0...680msec
Feedback (Tap2)
Sets the Tap2 feedback amount
100...+100
100...+100
i
High Damp [%]
Sets the damping amount in the high range
0...100%
Fx:043
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Appendix
376
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
(Phaser Chorus/Flanger)
(Reverb Gate)
Left
Wet / Dry
Phaser
Wet / Dry
Reverb
Chorus/Flanger
EQ Trim
Phaser
Resonance
Chorus/Flanger
EQ LEQ HEQ
Trim
Phaser
Feedback
Wet / Dry
0.02...20.00Hz
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
0...100%
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
100...+100
Fx:023
[R] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
LFO Waveform
Selects LFO Waveform
Triangle, Sine
0.0...50.0msec
Depth
Sets the depth of LFO modulation
0...100
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
15...+15dB
100...+100
0...100
[G] Polarity
+,
Switches between non-invert and invert of the gate on/off state
Fx:005
[G] Attack
Sets the attack time
Fx:005
Release
Sets the release time
Fx:005
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Threshold
Sets the gate threshold level
Src
Off...Gate2+Dmpr
Selects the modulation source that controls the gate when Envelope Select
is set to D-mod
0...100
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Fx:020
[F] EQ Trim
Table , Sets the EQ input level, on page 330
0...100
Output Mode
Selects the output mode for the chorus/anger
0.1...10.0sec
0...100
Gate
[P] Manual
Sets the frequency to which the effect is applied
Feedback
Sets the feedback amount
f
Wet / Dry
Reverb
Balance
Resonance
Sets the resonance amount
c
Gate
Right
Wet / Dry
Reverb
LEQ HEQ
Normal
Output Mode
Wet Invert
Cho/Flng
Wet / Dry
+
Right
LFO: Tri / Sine
Pre Delay
1...100
1...100
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Table , Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds, on page 330
Src
Off...Tempo
Table , Selects the modulation source of the effect balance, on page 330
Amt
Table , Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance, on page 330
100...+100
Effects
Mono Mono Chain
377
090: Vocoder
c: Formant Shift
By offsetting the Carrier filter, you can adjust the height of the
frequency range to which the vocoder effect is applied. The tonal
quality will change significantly.
When programming the Vocoder, you can use one of the specially programmed Vocoder Performances (in the SFX bank)
as templates.
Carrier
Wet / Dry
Osc (Carrier)
Trim
Mic (Modulator)
Trim
Modulator
Wet / Dry
0...100
0...100
Formant Shift
Sets the height of the frequency for the vocoder effect
2...+2
Response
Sets the speed of the response to the modulator input
0...100
12...+12
12...+12
Modulator Mix
Sets the high-range output level of the modulator
Note: When you assign the Vocoder effect to the D FX processor, the
direct input can no longer be heard. The input signal goes entirely
to the FX processor. To listen to the direct signal, you can still use
the Wet/Dry parameter to increase the level of the direct signal
(Dry).
Please remember to set the tracks Pan value to Off, and the Send
value to 127.
You can add reverb to the Vocoder, by way of the D to C parameter.
Vocoder /
Carrier
Envelope
f: Modulator Mix
Hint: To create a new Song making use of the Vocoder, enter the
Sequencer-Backing Sequence mode with a Performance that
includes the Vocoder effect.
0...100
Vocoder/Carrier
Carrier, 1:99...99:1, Vocoder
Sets the balance between the vocoder output and the Carrier
Wet/Dry
Dry, 1:99...99:1, Wet
Sets the balance between the effect and dry sounds
Src
Selects the modulation source of the effect balance
Amt
Sets the modulation amount of the effect balance
Off...Tempo
100...+100
Appendix
378
Assignable parameters
List of Footswitch and EC5 functions
Assignable parameters
List of Footswitch and EC5 functions
The following functions can be assigned to a footswitch or Korg
EC5s switch pedal.
Function
Meaning
Style Change
Style number
Sound Up
Sound Down
Transpose Down
Transpose Up
Function
Meaning
Off
No function assigned
Style Start/Stop
FX B Mute
Pause Seq1
Same functions of the control panel buttons with the same name
Synchro Start
FX C Mute
FX D Mute
FX All Mute
Synchro Stop
Style-Upper1 Mute
Tap Tempo/Reset
Style-Upper2 Mute
Tempo Lock
Style-Upper3 Mute
Ritardando
Accelerando
Tempo Up
Tempo Down
Intro 1
Style-Lower Mute
Style-Drum Mute
Style-Percussion Mute
Style-Bass Mute
Style-Acc1 Mute
Intro 2
Style-Acc2 Mute
Intro 3 / Count In
Style-Acc3 Mute
Ending 1
Style-Acc4 Mute
Ending 2
Fill 2
Style-Acc5 Mute
Same functions of the control panel buttons with the same name
Style-Acc1-5 Mute
Song-Melody Mute
Song-Drum&Bass Mode
Mute of all tracks, apart for track 2 (usually Bass) and 10 (usually Drum)
Fill 3 / Break
Variation 1
Variation 2
Solo Selected Track
Variation 3
Damper Pedal
Variation 4
Variation Up
Variation Down
Bass Inversion
Soft Pedal
Sostenuto Pedal
Bass&Lower Backing
Fade In/Out
Memory
FX A Mute
Fill 1
Same functions of the control panel buttons with the same name
Pause Seq2
Upper Octave Up
Same functions of the control panel buttons with the same name
Manual Bass
Ensemble On/Off
QuarterTone
Chord Latch
Style Up
Style Down
Same functions of the control panel buttons with the same name
Glide
Single Touch
STS1
STS2
STS3
STS4
STS Up
STS Down
Perform. Up
Perform. Down
Audio In Mute
Assignable parameters
List of Assignable Pedal and Assignable Sliders functions
Meaning
Microphone Talkback
SongBook Next
These options let you move to the previous or next page, when reading a text
file loaded with a Song (see Text files
loaded with Standard MIDI Files and MP3
files on page 146) or Song Book entry
(see Lyrics as text files associated to a
SongBook entry on page 163).
Moves to the next SongBook entry in the
selected Custom List.
Pad 1
Pad 4
Pad Stop
Meaning
Off
No function assigned
Master Volume
Acc. Volume
Same functions of the control panel buttons with the same name
Accopaniment Volume
Keyboard Expression
Joystick +X
Joystick right
Joystick -X
Joystick left
Joystick +Y
Joystick forward
Joystick -Y
Joystick backward
Pad 2
Pad 3
Standard FX controllers
With this function assigned, you can control the proportional volume of all four
Pads at the same time. Please note that
the status of the Pads volume, after having been modified with a pedal or slider,
is made current, and will be saved in a
Performance or STS by using the relevant
Write procedure.
Appendix
Function
379
380
Assignable parameters
List of Assignable Switches functions
Function
Meaning
Function
Meaning
Off
No function assigned
Ritardando
Accelerando
Style Up
Style Down
Perform. Up
Perform. Down
FX A Mute
FX B Mute
FX C Mute
FX D Mute
FX All Mute
Style-Upper1 Mute
Style-Upper2 Mute
Style-Upper3 Mute
Style-Lower Mute
Style-Drum Mute
Style-Percussion Mute
Style-Bass Mute
Style-Acc1 Mute
Style-Acc2 Mute
Style-Acc3 Mute
Style-Acc4 Mute
Style-Acc5 Mute
Style-Acc1-5 Mute
Song-Melody Mute
Song-Drum&Bass Mode
Mute of all tracks, apart for track 2 (usually Bass) and 10 (usually Drum)
QuarterTone
Audio In Mute
Microphone Talkback
SongBook Next
These options let you move to the previous or next page, when reading a text
file loaded with a Song (see Text files
loaded with Standard MIDI Files and MP3
files on page 146) or Song Book entry
(see Lyrics as text files associated to a
SongBook entry on page 163).
Moves to the next SongBook entry in the
selected Custom List.
Assignable parameters
List of functions assignable to Voice Processors Continuous Controls
381
Voice 3 Level
Thicken Level
Lead to Delay
Voice 3 Gender
Thicken Detune
Harmony to Delay
Voice 1 Level
Voice 4 Level
Thicken Spread
Delay to Reverb
Voice 1 Gender
Voice 4 Gender
Vibrato Depth
Reverb/Delay Balance
Voice 2 Level
Harmony Smooth
Lead to Reverb
Effect Level
Voice 2 Gender
Harmony to Reverb
Lead On/Off
Thicken On/Off
Voice 1 On/Off
Voice 4 On/Off
Harm/Model On/Off
Latch On/Off
Voice 2 On/Off
Harmony/Modeling Switch
Effect On/Off
Harmony Hold
Voice 3 On/Off
Appendix
The following Voice Processor functions can be assigned to a footswitch, to an Assignable Switch, or to and EC5 swtich pedal, by using
one of the four corresponding <Sw> meta-functions available on the Voice Processor Preset: Controls page of the Global mode (see
Voice Processor Preset: Controls).
382
Assignable parameters
Scales
Scales
The following is a list of scales (or tunings) you can select in various operating modes.
Equal
Pure Major
Pure Minor
Arabic
Slendro
Pelog
Stretch
User
MIDI Data
MIDI Controllers
383
MIDI Data
CC#
MIDI Controllers
The following is a table including all Control Change messages,
and their effect on various Pa1X functions.
CC Name
Pa1X Function
Bank Select
Program selection
Mod1 (Y+)
Joystick forward
Mod2 (Y-)
Joystick backward
Undef. ctl
Foot ctl
Port.time
Data ent.
Volume
Balance
Undef. ctl
10
Pan Pot
11
Expression
12
Fx Ctl 1
13
Fx Ctl 2
14-15
Undef. ctl
16
Gen.pc.1
17
Gen.pc.2
18
Slider
19
Gen.pc.4
20-31
Undef. ctl
Pa1X Function
91
Fx A/C
92
Fx 2 ctl
93
Fx B/D
94
Fx 4 ctl
95
Fx 5 ctl
96
Data Inc
97
Data Dec
98
NRPN Lsb
99
NRPN Msb*
100
RPN Lsb
101
102-119
Track volume
Track panning
Expression
RPN Msb
Undefined ctl
120
AllSOff
121
Res Ctl
122
LocalCt
123
NoteOff
124
OmniOff
125
Omni On
126
Mono On
127
Poly On
CC#98
(LSB)
CC#06
(Data Entry)
Vibrato Rate
0127(a)
Vibrato Depth
0127(a)
Vibrato Decay
10
0127(a)
Filter Cutoff
32
0127(a)
Resonance
33
0127(a)
EG Attack Time
99
0127(a)
EG Decay Time
100
0127(a)
EG Release Time
102
0127(a)
20
dd(b)
0127(a)
Filter resonance
21
dd(b)
0127(a)
22
dd(b)
0127(a)
23
dd(b)
0127(a)
24
dd(b)
0127(a)
25
dd(b)
0127(a)
NRPN
Control Change #32-63 are the LSB (Least Significant Bytet) of Control Change #0-31, i.e. the MSB (Most Significant Byte), and are
changed according to their MSB counterparts.
64
Damper
65
Portamento
Damper pedal
66
Sostenuto
Sostenuto pedal
67
Soft pedal
Soft pedal
68
Legato
69
Hold 2
70
Sustin level
71
F.Res.Hp
72
Release
Release time
73
Attack
Attack time
74
F.CutOff
75
Decay T.
Decay time
76
Lfo1 Sp.
Vibrato speed
77
Lfo1 Dpt
Vibrato depth
Drum Volume
26
dd(b)
0127
Drum Panpot
28
dd(b)
0127(a)
78
Lfo1 Dly
79
FilterEg
29
dd(b)
0127(a)
80
Gen.pc.5
30
dd(b)
0127(a)
81
Gen.pc.6
82
Gen.pc.7
83
Gen.pc.8
84
Port.ctl
85-90
Undef. ctl
Note: These controls are reset when stopping the Song, or choosing
a new Song.
Appendix
CC#
CC Name
384
MIDI Data
Program Change messages used as remote commands
Function
PC
Function
PC
Function
PC
Function
PC
Function
91
Fade In/Out
92
Memory
93
Bass Inversion
94
96
Single Touch
97
Style Change
98
Intro 3/Count In
99
Manual Bass
95
Tempo Lock
Start/Stop (Style)
100
101
Play/Stop (Seq 2)
Play/Stop (Seq 1)
Note: The above Program Change numbers are given according to the 0-127 numbering system.
MIDI Data
MIDI Implementation Chart
385
Function
Recognized
Default
116
116
Changed
116
116
Default
Mode
Note
Number:
X
****************
0127
0127
True Voice
****************
0127
9n, V=1127
X
Poly (Key)
Aftertouch
Mono (Channel)
System
Real Time
Aux
Messages
Notes
V=64
X
O
*A
*A
*A
1, 2
Modulations
*A
*A
38
*A
7, 11
Volume, Expression
*A
10, 91, 93
*A
64, 66, 67
*A
65, 5
*A
71, 72, 73
*A
74, 75
*A
76, 77, 78
*A
98, 99
*A, 1
100, 101
*A, 2
X
O
True #
0127
****************
X
System Exclusive
System
Common
9n, V=1127
0, 32
120, 121
Program
Change
Pitch Bend
Control
Change
Altered
Note Off
Memorized
Messages
Note On
Velocity
Remarks
0127
*A
*A
0127
X
*3
Song Position
Song Select
Tune
Clock
*4
Commands
*4
Local On/Off
O (123127)
Active Sense
Reset
*A: Sent and received when MIDI Filters In and Out are set to Off in Global mode.
*1: Drawbars settings, Sound parameters, Selection of SongBook entries.
*2: LSB, MSB = 00,00: Pitch Bend range, =01,00: Fine Tune, =02,00: Course Tune.
*3: Includes Inquiry and Master Volume messages, FX settings, Quarter Tone settings.
*4: Transmitted only when the Clock Send parameter (Global mode) is set to on.
Mode 2:OMNI ON, MONO
Mode 4:OMNI OFF, MONO
O: Yes
X: No
Appendix
Basic Channel
Transmitted
386
Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters
Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters
The following table shows the parameters you can save to memory when selecting one of the Write commands from the Style Play,
Song Play, Sequencer, Global and Disk mode page menu, as well as when pressing the Write button in the SongBook > Book Edit 1
page.
Legend: Perf (Performance), STS (Styles STS), Sty Perf (Style Performance), STS SB (SongBooks STS), SB (SongBook Entry), Sty Stp (Style
Play Setup), Sng Stp (Song Play Setup), Glb Stp (Global Setup), Mid Stp (MIDI Setup), VP Stp (Voice Processor Setup), VP Tlk (Voice Processor Talk Setup), VP Pst (Voice Processor Preset), Dsk Stp (Disk Setup).
Page
Parameter
Global
Sty Stp Sng Stp Seq Stp Glb Stp Mid Stp VP Stp VP Tlk VP Pst Dsk Stp
Note
Control Panel
Drawbar Settings
Manual Bass
Fade In/Out
Selected Style Number
Single Touch
Tap Tempo / Reset
Synchro Start/Stop
Start/Stop
Style Element (Intro 1-3,
Ending 1/2, Var 1-4,
Fill 1-3)
Sequencer 1/2 Transport
Balance (Slider)
Selected STS
Tempo
Tempo Lock
Display Hold
Chord Scanning
Keyboard Mode
Style Change
Perf./Sound Select
Selected Performance
Selected Sound
K/St K
SongBook
Ensemble On/Off
Pads
Master Transpose
Analog control
St/Sg
L5
L7
L10
Set to On at startup
G
Set to Off at startup
St
St
L4
L3
L1
Main Mic
Selected Style
Meter
Tempo
Selected Perf/STS
Selected Songs
Keyboard Sounds
K
K
Upper Trk Octave Transp. U
U
Master Transpose
VP Lock
K
U
St
St
St
St
K
K
St
St
Selected when Original Style Sounds is set to Off
St
St
STS#1 selected when selecting a Style (with SINGLE TOUCH = On)
L1
T
L8
L2
G
SG
Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters
Main Sub-Scale
Main Pad
Main Split
Mix/Tun Volume/Pan
Mix/Tun FX Send
Mix/Tun Tuning
Mix/Tun Sub-Scale
Effects FX Select
Effects FX A-D
Pad/Switch Pad
Parameter
Scale
Key
Quarter Tone
Detuned Notes
Scale Lock
Pad Assignment
Pad lock
Split Point
Chord Recogn. Mode
Split Point Lock
Style Preferences Lock
Upper Volume Link
Pan
Volume
Play/Mute
Send Level
Play/Mute
PB Sensitivity
Trk Octave Transpose
Detune
Play/Mute
Scale
Key
Quarter Tone
Detuned Notes
Scale Lock
FX (A-B)
FX (C-D)
Wet/Dry (A-B)
Wet/Dry (C-D)
B to A
D to C
Mod. Track (A-B)
Mod. Track (C-D)
Selected FX (A-B)
Selected FX (C-D)
FX Parameters (A-B)
FX Parameters (C-D)
Int/Ext
Type
Play/Mute
Drum Family Volume
Play/Mute
Sound Parameters
Play/Mute
Damper
Joystick X
Joystick Y
Expression
Play/Mute
Top/Btm Key
Top/Btm Velocity
Play/Mute
Ensemble
Note Velocity
Tempo
Feedback
Ens Track Assign
Play/Mute
Drum Mapping Var 1-4
Kick and Snare Design.
Fill Mode 1-3
Fill Mode Lock
Play/Mute
Keyboard Range On/Off
Wrap Around
Play/Mute
Pad 1-4
Volume
Pan
C Send
D Send
Pad Lock
Switch 1-4
Assign. Sw. Lock
Chord Recogn. Mode
Velocity Control
Scale Mode
Memory Mode
Style Pref Lock
Global
Sty Stp Sng Stp Seq Stp Glb Stp Mid Stp VP Stp VP Tlk VP Pst Dsk Stp
Note
L14
L14
L14
L14
L3
L6
L11
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
St
St
St
St
St
St
St
St
St
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
G
G
St
St
St
St
St
St
St
St
St
T
L8
T
L8
T
L8
L14
L14
L14
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K/St
K
K
K
K
K
U
U
K
U
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
U
U
K
U
K
St
St
St
St
St
St
St
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
K
U
U
K
U
K
St
St
St
St
St
St
St
T
L8
T
L8
T
L8
L13
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
L8
T
L8
L3
L3
L3
L3
L3
L4
L11
L11
L11
L11
Appendix
Page
387
388
Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters
Page
Parameter
Midi Setup
Perf/Sound Default
Velocity Control Value
Upper Volume Link
Bass & Lower Backing
Global
Sty Stp Sng Stp Seq Stp Glb Stp Mid Stp VP Stp VP Tlk VP Pst Dsk Stp
Note
Main Lyrics-Options
Show Chords
Text Follow
Lead
V1-V4
Pitch
Thicken
Main Mic
Effects
Talk
Play/Mute
VP Preset
VP Lock
Scale
Key
Main Sub-Scale
Quarter Tone
Detuned Notes
Scale Lock
Pad Assignment
Main Pad
Pad lock
Split Point
Main Split
Split Point Lock
Pan
K
K
Mix/Tun Volume/Pan
Volume
K
K
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
Send Level
K
K
Mix/Tun FX Send
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
PB Sensitivity
K
K
Trk Octave Transpose
K
K
Mix/Tun Tuning
Detune
K
K
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
FX (A-B)
FX (C-D)
(*)
(**)
(*)
Wet/Dry (A-B)
Wet/Dry (C-D)
(*)
(**)
(*)
Effects FX Select
B to A
D to C
(*)
(*)
(**)
Mod. Track (A-B)
Selected FX (C-D)
(*)
(*)
(**)
Effects FX A-D
FX Parameters (A-B)
FX Parameters (C-D)
(*)
(*)
(**)
(*) Depends on the Perf. Recalls FX CD parameter (**) Depends on the Seq.2 FX Mode parameter
Int/Ext
K
K
Sg
Trk Ctrl Mode
Type
K
K
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
Drum Family Volume
K
K
Trk Ctrl Drum Volume
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
Sound Parameters
K
K
Trk Ctrl Easy Edit
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
Damper
K
K
Joystick X
K
K
Kbd Ens Kbd Control Joystick Y
K
K
Expression
K
K
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
Top/Btm Key
U
U
Kbd Ens Key/Vel Range Top/Btm Velocity
U
U
Play/Mute
K
K
Sg
L1
G
T
T
L2
L14
L14
L14
L14
L3
L6
L11
G
G
T
T
T
Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters
Parameter
Ensemble
Note Velocity
Tempo
Global
Sty Stp Sng Stp Seq Stp Glb Stp Mid Stp VP Stp VP Tlk VP Pst Dsk Stp
U
K
P
P
P
P
P
Note
Sg
T
L3
L3
L3
L3
L3
L4
T
G
G
G
G
G
G
Appendix
Page
389
390
Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters
Page
VP Setup Setup
VP Setup Dyn/EQ
VP Setup Talk
VP Preset Preset
VP Preset Thick/Pitch
Parameter
Midi In Oct Transp
Midi In Mute/Unmute
Chord 1 Midi Channel
Chord 2 Midi Channel
Upper Octave Transp
Lower Octave Transp
Midi In Velocity Value
VP Midi In Channel
VP Oct Transp In
VP In Note Range H/L
Channels
Channels
Midi In Filters
Midi Out Filters
Tracks
Tracks
Tracks
Drum Output
Drum Category
VP Out
Metronome Mode
Metronome Volume
Click Out
SPDIF On/Off
Speaker On/Off
MP3 Max Volume
CD Max Volume
VP Setup
Vibrato Mode
Vibrato RX Enable
Octave Transpose
Pitch Bend Range
Damper Mode
Mic In Low Cut
Delay Compensation
Pan
Level
Dyn Assign
EQ Assign
Dyn-Threshold
Dyn-Ratio
Dyn-Gate
EQ-Low Gain
EQ-Low Freq
EQ-Mid Gain
EQ-Mid Freq
EQ-Mid Q
EQ-High Gain
EQ-High Freq
Talk On/Off
Auto Talk
Ld to Rev
FX Lev
Master Vol. Attenuation
Rev-Type
Rev-PreDelay
Rev-Decay
Rev-Low Color
Rev-High Color
Thicken On/Off
Thicken-Detune
Thicken-Spread
Level
VP Preset
Harmony/Modeling Sw.
Lead On/Off
V1-V4 On/Off
Pitch On/Off
Thicken On/Off
Harm./Model. On/Off
Effects On/Off
VP Preset Lock
Thk-On/Off
Thk-Detune
Thk-Spread
Thk-Level
Ptch-On/Off
Ptch-Root
Ptch-Scale Type
Ptch-Attack
Ptch-Amount
Ptch-Window
Ptch-Custom Scale
Global
Sty Stp Sng Stp Seq Stp Glb Stp Mid Stp VP Stp VP Tlk VP Pst Dsk Stp
Note
T
G
T
T
T
G
G
Parameters
Control panel and operating mode parameters
Parameter
Resonance / Amount
Spectral / Amount
Growl / Amount
VP Preset V. Modeling Inflection / Amount
Vibrato / Amount
Level
Pan
On/Off
Latch On/Off
Harmony Mode
Root
Type
Human. Style
Amount
VP Preset Harmony
Tuning
Portamento
PB Assign
Smooth
Harm Note Input Source
Attack
Release
Level
Voice On/Off
Gender
Voicing
Vibrato Style
VP Preset Harm. Voices Vibrato Amount
Level
Pan
CV Map-Note In
CV Map-Note Out
Lead to Rev
Harm/Model to Rev
Harm/Model to Dly
Lead to Dly
Dly to Rev
Rev/Dly Balance
FX Level
Rev-Type
Rev-PreDelay
VP Preset Effects
Rev-Decay
Rev-Low Color
Rev-High Color
Dly-Type
Dly-Delay
Dly-Feedback
Dly-Source
Dly-R(atio)
Dly-Hi Freq Damp
Cnt.Ctl A-D
VP Preset Controls
Sw.Ctl A-D
System
Characters
Video Interface
Colors
Position X/Y
Touch Screen Calib
Calibration
Disk Mode
Global Protect
Hard Disk Protect
Factory Styles/Pad Protect
Preferences
PCM Autoload
Hide Unknown Files
HD Sleep Time
Global
Sty Stp Sng Stp Seq Stp Glb Stp Mid Stp VP Stp VP Tlk VP Pst Dsk Stp
Note
Set to On at startup
L1
L9
L3
L11
L5
L13
L7
L15
L2
L10
L4
L12
L6
L8
L14
L16
Appendix
Page
391
392
Parameters
Style, Pad and Song parameter
Header
Style
Tracks
Pad
Master Track
Header
Track
Tempo
Meter (Time Signature)
Sounds(b)
Note On/Off
Pitch Bend
After Touch
Control Change(c)
Quarter Tone(a)
Quarter Tone Reset(a)
Pad Sync
Pad Type
Chord Variation Length
Original Key/Chord
NTT
Wrap Around
Expression
Keyboard Range
Chord Variation Table
Track Type (Drum/Perc/Bass/Acc)
Trigger Mode
Tension
Play/Mute status(a)
Master Transpose(a)
Volume
Pan
FX Block(a)
FX Send
Detune
Scale(a)
Key
Note
Detune
Uses Arranger/Sequencers
Tempo
Header
Master Track
Modulation Track(a)
Scale Yes/No(a)
Pitch Bend Range
Song
Tracks
Recognized chords
393
Recognized chords
The following pages show the most important chords recognized by the Pa1X, when the selected Chord Recognition mode is Fingered 2
(see Chord Recognition Mode on page 95). Recognized chords may vary with a different Chord Recognition mode.
Major 6th
Major
3-note
T
2-note
2-note
4-note
T
Major 7th
4-note
3-note
2-note
T
T
Sus 2
Sus 4
3-note
2-note
3-note
3-note
2-note
T
T
Dominant 7th
4-note
T
T
T
T
T
4-note
4-note
T
Major 7th 5
Dominant 7th 5
3-note
T
T
Appendix
394
Recognized chords
Minor
Minor 6th
3-note
2-note
4-note
Minor 7th
Minor-Major 7th
4-note
3-note
Diminished
3-note
4-note
3-note
4-note
T
T
Minor 7th 5
4-note
Augmented
3-note
T
T
No 3rd
2-note
Augmented 7th
4-note
T
No 3rd, no 5th
1-note
395
You can install a 2.5 ATA hard disk drive into your Pa1X, for
quick and easy data storage and retrieval. Please contact your
Korg dealer for more information. Before you begin, turn the
instrument off, and disconnect the power cable.
Note: To install the hard disk, you will need a cross-point screwdriver.
1.
C
D
b
4.
A
a
Place the assembled hard disk unit over the four spacers in
the option compartment, as shown in the diagram. Secure
the hard disk unit to the spacers using the remaining four
M3x6 screws (b). Be sure to fix the clip (c), previously
removed, to the original spacer, as shown in the diagram.
Connect the data cable (B) to the hard disk (C), then secure
the cable (B) with the clip (c).
b
C
a
b
2.
b
B
b+c
b+c
3.
Appendix
396
2.
Device selector
3.
4.
Press the
(Text Edit) button in the display to assign a
label (name) to the hard disk.
5.
Select the Full Format option, then press the Execute button, and follow the instructions that appear in the display.
397
If the above is not true, please follow the instructions you can download from our website (www.korgpa.com).
A Korg CDRW-1 CD player/writer can be installed into your Pa1X. Installation will require a + (cross-point) screwdriver. Please contact your Korg dealer for more information on how to obtain this option.
Warning: Installation of the CD drive is done at the users own risk. Korg will assume no responsibility for any damage or injury resulting
from improper installation or use.
Pa1X Pro
Pa1X
1) Before you begin, turn the instrument off, and disconnect the power cable.
2) Push the small unlock button with the tip of a pen, to open the CD drives (A) cover, and remove the paper protection.
push
push
A
3) With the help of a cross-point screwdriver, remove the two screws
(a) securing the floppy disk drive cover (B), and remove the cover itself.
B
a
Appendix
398
Pa1X Pro
Pa1X
4) Slide the CD drive (A) into the instrument. Push it all the way in, to make sure that the CD drive mounts to the connector inside the Pa1X (two
clicks should be felt on your fingers when the connector on the CD drive is correctly inserted).
5) Turn the instrument on. Go to the Disk mode, and select the CD device by using the Device pop-up on the lower left corner of the Load, Save,
Copy, and Erase pages. If it works, go on with the next step to complete installation.
6) Screw screw (b) to secure the CD drive in place. Apply the cover (C) supplied with the Pa1X, and secure it with the two previously extracted
screws (a).
a
a
We suggest saving all removed components in a safe place for future use.
399
Before you begin, turn the instrument off, and disconnect the power cable.
2.
Turn the instrument upside down, and remove the screws (a), to
open the cover (A) and gain access to the option compartment.
Note: Block any possible access to the inside of the instrument during installation to prevent any items from falling inside. In the
event something does fall into the instrument, please immediately
contact your nearest Service Center.
Pa1X Pro
a
a
Pa1X
3.
4.
Lightly push out on the two securing clamps (one on each end).
A
a
Appendix
400
5.
6.
Insert the new SIMM module (C) into the slot that was originally empty, as shown in the diagram. Line up the lower side of
the module with the slot base, then rotate the module up, and
delicately push until it is firmly seated in place. Be sure the module is correctly inserted. If not, extract it and repeat the operation.
7.
Now re-insert the SIMM module (B) that you removed in step
5, using the same method as used with the new module (C).
8.
Close and secure the compartment cover by reversing the operations seen on step 2.
401
Before you begin, turn the instrument off, and disconnect the power cable.
2.
Turn the instrument upside down, and remove the screws (a), to
open the cover (A) and gain access to the option compartment.
Note: Block any possible access to the inside of the instrument during installation to prevent any items from falling inside. In the
event something does fall into the instrument, please immediately
contact your nearest Service Center.
Pa1X Pro
a
a
Pa1X
A
a
Appendix
3.
402
4.
Insert the first ROM expansion module (B) the only one, if it
is the only one you purchased in the slot farther from you, as
shown in the diagram. Line up the lower side of the module
with the slot base, then rotate the module up, and delicately
push until it is firmly seated in place. Be sure the module is correctly inserted. If not, extract it and repeat the operation.
Note: You could also install the module in the other slot, but this
way installing a second module later will be easier.
5.
6.
Close and secure the compartment cover by reversing the operations seen on step 2.
403
Part listing
Before beginning with the installation, please be sure all the following parts are included with your kit. Some parts are needed
only when installing the board on a particular model, but not on
others. In addition, you will need a cross-point screwdriver and
a pair of pliers (not supplied).
A
The following instruction refer both to the VIF3-PAL and VIF3NTSC versions of the board. When connecting the VIF3-PAL to
a SECAM-compliant TV, the image will be shown in black and
white.
C
B
E
Precautions
Installation of the card is done at the users own risk. Korg will
assume no responsibility for any damage or injury resulting
from its improper installation or use.
H
F
Pa1X Pro
Pa1X
Video card
Plastic spacers
Ground cable
(not needed)
(not needed)
Video cable
(not needed)
Nuts
(not needed)
1
2
Note: The checkmark means the part is needed for the corresponding instrument. Some components are only for the Pa80 and Pa60,
therefore are not needed on the Pa1X or Pa1X Pro.
Appendix
404
support (g) for the installation on the Pa1X Pro, nevertheless we suggest to save them for any future use.
b
b
g
b
d
d
2.
d d
b
4.
B
B
e
f
e
GF
G
b+C
5.
3.
Examine the video interface (A) included with the kit. Note
how the IC board (f) is joined to the support (g) by means
of the two screws (b). Unscrew the two screws (b) to separate them. You will not need the removed screws (b) and
save them for any future use. On the contrary, the removed
screws will be needed in the following step.
405
b
b
g
b
d
d
2.
c
d
4.
Secure the IC board (f) to the two vertical spacers using the
two screws (b), previously removed. Please remember to
re-insert the clip (C) at its original position. Connect the
terminal lug of the cable (F) to the corresponding connector on the IC board. Secure the cable to the clip (C). Finally,
connect the cable (e) to the IC board, and secure it using
the previously loosened clip (C).
b+C
f
e
F
b
C
5.
b+C
3.
Appendix
406
RCA
RCA
SCART
2.
3.
4.
Turn the television set on, and tune it on the AV1 or AV2
input.
5.
407
Please note Korg is not responsible for any damage or injury caused by
incorrect installation of this card by unauthorized personnel.
Part listing
Before beginning with the installation, please be sure all the following parts
are included with your kit. Some parts are needed only when installing the
board on a particular model, but not on others. In addition, you will need a
cross-point screwdriver (Pa1X/Pa1X Pro) and a 5.5mm hexagon wrench or a
pair of pliers (Pa1X Pro) (not supplied).
Precautions
Installation of the card is done at the users own risk. Korg will assume no
responsibility for any damage or injury resulting from its improper installation or use.
Be sure to disconnect the instrument from the AC plug, before opening it.
To prevent your bodys static electricity from damaging the boards components, touch an unpainted metallic component before proceeding with the
installation.
Part name
Pa1X Pro
Pa1X
Self-locking nuts
Plastic spacers
MP3 card
M36 screws
Note: The checkmark means the part is needed for the corresponding instrument.
Appendix
You can install a Korg EXBP-MP3 board into your Pa1X or Pa1X
Pro. This user-installable card will let your Pa1X and Pa1X Pro
play and record MP3 files, allowing for easy music data exchange
with any personal computer or stand-alone MP3 player.
408
Installation
Pa1X Pro
1.
2.
3.
Insert the four plastic spacers (B) into the corresponding columns on the option compartment cover, as shown in the diagram. Please be sure to lay the flat size of the spacers onto the
option compartment cover, and to keep both clamps (f) under
the spacers (B), as shown in the following diagram.
4.
Insert the MP3 board (C) over the four spacers, with the components on the upper side (as shown in the diagram). Secure it to
the spacers by using the four self-locking nuts (A). Connect the
terminal lug of the cable (c) to the corresponding connector on
the MP3 board, by folding the cable as shown in the diagram.
5.
a
a
A+f
e A+f
d
c
B B
B B
f
f
A
c
C
A
A
A
409
Pa1X
Turn the instrument upside down, and remove the eight
screws (a), to open the cover (b) and gain access to the option
compartment.
Note: Block any possible access to the inside of the instrument (for example, the openings of the nearby RAM expansion slots) during installation to prevent any items from
falling inside. In the event something does fall into the instrument, please immediately contact your nearest Service Center.
a
a
2.
b
a
d
D+f
3.
Insert the MP3 board (C) over the four spacers, with the components on the upper side (as shown in the diagram). Secure it to
the spacers by using the four M3 screws (D). Connect the terminal lug of the cable (c) to the corresponding connector on the
MP3 board, by folding the cable as shown in the diagram.
4.
D+f
D
C
D
c
D
Appendix
1.
410
Recording an MP3
If your Pa1X is fitted with the optional MP3 Board (EXBP-MP3)
and a hard disk (optional on the Pa1X with speakers), you can
record your performance as an MP3 file.
Note: You cannot enter MP3 Record mode while in Sequencer or
Disk mode.
All you play on the keyboard, the Styles and the Standard MIDI
Files performed by the sequencer will be recorded. Audio entering the Audio Input 1 (microphone input, or mono line-level
input), and harmony voices generated by the Voice Processor
will be recorded as well.
Playback of MP3 files and Audio CD tracks will not be
recorded.
To enter recording, keep the SHIFT button pressed, and press
the REC button. The following dialog box will appear.
After saving, you can listen to the MP3 file in Song Play mode, as
you did with any other Song.
The MP3 file can also be moved to a personal computer for further editing, via the USB interface.
Notes
Operating system version
To use the EXBP-MP3, your Pa1X must be fitted with Operating System 1.51 or higher.
Audio outputs
After installing the EXBP-MP3 board, the audio output level (both on
the OUTPUT connectors and the internal speakers) is increased of
about 3dB. Readjust the master volume accordingly.
Playback
MP3 files recorded with lower sampling rates may not sound very
good. This is an unavoidable problem with MP3 files.
You can assign an MP3 file to both sequencers, but starting one stops
the other (if it is playing).
When reading MP3 files from a data CD, and the CD has been automatically paused for having been inactive for some time, starting playback may require some seconds, because the CD has to start spinning
again.
If you like, you can press the EXIT button to exit this dialog box.
To enter it again, and see the file length or stop recording, press
SHIFT+REC again.
During recording, you can use this dialog box to see the Recording time, file length, and the remaining space on disk. Maximum
recording time depends on the available space on the hard disk.
After pressing Stop, recording will stop, and the following dialog
box will appear:
Press the
(Text Edit) button to assign a name to the MP3
File. Press the Browse button to select a device and directory
where to save the file. Press the Save button to save the file.
Recording
You can record as an MP3 file everything you play with the Pa1X,
including your vocals (in other words, you can record your whole performance). However, you cannot record MP3 files or convert Audio
CD Tracks.
You can listen to Audio CD tracks during MP3 recording, but they will
not be recorded.
Hard disk
To record MP3 files, your Pa1X must be fitted with a hard disk.
It is not advisable to fill the hard disk too much during recording. Filling the hard disk may cause troubles with the recorded file.
Shortcuts
411
Shortcuts
Shift +
Functions
Tempo Change
Scroll Arrows, or
Up/Down
Sound
Global
Disk
Start/Stop
Panic
Slider Mode
Selects the Assignable Sliders page, Controllers section, of the Global mode
Fade In/Out
Synchro (either)
Tempo Lock
Selects the Lock page, General Controls section, of the Global mode
Display Hold
SongBook
Transpose (either)
Memory
Var or Fill
Chord Scanning
(either)
Keyboard Mode
(either)
Shift +
Functions
Ensemble
Pad (any)
Assignable Switch
(any)
Upper Octave
(either)
Play/StopSeq 1
or 2
>>
<<
Upper Octave
(either)
Keyboard Mode
(either)
Pad (any)
Assignable Switch
(any)
JukeBox mode
>>
<<
Sequencer mode
Sequencer
Upper Octave
(either)
Original Tempo
Appendix
You can keep the SHIFT button pressed, and press another button on the control panel to directly jump to an edit page. Here is
the list of shortcuts.
412
Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting
Problem
Solution
Page
General problems
Power does not turn on
Make sure that (1) the power cable is plugged into the outlet, (2) the cable is plugged into the
connector on the back of the instrument, (3) and is not damaged, (4) there are no problems
with the mains.
Is the power switch turned ON?
If the power still does not turn on, contact your dealer or the nearest KORG Service Center.
No sound
Is a jack connected to the HEADPHONES connector? This would disable the internal speakers.
18
18
Make sure that all the components of the amplifying system are turned on.
Is the MASTER VOLUME slider of the Pa1X set to a position other than 0?
18
237
241
Is the Attack parameter value too high? Set it to a lower value, to let the sound start faster. Is
the Volume parameter too low? Set it to a higher value.
84, 90
When the SPLIT button is lit up, the keyboard will be divided into the Lower part (low notes,
below the split point) and the Upper part (high notes, above the split point). Is the Lower track
muted? Unmute it.
27
Wrong sounds
Do the USER banks contain modified data? Load the appropriate data for the Song or the Style
you wish to playback.
262
Has one of the USER Drum Kits been modified? Load the appropriate Drum Kits.
262
Have the Styles or Performances been modified? Load the appropriate data (Styles or Performances).
262
Make sure that the damper switch polarity parameter is set correctly.
235
Make sure that the Clock parameter is set to Internal. If you are using the MIDI Clock of
another device, you must set the MIDI Clock parameter to MIDI A or MIDI B (depending on the
port the Pa1X is hooked to the other device through) and make sure that the external device
transmits MIDI Clock data.
236
280
Make sure that the external device is transmitting through MIDI channels enabled to receive in
the Pa1X.
238
Make sure that the MIDI IN Filters of the Pa1X do not prevent the reception of messages.
239
Make sure that the Drum track is set to Drum Mode and the external device has not transposition applied.
The selected Performance, Style or STS recalled the effect 15 Analog Record, simulating the
noise of a old vinyl recording.
The Vocoder effect has been assigned to the D FX processor. This deactivates the Voice processor.
Voice processor effects an only be applied to the microphone (MIC) input
88, 181
377
Troubleshooting
Problem
Solution
413
Page
Are you using a 3.5 inch 2DD or 2HD floppy disk? You must use one of these types.
Is the disk inserted correctly?
278
278
270
278
278
278
259
Appendix
414
Technical specifications
Technical specifications
Model
Pa1X Pro
Pa1X
Keyboard
Operating System
KORG OPOS (Objective Portable Operating System) and RX (Real eXperience) Technology. Multitasking, Load-While-Play feature. SSD
(Solid State Disk)-resident. Upgradable from floppy disk.
Display
Help
Data storage
1.44MB Floppy Disk Drive (MS-DOS compatible), Optional CDRW (KORG CDRW-1), Standard 2.5" ATA Hard Disk Drive
Polyphony
1.44MB Floppy Disk Drive (MS-DOS compatible), Optional CDRW (KORG CDRW-1), Optional 2.5" ATA Hard Disk Drive
Multitimbricity
Sounds
Factory: >870, including a Stereo Piano and GM Level 2-compatible Programs, 48 Drum Kits
User: 256 Sounds, 64 Drum Kits.
Digital Drawbars
Sound Edit
Sampling
Record, Edit, Time Slice (compatible with Korg, Wav, Aiff and Akai files)
2 slots available, for up to 32MB of additional samples (up to 512 extra Sounds and 128 Drum Kits)
Effects
4 stereo digital multi-effect processors (with 89 effect types each, plus Vocoder). Voice Processor by TCHelicon.
Voice Processor
Voice technology by TCHelicon. Four-parts harmonizer, Reverb, Delay, Compressor, EQ. Pitch Correction and Voice Modeling available as options.
Realtime Tracks
Performances
Memorize Realtime tracks and Voice Processor settings. Up to 4 608 Styles. Up to 4 each SongBook entry.
Styles
More than 450 preloaded Styles, SSD-resident, freely reconfigurable. Up to 608 available Style locations. Eight Style tracks, 4 Single
Touch Settings and one Style Performance per-Style.
Direct Disk (up to 96 Styles) and Direct Hard Disk (up to 288 Styles) functions. Compatible with old i-Series and Pa80/60-series Styles.
Style Record with Edit functions, Step Edit, Event Edit. Up to 96 User Style locations.
Style controls
4 Variations, 2 Fills, 2 Intros, 2 Endings, Intro 3/Count In, Fill 3/Break, Synchro Start/Stop, Tap Tempo/Reset, Fade In/Out, Bass Inversion,
Manual Bass, Tempo Lock, Memory, Accompaniment Volume, Accompaniment Mute, Drum Mapping, Snare & Kick Designation, Single
Touch.
General controls
Master Volume, Ensemble, Octave Transpose, Master Transpose, Split Point, Style Change, Tracks Volume, Quarter Tone (pedal function), Assignable Sliders, Assignable Switches, Joystick, Dial.
Pads
Song Play
Patented XDS Crossfade Dual Sequencer player - 2 Sequencers with separate Select, Start/Stop, Pause, << (Rewind) and >> (Fast Forward) controls. Balance control.
Lyrics data can be displayed on-screen, or on an external video monitor. Jukebox function. SMF Direct Player (formats 0 and 1). Reads
Audio CDs and MP3 files (both optional).
Sequencer
Quick, Multitrack and Step Record functions. Full-featured sequencer. 16 tracks. Up to 200,000 events. SMF native format.
MP3 Player/Recorder
CD Audio Player/Writer
Optional. Requires a KORG CDRW-1 drive. Reads audio and data, writes data (ISO 9660 disks).
SongBook
Fully programmable music database, with automatic selection of Style Play and Song Play modes. Different custom lists can be created.
Pedals
Realtime controllers
MIDI
2 IN, 2 OUT (toggle as THRU ports). Individual track assignment. Auto-setup functions (MIDI Setup)
USB
Audio Inputs
Audio Outputs
2 Main (Left/Mono, Right), 2 Sub (1, 2), 1 48kHz S/PDIF digital coaxial (mirroring Main Outputs)
Headphone
Amplification
Speakers
Power Supply
Power Consumption
35 W
Dimensions
W: 1330 mm / 52.36", D: 366 mm / 14.40", H: 136 mm / 5.35" (with- W: 1123 mm / 44.21, D: 428 mm / 16.85, H: 189 mm / 7.44 (without music stand)
out music stand)
Weight
Accessories
65 W
22 kg / 48.5 lbs
Technical specifications
Model
Pa1X Pro
Options
415
Pa1X
Appendix
416
Index
Index
A
Acc/Seq Volume 8, 18
Aftertouch Curve 230
AIFF file format 225
Akai 215, 225
Amp EG 207
AMS(Alternate Modulation Source)
Amp EG 207
Filter Cutoff 202
Filter EG 202
Filter LFO 203
Pan 205
Pitch 198
Pitch EG 200
Resonance 201
Arabic Scale 83, 86
Assignable Sliders 8, 235
Attack Level
Amp EG 207
Attack Time
Filter EG 205
Audio Inputs 11, 15, 19, 240
Audio Outputs 15, 18, 239241
Auto Style/Perf/Sound Select 234
Write 257
B
Backup 17, 271
Balance 11, 18
Bank Select 283
Bank123.SET, Bank456.SET, Bank789.SET (Direct HD) 99
Bass & Lower Backing 96
BPM
MIDI/Tempo Sync., LFO 209
C
CD 48, 55, 139, 140, 156
Installing 397
Selecting 259
Volume 242
Writing 274276
Chord Scanning 11
Lock 233
Cutoff Frequency 201
D
Damper 19, 91
Polarity 235
Decay Time
Filter EG 205
Delay
LFO 209
Demo 19
Digital Drawbars 192
Direct FD 100
Direct HD 99
Disk 259279
Backup 271
Format 270
Write protection 278
Display Hold 11
Double Sequencer 10, 147
Drum tracks 89, 93, 240
E
EC5 236
Effects
Copy 97, 155, 187
Sequencer mode 179, 180
Song Play mode 148, 149, 150
Style Play mode 85, 87, 180
Ending 10
Ensemble 92
F
Fade (Sound parameter)
LFO 209
Fade In/Out 230
Fill 10
Filter
Cutoff Frequency 201
Filter Type 200
Filter Cutoff 202
Filter EG 202
Filter LFO 203
Footswitch 235
Polarity 235
Format 270
G
General MIDI 281
Global 229258
Write
Global Setup 257
MIDI Setup 257
Sequencer Setup 188
Song Play Setup 156
Style Play Setup 99
Talk Configuration 258
Voice Processor Preset 258
Voice Processor Setup 258
Global channel 281
Groove Quantize 152
Index
H
Harmony track (Voice Processor) 153, 186
in SongBook entries 161
MIDI channel 237
Note Input Source 249
I
Inputs 11, 15, 19, 240
Intro 9
J
Jukebox 143, 151
K
Keyboard Mode 12
Lock 233
KMP file format 225
KSF file format 225
L
Level (Sound parameter)
Trim 200
LFO
Waveform, LFO waveform 208
Local Off 237, 283
Lower Lock 233
Lyrics 144, 163
M
Markers 145
Master Transpose 12, 231
Master Tune 230
Master Volume 8, 18
Menu 11
MIDI
Clock 137, 236
General MIDI 281
Global channel 281
IN channels 238
Interface 15, 283
OUT channels 238
Setup 96, 153, 186, 236, 281
Standard MIDI File 137, 166
MIDI interface 15, 283
MIDI Setup 96, 153, 186, 236, 281
Write 257
Midifile 137, 166, 280
Mode
Pad Record 126136
Sampling 215228
Sequencer 166189
Song Play 137156
SongBook 157165
Sound 190214
Style Play 78101
Style Record 102125
MP3 48, 56, 137, 139, 140, 144, 151, 156, 157, 163
Installation 407
Recording 410
Volume 241
O
Octave Transpose 13, 86
Auto Octave 232
Midi In 237
Offset
Offset, LFO 209
Operating Modes 8
OS (Operating System)
Backup 17, 271
Update 17
Outputs 15, 18, 239241
P
Pads 12, 94
Pan
Pads 94
Song tracks 148, 179
Sound 197, 205
Style tracks 84
PANIC (SHIFT+START/STOP) 10
PCG file format 225
PCM Autoload 226, 273
Pedals 235
Performance 12, 78
Selecting 12, 74
Selecting (Auto) 234
Writing 98
Pitch 198
Pitch Bend 86, 180
Pitch EG 200
Portamento
AMS 213
Program Change 283
Q
Quarter Tone 83, 86
R
Resonance 201
S
Sampling 215228
Sampling mode 215228
Scale
Main scale 231
Sequencer
Link mode 154
Sequencer 2 FX mode 154
Transport controls 10, 11
Sequencer mode 166189
Shift 10
Single Touch 9, 10
Single Touch Setting (STS) 10
Selecting 10, 75
Writing 98
Song
Markers 145
417
418
Index
T
Talk
Auto On/Off 244
On/Off 82
Settings 244
Write settings 258
Tap Tempo 10
Tempo/Value section 11
Touch Panel
Calibration 256
Reset 256
Track Select 10
Tracks
Drum/Percussion 89, 93, 240
Keyboard tracks 12, 78, 138
Octave Transpose 13
Sounds 12
Volume 84, 147, 179
Transpose 12, 13, 86
Auto Octave 232
Midi In 237
Trinity 215, 225
Triton 215, 225
Tune
Tune (Sound parameter) 195
U
Upper Volume Link 84, 96
USB 273
V
VALUE slider
AMS 213
Variation 10
Velocity
AMS 213
Velocity Intensity, Amp Mod. 206
Velocity, Filter EG 202
Velocity Curve 230
Video Interface 15, 256, 403
Vocoder 377
Voice Processor
Harmony Track 153, 161, 186
MIDI channel 237
Note Input Source 249
Voice Processor Preset
Editing 245
Lock 233
Writing 258
Voice Processor Setup
Editing 242
Writing 258
Volume
Acc/Seq 8, 18, 137
Balance 18
Individual tracks
Sequencer 179
Song Play 147
Style Play 84
Master 8, 18, 137
W
WAVE file format 225
Address
KORG ITALY Spa
Via Cagiata, 85
I-60027 Osimo (An)
Italy
Web servers
www.korgpa.com
www.korg.co.jp
www.korg.com
www.korg.co.uk
www.korgcanada.com
www.korgfr.net
www.korg.de
www.korg.it
www.letusa.es